Saturn Automobile 2009 VUE Hybrid User Guide

2009 Saturn VUE Green Line Hybrid Owner Manual M  
OnStar® System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ii  
Preface  
Read this manual from beginning to  
end to learn about the vehicle’s  
features and controls. Pictures,  
symbols, and words work together  
to explain vehicle operation.  
Propriétaires Canadiens  
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de  
ce guide en français auprès de  
concessionnaire ou à l’adresse  
suivante:  
Keep this manual in the vehicle for  
quick reference.  
Helm Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
SATURN, the SATURN Emblem,  
and the name VUE are registered  
trademarks of Saturn Corporation.  
GENERAL MOTORS and GM  
are registered trademarks of  
General Motors Corporation.  
Canadian Owners  
A French language copy of this  
manual can be obtained from your  
dealer/retailer or from:  
1-800-551-4123  
helminc.com  
About Driving Your  
Vehicle  
This manual includes the latest  
information at the time it was  
printed. Saturn reserves the right to  
make changes after that time  
without further notice.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
As with other vehicles of this type,  
failure to operate this vehicle  
correctly may result in loss of control  
or an accident. Be sure to read  
the “on-pavement” and “off-road”  
driving guidelines which follow in this  
manual in the section called “Your  
Driving, the Road, and Your  
Vehicle”.  
1-800-551-4123  
helminc.com  
This manual describes features that  
may or may not be on your  
specific vehicle.  
Litho in U.S.A.  
Part No. 25814240 A First Printing  
©2008 General Motors Corporation. All Rights Reserved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
iv  
Preface  
Vehicle Symbol Chart  
B : Engine Coolant Temperature  
O : Exterior Lamps  
# : Fog Lamps  
> : Safety Belt Reminders  
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor  
F : Traction Control  
Here are some additional symbols  
that may be found on the vehicle  
and what they mean. For more  
information on the symbol, refer to  
the index.  
. : Fuel Gage  
M : Windshield Washer Fluid  
9 : Airbag Readiness Light  
# : Air Conditioning  
+ : Fuses  
i : Headlamp High/Low-Beam  
Changer  
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
j : LATCH System Child Restraints  
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
: : Oil Pressure  
g : Audio Steering Wheel  
Controls or OnStar®  
$ : Brake System Warning Light  
" : Charging System  
I : Cruise Control  
} : Power  
/ : Remote Vehicle Start  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-1  
Seats and  
Restraint System  
Child Restraints  
Head Restraints  
Front Seats  
Restraint System Check  
Rear Seats  
Airbag System  
Safety Belts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2  
Seats and Restraint System  
Head Restraints  
The front and rear seats have  
adjustable head restraints in the  
outboard seating positions.  
{ CAUTION  
With head restraints that are not  
installed and adjusted properly,  
there is a greater chance that  
occupants will suffer a neck/spinal  
injury in a crash. Do not drive until  
the head restraints for all  
Adjust the head restraint so that the  
top of the restraint is at the same  
height as the top of the occupant’s  
head. This position reduces the  
chance of a neck injury in a crash.  
Pull the head restraint up to  
raise it. To lower the head restraint,  
press the button, located on the  
top of the seatback, and push the  
restraint down.  
occupants are installed and  
adjusted properly.  
Push down on the head restraint  
after the button is released to make  
sure that it is locked in place.  
The head restraints are not  
designed to be removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-3  
To move a manual seat forward or  
rearward:  
Active Head Restraint System  
Front Seats  
The vehicle has an active head  
restraint system in the front outboard  
seating positions. The active head  
restraints automatically tilt forward to  
reduce the risk of neck injury if  
the vehicle is hit from behind.  
Manual Seats  
{ CAUTION  
You can lose control of the  
vehicle if you try to adjust a  
manual driver’s seat while the  
vehicle is moving. The sudden  
movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a  
pedal when you do not want to.  
Adjust the driver’s seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
1. Lift the bar to unlock the seat.  
2. Slide the seat to the desired  
position and release the bar.  
Try to move the seat with your body  
to be sure the seat is locked in  
place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-4  
Seats and Restraint System  
Seat Height Adjuster  
Power Seat  
a : To adjust the seat:  
Raise or lower the front or rear part  
of the seat cushion.  
If the vehicle has a manual driver  
seat height adjuster, it is located on  
the outboard side of the seat  
Move the seat forward or rearward.  
near the front of the seat cushion.  
To raise the seat, move the  
lever upward repeatedly until the  
seat is at the desired height.  
To lower the seat, move the lever  
downward repeatedly until the  
seat is at the desired height.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-5  
Manual Lumbar  
M (Heated Seat): Press this  
button to turn on the heated seat.  
{ CAUTION  
The indicator light on the button  
shows that the feature is on and the  
level of heat, three being the  
highest. Press the button to choose  
the level of heat.  
If either seatback is not locked, it  
could move forward in a sudden  
stop or crash. That could cause  
injury to the person sitting there.  
Always push and pull on the  
seatbacks to be sure they are  
locked.  
The passenger seat may take  
longer to heat up.  
Reclining Seatbacks  
Manual Reclining Seatbacks  
If the vehicle has this feature, the  
knob is located on the inboard  
side of the driver seatback.  
{ CAUTION  
Turn the knob clockwise or  
counterclockwise to increase or  
decrease the lumbar support.  
You can lose control of the  
vehicle if you try to adjust a  
manual driver’s seat while the  
vehicle is moving. The sudden  
movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a  
pedal when you do not want to.  
Adjust the driver’s seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
Heated Seats  
On vehicles with heated front seats  
the controls are located on the center  
console. The engine must be running  
to operate the heated seats.  
On seats with manual reclining  
seatbacks, the lever used to operate  
them is located on the outboard  
side of the seat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-6  
Seats and Restraint System  
To recline the seatback:  
1. Lift the recline lever.  
Power Reclining Seatbacks  
{ CAUTION  
2. Move the seatback to the desired  
position, then release the lever to  
lock the seatback in place.  
Sitting in a reclined position when  
your vehicle is in motion can be  
dangerous. Even if you buckle up,  
your safety belts cannot do their  
job when you are reclined like this.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to  
make sure it is locked.  
The shoulder belt cannot do its job.  
In a crash, you could go into it,  
receiving neck or other injuries.  
To return the seatback to an upright  
position:  
1. Lift the lever fully without  
applying pressure to the  
The lap belt cannot do its job  
either. In a crash the belt could go  
up over your abdomen. The belt  
forces would be there, not at your  
pelvic bones. This could cause  
serious internal injuries.  
seatback and the seatback  
returns to the upright position.  
If the seats have power reclining  
seatbacks, the control used to  
recline them is located on the  
outboard side of the seat.  
2. Push and pull on the seatback to  
make sure it is locked.  
To recline the seatback, tilt the  
top of the control rearward.  
For proper protection when the  
vehicle is in motion, have the  
seatback upright. Then sit well  
back in the seat and wear your  
safety belt properly.  
To bring the seatback forward, tilt  
the top of the control forward.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-7  
Passenger Folding  
Seatback  
The front passenger seatback may  
fold flat.  
{ CAUTION  
Things you put on this seatback  
can strike and injure people in a  
sudden stop or turn, or in a crash.  
Remove or secure all items  
before driving.  
{ CAUTION  
If you fold the seatback forward to  
carry longer objects, such as skis,  
be sure any such cargo is not  
near an airbag. In a crash, an  
inflating airbag might force that  
object toward a person. This  
could cause severe injury or even  
death. Secure objects away from  
the area in which an airbag would  
inflate. For more information, see  
To fold the seatback:  
1. Lower the head restraint all  
the way.  
Do not have a seatback reclined if  
the vehicle is moving.  
2. Lift the bar under the front of the  
seat to unlock it. Slide the seat  
as far back as it will go and  
release the bar. Try to move the  
seat back and forth to make  
sure it is locked into place.  
page 1-44 and Loading the  
Vehicle on page 4-18.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-8  
Seats and Restraint System  
To raise the seatback:  
{ CAUTION  
1. Lift the recliner lever, located on  
the outboard side of the seat, up  
fully and push up on the  
seatback.  
If either seatback is not locked, it  
could move forward in a sudden  
stop or crash. That could cause  
injury to the person sitting there.  
Always push and pull on the  
seatbacks to be sure they are  
locked.  
2. Continue raising the seatback  
until the seatback re-engages.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to  
make sure it is locked in place.  
3. Lift the recliner lever, located on  
the outboard side of the seat, up  
fully and fold the seatback  
The recliner lever is also used to  
recline the seatback while a  
passenger is seated. See Reclining  
Seatbacks on page 1-5.  
forward until it disengages.  
4. Continue to fold the seat forward  
into the folded position.  
5. Pull up on the seatback to be  
sure it is locked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-9  
Rear Seats  
{ CAUTION  
Split Folding Rear Seat  
A safety belt that is improperly  
routed, not properly attached, or  
twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be  
seriously injured. After raising the  
rear seatback, always check to be  
sure that the safety belts are  
properly routed and attached, and  
are not twisted.  
The rear split bench seatbacks can  
be folded forward, upright, or  
partially reclined, independent of the  
other seatback position.  
2. Lift the lever located on the top  
{ CAUTION  
of the seatback to release the  
seatback and fold the seatback  
forward.  
If either seatback is not locked, it  
could move forward in a sudden  
stop or crash. That could cause  
injury to the person sitting there.  
Always push and pull on the  
seatbacks to be sure they are  
locked.  
To recline the seatback:  
To fold the seatback down:  
1. Lift and hold the lever located on  
top of the seatback.  
Notice: Folding a rear seat with  
the safety belts still fastened may  
cause damage to the seat or the  
safety belts. Always unbuckle the  
safety belts and return them to  
their normal stowed position  
before folding a rear seat.  
2. Tilt the seatback rearward, then  
release the lever.  
1. Unbuckle all three safety belts  
and put the front seatback in  
an upright position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-10  
Seats and Restraint System  
In most states and in all Canadian  
provinces, the law requires  
wearing safety belts. Here is why:  
Safety Belts  
{ CAUTION  
Safety Belts: They Are  
for Everyone  
This section of the manual describes  
how to use safety belts properly.  
It also describes some things not to  
do with safety belts.  
It is extremely dangerous to ride  
in a cargo area, inside or outside  
of a vehicle. In a collision, people  
riding in these areas are more  
likely to be seriously injured or  
killed. Do not allow people to ride  
in any area of your vehicle that is  
not equipped with seats and  
You never know if you will be  
in a crash. If you do have a crash,  
you do not know if it will be a  
serious one.  
A few crashes are mild, and some  
crashes can be so serious that even  
buckled up, a person would not  
survive. But most crashes are  
in between. In many of them, people  
who buckle up can survive and  
sometimes walk away. Without  
safety belts they could have been  
badly hurt or killed.  
{ CAUTION  
safety belts. Be sure everyone in  
your vehicle is in a seat and using  
a safety belt properly.  
Do not let anyone ride where a  
safety belt cannot be worn  
properly. In a crash, if you or your  
passenger(s) are not wearing  
safety belts, the injuries can be  
much worse. You can hit things  
inside the vehicle harder or be  
ejected from the vehicle. You and  
your passenger(s) can be seriously  
injured or killed. In the same crash,  
you might not be, if you are  
buckled up. Always fasten your  
safety belt, and check that your  
passenger(s) are restrained  
properly too.  
This vehicle has indicators as a  
reminder to buckle the safety belts.  
page 3-24 for additional information.  
After more than 40 years of safety  
belts in vehicles, the facts are clear.  
In most crashes buckling up does  
matter... a lot!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-11  
Why Safety Belts Work  
When you ride in or on anything,  
you go as fast as it goes.  
Put someone on it.  
The person keeps going until  
stopped by something. In a real  
vehicle, it could be the windshield...  
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose  
it is just a seat on wheels.  
Get it up to speed. Then stop the  
vehicle. The rider does not stop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-12  
Seats and Restraint System  
With safety belts, you slow down as  
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why  
should I have to wear safety  
belts?  
the vehicle does. You get more  
time to stop. You stop over more  
distance, and your strongest bones  
take the forces. That is why  
A: Airbags are supplemental  
systems only; so they work with  
safety belts — not instead of  
them. Whether or not an airbag  
is provided, all occupants  
still have to buckle up to get the  
most protection. That is true  
not only in frontal collisions, but  
especially in side and other  
collisions.  
safety belts make such good sense.  
Questions and Answers  
About Safety Belts  
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle  
after a crash if I am wearing a  
safety belt?  
A: You could be — whether you are  
wearing a safety belt or not. But  
your chance of being conscious  
during and after an accident, so  
you can unbuckle and get out, is  
much greater if you are belted.  
And you can unbuckle a safety  
belt, even if you are upside down.  
or the instrument panel...  
or the safety belts!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-13  
First, before you or your  
Q: If I am a good driver, and I  
never drive far from home,  
why should I wear safety  
belts?  
How to Wear Safety Belts  
Properly  
This section is only for people of  
adult size.  
passenger(s) wear a safety belt,  
there is important information  
you should know.  
A: You may be an excellent driver,  
but if you are in a crash — even  
one that is not your fault — you  
and your passenger(s) can be  
hurt. Being a good driver does not  
protect you from things beyond  
your control, such as bad drivers.  
Be aware that there are special  
things to know about safety  
belts and children. And there are  
different rules for smaller children  
and infants. If a child will be riding in  
the vehicle, see Older Children on  
Children on page 1-25. Follow those  
rules for everyone’s protection.  
Most accidents occur within  
25 miles (40 km) of home. And  
the greatest number of  
serious injuries and deaths occur  
at speeds of less than 40 mph  
(65 km/h).  
It is very important for all occupants  
to buckle up. Statistics show that  
unbelted people are hurt more often  
in crashes than those who are  
wearing safety belts.  
Sit up straight and always keep your  
feet on the floor in front of you.  
The lap part of the belt should be  
worn low and snug on the hips, just  
touching the thighs. In a crash,  
this applies force to the strong pelvic  
bones and you would be less  
likely to slide under the lap belt. If  
you slid under it, the belt would  
apply force on your abdomen. This  
could cause serious or even  
Safety belts are for everyone.  
Occupants who are not buckled up  
can be thrown out of the vehicle  
in a crash. And they can strike  
others in the vehicle who are  
wearing safety belts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-14  
Seats and Restraint System  
fatal injuries. The shoulder belt  
should go over the shoulder  
and across the chest. These parts  
of the body are best able to take belt  
restraining forces.  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
You can be seriously hurt if your  
shoulder belt is too loose. In a  
crash, you would move forward  
too much, which could increase  
injury. The shoulder belt should fit  
snugly against your body.  
You can be seriously hurt if your  
lap belt is too loose. In a crash,  
you could slide under the lap belt  
and apply force on your abdomen.  
This could cause serious or even  
fatal injuries. The lap belt should  
be worn low and snug on the  
hips, just touching the thighs.  
The shoulder belt locks if there is a  
sudden stop or crash.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
A: The shoulder belt is too loose. It  
will not give as much protection  
this way.  
A: The lap belt is too loose. It will  
not give nearly as much  
protection this way.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-15  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
You can be seriously injured if  
your belt is buckled in the wrong  
place like this. In a crash, the belt  
would go up over your abdomen.  
The belt forces would be there,  
not on the pelvic bones. This  
could cause serious internal  
You can be seriously injured if  
your belt goes over an armrest  
like this. The belt would be much  
too high. In a crash, you can slide  
under the belt. The belt force  
would then be applied on the  
abdomen, not on the pelvic  
injuries. Always buckle your belt  
into the buckle nearest you.  
bones, and that could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. Be sure  
the belt goes under the armrests.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong  
buckle.  
A: The belt is over an armrest.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-16  
Seats and Restraint System  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
{ CAUTION  
You can be seriously injured if  
you wear the shoulder belt under  
your arm. In a crash, your body  
would move too far forward, which  
would increase the chance of  
head and neck injury. Also, the  
belt would apply too much force  
to the ribs, which are not as  
strong as shoulder bones. You  
could also severely injure internal  
organs like your liver or spleen.  
The shoulder belt should go over  
the shoulder and across the  
chest.  
A: The shoulder belt is worn under  
the arm. It should be worn over  
the shoulder at all times.  
A: The belt is behind the body.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-17  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
All seating positions in the vehicle  
have a lap-shoulder belt.  
{ CAUTION  
You can be seriously injured by  
not wearing the lap-shoulder belt  
properly. In a crash, you would  
not be restrained by the shoulder  
belt. Your body could move too  
far forward increasing the chance  
of head and neck injury. You  
might also slide under the lap  
belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen.  
That could cause serious or fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across  
the chest.  
The following instructions explain  
how to wear a lap-shoulder belt  
properly.  
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is  
adjustable, so you can sit up  
straight. To see how, see “Seats”  
in the Index.  
A: The belt is twisted across  
the body.  
{ CAUTION  
You can be seriously injured by a  
twisted belt. In a crash, you would  
not have the full width of the belt  
to spread impact forces. If a belt  
is twisted, make it straight so it  
can work properly, or ask your  
dealer/retailer to fix it.  
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull  
the belt across you. Do not let  
it get twisted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-18  
Seats and Restraint System  
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if  
you pull the belt across you  
very quickly. If this happens, let  
the belt go back slightly to  
unlock it. Then pull the belt  
across you more slowly.  
Adjustment” later in this section  
for instructions on use and  
important safety information.  
If the shoulder portion of a  
passenger belt is pulled out all  
the way, the child restraint  
locking feature may be engaged.  
If this happens, let the belt go  
back all the way and start again.  
Engaging the child restraint  
locking feature in the right front  
seating position may affect  
the passenger sensing system.  
System on page 1-49 for more  
information.  
3. Push the latch plate into the  
buckle until it clicks.  
Pull up on the latch plate to  
make sure it is secure. If the belt  
is not long enough, see Safety  
Belt Extender on page 1-22.  
5. To make the lap part tight, pull  
up on the shoulder belt.  
It may be necessary to pull the  
stitching on the safety belt  
through the latch plate to fully  
tighten the lap belt on smaller  
occupants.  
Position the release button on  
the buckle so that the safety belt  
could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
4. If equipped with a shoulder belt  
height adjuster, move it to the  
height that is right for you.  
See “Shoulder Belt Height  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-19  
Before a door is closed, be sure the  
safety belt is out of the way. If a  
door is slammed against a safety  
belt, damage can occur to both the  
safety belt and the vehicle.  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster  
The vehicle has a shoulder belt  
height adjuster for the driver  
and right front passenger seating  
positions.  
Adjust the height so that the  
shoulder portion of the belt is  
centered on the shoulder. The belt  
should be away from the face  
and neck, but not falling off of the  
shoulder. Improper shoulder  
belt height adjustment could reduce  
the effectiveness of the safety  
belt in a crash.  
To unlatch the belt, push the button  
on the buckle. The belt should  
return to its stowed position. Slide  
the latch plate up the safety  
belt webbing when the safety belt is  
not in use. The latch plate should  
rest on the stitching on the  
Squeeze the release buttons (A)  
together and move the height  
adjuster up or down to the desired  
position.  
After the adjuster is set to the  
desired position, try to move it up or  
down without squeezing the release  
buttons to make sure it has locked  
into position.  
safety belt, near the guide loop on  
the side wall.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-20  
Seats and Restraint System  
Safety Belt Pretensioners  
Rear Safety Belt Comfort  
Guides  
This vehicle has safety belt  
pretensioners for the front outboard  
occupants. Although the safety  
belt pretensioners cannot be seen,  
they are part of the safety belt  
assembly. They can help tighten the  
safety belts during the early  
stages of a moderate to severe  
frontal, near frontal, or rear crash if  
the threshold conditions for  
pretensioner activation are met.  
And, for vehicles with side impact  
airbags, safety belt pretensioners  
can help tighten the safety belts in a  
side crash or a rollover event.  
Rear shoulder belt comfort guides  
may provide added safety belt  
comfort for older children who have  
outgrown booster seats and for  
some adults. When installed on a  
shoulder belt, the comfort guide  
positions the shoulder belt away  
from the neck and head.  
There is one guide for each  
outboard passenger position in the  
rear seat. Here is how to install  
a comfort guide to the safety belt:  
2. Place the guide over the belt and  
insert the two edges of the belt  
into the slots of the guide.  
1. Remove the guide from its  
storage location, which is a  
pocket on the side of the seat.  
Pretensioners work only once. If the  
pretensioners activate in a crash,  
they will need to be replaced,  
and probably other new parts for the  
vehicle’s safety belt system. See  
Parts After a Crash on page 1-57.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-21  
{ CAUTION  
A safety belt that is not properly  
worn may not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be  
seriously injured. The shoulder  
belt should go over the shoulder  
and across the chest. These parts  
of the body are best able to take  
belt restraining forces.  
3. Be sure that the belt is not  
twisted and it lies flat. The elastic  
cord must be under the belt  
and the guide on top.  
4. Buckle, position, and release the  
safety belt as described  
previously in this section. Make  
sure that the shoulder belt  
crosses the shoulder.  
To remove and store the comfort  
guide, squeeze the belt edges  
together so that the safety belt can  
be removed from the guide.  
Store the comfort guide in its  
storage location, which is a pocket  
on the side of the seat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-22  
Seats and Restraint System  
The best way to protect the fetus is to  
protect the mother. When a safety  
belt is worn properly, it is more likely  
that the fetus will not be hurt in a  
crash. For pregnant women, as for  
anyone, the key to making safety  
belts effective is wearing them  
properly.  
Safety Belt Use During  
Pregnancy  
Safety belts work for everyone,  
including pregnant women. Like all  
occupants, they are more likely  
to be seriously injured if they do not  
wear safety belts.  
Child Restraints  
Older Children  
Safety Belt Extender  
If the safety belt will fasten around  
you, you should use it.  
But if a safety belt is not long  
enough, your dealer/retailer will  
order you an extender. When you go  
in to order it, take the heaviest  
coat you will wear, so the extender  
will be long enough for you. To  
help avoid personal injury, do not let  
someone else use it, and use it  
only for the seat it is made to fit. The  
extender has been designed for  
adults. Never use it for securing  
child seats. To wear it, attach it to  
the regular safety belt. For more  
information, see the instruction  
sheet that comes with the extender.  
Older children who have outgrown  
booster seats should wear the  
vehicle’s safety belts.  
A pregnant woman should wear a  
lap-shoulder belt, and the lap portion  
should be worn as low as possible,  
below the rounding, throughout  
the pregnancy.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-23  
The manufacturer’s instructions that  
come with the booster seat, state  
the weight and height limitations for  
that booster. Use a booster seat  
with a lap-shoulder belt until  
Also see “Rear Safety Belt Comfort  
Guides” under Lap-Shoulder Belt  
on page 1-17.  
Can proper safety belt fit be  
maintained for the length of  
the trip? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
According to accident statistics,  
children and infants are safer when  
properly restrained in a child  
restraint system or infant restraint  
system secured in a rear seating  
position.  
Q: What is the proper way to  
wear safety belts?  
the child passes the below fit test:  
Sit all the way back on the  
A: An older child should wear a  
lap-shoulder belt and get the  
additional restraint a shoulder  
belt can provide. The shoulder  
belt should not cross the face or  
neck. The lap belt should fit  
snugly below the hips, just  
seat. Do the knees bend at the  
seat edge? If yes, continue.  
If no, return to the booster seat.  
In a crash, children who are not  
buckled up can strike other people  
who are buckled up, or can be  
thrown out of the vehicle. Older  
children need to use safety  
belts properly.  
Buckle the lap-shoulder  
belt. Does the shoulder belt rest  
on the shoulder? If yes,  
continue. If no, try using the rear  
safety belt comfort guide. See  
“Rear Safety Belt Comfort  
touching the top of the thighs.  
This applies belt force to  
the child’s pelvic bones in a  
crash. It should never be worn  
over the abdomen, which  
could cause severe or even fatal  
internal injuries in a crash.  
Guides” under Lap-Shoulder Belt  
on page 1-17 for more  
information. If the shoulder belt  
still does not rest on the shoulder,  
then return to the booster seat.  
Does the lap belt fit low and snug  
on the hips, touching the thighs?  
If yes, continue. If no, return  
to the booster seat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-24  
Seats and Restraint System  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Never do this.  
Never do this.  
Never allow two children to wear  
the same safety belt. The safety  
belt can not properly spread the  
impact forces. In a crash, the two  
children can be crushed together  
and seriously injured. A safety  
belt must be used by only one  
person at a time.  
Never allow a child to wear the  
safety belt with the shoulder belt  
behind their back. A child can be  
seriously injured by not wearing  
the lap-shoulder belt properly. In a  
crash, the child would not be  
restrained by the shoulder belt.  
The child could move too far  
forward increasing the chance of  
head and neck injury. The child  
might also slide under the lap  
belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen.  
That could cause serious or fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across  
the chest.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-25  
Airbags plus lap-shoulder belts offer  
Infants and Young  
Children  
CAUTION (Continued)  
protection for adults and older  
children, but not for young children  
and infants. Neither the vehicle’s  
safety belt system nor its airbag  
system is designed for them. Every  
time infants and young children  
ride in vehicles, they should have  
the protection provided by  
For example, in a crash at only  
25 mph (40 km/h), a 12 lb (5.5 kg)  
infant will suddenly become a  
240 lb (110 kg) force on a  
person’s arms. An infant should  
be secured in an appropriate  
restraint.  
Everyone in a vehicle needs  
protection! This includes infants and  
all other children. Neither the  
distance traveled nor the age and  
size of the traveler changes the  
need, for everyone, to use safety  
restraints. In fact, the law in  
appropriate child restraints.  
every state in the United States and  
in every Canadian province says  
children up to some age must  
be restrained while in a vehicle.  
Children who are not restrained  
properly can strike other people, or  
can be thrown out of the vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Never do this.  
Children can be seriously injured  
or strangled if a shoulder belt is  
wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to  
tighten. Never leave children  
unattended in a vehicle and never  
allow children to play with the  
safety belts.  
Never hold an infant or a child  
while riding in a vehicle. Due to  
crash forces, an infant or a child  
will become so heavy it is not  
possible to hold it during a crash.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-26  
Seats and Restraint System  
For most basic types of child  
restraints, there are many  
{ CAUTION  
different models available. When  
purchasing a child restraint,  
be sure it is designed to be used  
in a motor vehicle. If it is, the  
restraint will have a label saying  
that it meets federal motor  
vehicle safety standards.  
Never do this.  
Children who are up against, or  
very close to, any airbag when it  
inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Never put a rear-facing  
child restraint in the right front  
seat. Secure a rear-facing child  
restraint in a rear seat. It is also  
better to secure a forward-facing  
child restraint in a rear seat. If you  
must secure a forward-facing child  
restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger  
seat as far back as it will go.  
The restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions that come with the  
restraint state the weight and  
height limitations for a particular  
child restraint. In addition, there  
are many kinds of restraints  
available for children with special  
needs.  
Q: What are the different types of  
add-on child restraints?  
A: Add-on child restraints, which  
are purchased by the vehicle’s  
owner, are available in four  
basic types. Selection of a  
particular restraint should take  
into consideration not only the  
child’s weight, height, and age but  
also whether or not the restraint  
will be compatible with the motor  
vehicle in which it will be used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-27  
Child Restraint Systems  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
To reduce the risk of neck and  
head injury during a crash, infants  
need complete support. This is  
because an infant’s neck is not  
fully developed and its head  
weighs so much compared with  
the rest of its body. In a crash, an  
infant in a rear-facing child  
A young child’s hip bones are still  
so small that the vehicle’s regular  
safety belt may not remain low on  
the hip bones, as it should.  
Instead, it may settle up around  
the child’s abdomen. In a crash,  
the belt would apply force on a  
body area that is unprotected by  
any bony structure. This alone  
could cause serious or fatal  
injuries. To reduce the risk of  
serious or fatal injuries during a  
crash, young children should  
always be secured in appropriate  
child restraints.  
restraint settles into the restraint,  
so the crash forces can be  
distributed across the strongest  
part of an infant’s body, the back  
and shoulders. Infants should  
always be secured in rear-facing  
child restraints.  
(A) Rear-Facing Infant Seat  
A rear-facing infant seat (A) provides  
restraint with the seating surface  
against the back of the infant.  
The harness system holds the infant  
in place and, in a crash, acts to  
keep the infant positioned in  
the restraint.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-28  
Seats and Restraint System  
Securing an Add-On Child  
Restraint in the Vehicle  
{ CAUTION  
A child can be seriously injured or  
killed in a crash if the child  
restraint is not properly secured in  
the vehicle. Secure the child  
restraint properly in the vehicle  
using the vehicle’s safety belt or  
LATCH system, following the  
instructions that came with that  
child restraint and the instructions  
in this manual.  
(C) Booster Seats  
(B) Forward-Facing Child Seat  
A booster seat (C) is a child  
A forward-facing child seat (B)  
provides restraint for the child’s body  
with the harness.  
restraint designed to improve the fit  
of the vehicle’s safety belt system.  
A booster seat can also help a child  
to see out the window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-29  
To help reduce the chance of injury,  
the child restraint must be secured  
in the vehicle. Child restraint  
systems must be secured in vehicle  
seats by lap belts or the lap belt  
portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by  
the LATCH system. See Lower  
(LATCH) on page 1-31 for more  
information. A child can be  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child  
Where to Put the  
Restraint  
According to accident statistics,  
children and infants are safer when  
properly restrained in a child  
restraint system or infant restraint  
system secured in a rear seating  
position.  
restraint can move around in a  
collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to  
properly secure any child restraint in  
the vehicle — even when no child is  
in it.  
Securing the Child Within the  
Child Restraint  
We recommend that children and  
child restraints be secured in a rear  
seat, including: an infant or a child  
riding in a rear-facing child restraint;  
a child riding in a forward-facing child  
seat; an older child riding in a booster  
seat; and children, who are large  
enough, using safety belts.  
endangered in a crash if the child  
restraint is not properly secured  
in the vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
A child can be seriously injured or  
killed in a crash if the child is not  
properly secured in the child  
restraint. Secure the child properly  
following the instructions that  
came with that child restraint.  
When securing an add-on child  
restraint, refer to the instructions that  
come with the restraint which may  
be on the restraint itself or in a  
booklet, or both, and to this manual.  
The child restraint instructions are  
important, so if they are not  
available, obtain a replacement  
copy from the manufacturer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-30  
Seats and Restraint System  
A label on the sun visor says,  
“Never put a rear-facing child  
restraint in the front.” This is  
because the risk to the rear-facing  
child is so great, if the airbag  
deploys.  
If the vehicle does not have a rear  
seat that will accommodate a  
rear-facing child restraint, a  
rear-facing child restraint should not  
be installed in the vehicle, even if  
the airbag is off.  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Even if the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can  
guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is  
turned off.  
When securing a child restraint in a  
rear seating position, study the  
instructions that came with your child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible  
with this vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
A child in a rear-facing child  
restraint can be seriously injured or  
killed if the right front passenger  
airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child  
restraint would be very close to the  
inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can  
be seriously injured or killed if the  
right front passenger airbag  
Secure rear-facing child restraints  
in a rear seat, even if the airbag is  
off. If you secure a forward-facing  
child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger  
seat as far back as it will go. It is  
better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
Wherever a child restraint is  
installed, be sure to secure the child  
restraint properly.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child  
restraint can move around in a  
collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to  
properly secure any child restraint in  
the vehicle — even when no child  
is in it.  
inflates and the passenger seat is  
in a forward position.  
on page 1-49 for additional  
information.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-31  
In order to use the LATCH system  
in your vehicle, you need a child  
restraint that has LATCH  
attachments. The child restraint  
manufacturer will provide you with  
instructions on how to use the  
child restraint and its attachments.  
The following explains how to attach  
a child restraint with these  
Lower Anchors  
Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children  
(LATCH)  
The LATCH system holds a child  
restraint during driving or in a crash.  
This system is designed to make  
installation of a child restraint easier.  
The LATCH system uses anchors  
in the vehicle and attachments  
Lower anchors (A) are metal  
attachments in your vehicle.  
bars built into the vehicle. There  
are two lower anchors for each  
LATCH seating position that will  
accommodate a child restraint with  
lower attachments (B).  
on the child restraint that are made  
for use with the LATCH system.  
Not all vehicle seating positions or  
child restraints have lower anchors  
and attachments or top tether  
anchors and attachments.  
Make sure that a LATCH-compatible  
child restraint is properly installed  
using the anchors, or use the  
vehicle’s safety belts to secure the  
restraint, following the instructions  
that came with that restraint, and  
also the instructions in this manual.  
When installing a child restraint with  
a top tether, you must also use either  
the lower anchors or the safety belts  
to properly secure the child restraint.  
A child restraint must never be  
installed using only the top tether  
and anchor.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-32  
Seats and Restraint System  
Top Tether Anchor  
Your child restraint may have  
a single tether (A) or a dual  
tether (C). Either will have a single  
attachment (B) to secure the top  
tether to the anchor.  
Lower Anchor and Top Tether  
Anchor Locations  
Some child restraints that have top  
tethers are designed for use  
with or without the top tether being  
attached. Others require the top  
tether always to be attached.  
In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have  
a top tether, and that the tether  
be attached. Be sure to read and  
follow the instructions for your  
child restraint.  
A top tether (A, C) anchors the top  
of the child restraint to the  
vehicle. A top tether anchor is built  
into the vehicle. The top tether  
attachment (B) on the child restraint  
connects to the top tether anchor  
in the vehicle in order to reduce the  
forward movement and rotation  
of the child restraint during driving  
or in a crash.  
Rear Seat  
i (Top Tether Anchor): Seating  
positions with top tether anchors.  
If the child restraint does not have a  
top tether, one can be obtained,  
in kit form, for many child restraints.  
Ask the child restraint manufacturer  
whether or not a kit is available.  
j (Lower Anchor): Seating positions  
with two lower anchors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-33  
The top tether anchors are located  
on the back of the rear seatback.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on  
the same side of the vehicle as  
the seating position where the child  
restraint will be placed.  
Accident statistics show that children  
are safer if they are restrained in the  
rear rather than the front seat. See  
page 1-29 for additional information.  
To assist you in locating the lower  
anchors, each seating position  
with lower anchors has two labels,  
near the crease between the  
seatback and the seat cushion.  
To assist you in locating the top  
tether anchors, the top tether anchor  
symbol is located near the top  
tether anchors.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a  
position without a top tether  
anchor if a national or local law  
requires that the top tether be  
attached, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that  
the top tether must be attached.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-34  
Seats and Restraint System  
Securing a Child Restraint  
Designed for the LATCH System  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Do not attach more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor.  
Children can be seriously injured  
or strangled if a shoulder belt is  
wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to  
tighten. Buckle any unused safety  
belts behind the child restraint so  
children cannot reach them. Pull  
the shoulder belt all the way out  
of the retractor to set the lock, if  
your vehicle has one, after the  
child restraint has been installed.  
{ CAUTION  
Attaching more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor could  
cause the anchor or attachment to  
come loose or even break during a  
crash. A child or others could be  
injured. To reduce the risk of  
serious or fatal injuries during a  
crash, attach only one child  
If a LATCH-type child restraint is  
not attached to anchors, the child  
restraint will not be able to protect  
the child correctly. In a crash, the  
child could be seriously injured or  
killed. Install a LATCH-type child  
restraint properly using the  
anchors, or use the vehicle’s  
restraint per anchor.  
safety belts to secure the restraint,  
following the instructions that came  
with the child restraint and the  
instructions in this manual.  
Notice: Do not let the LATCH  
attachments rub against the  
vehicle’s safety belts. This may  
damage these parts. If necessary,  
move buckled safety belts to  
avoid rubbing the LATCH  
attachments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-35  
Do not fold the empty rear seat  
with a safety belt buckled. This  
could damage the safety belt or  
the seat. Unbuckle and return the  
safety belt to its stowed position,  
before folding the seat.  
2. If the child restraint manufacturer  
recommends that the top tether  
be attached, attach and tighten  
the top tether to the top tether  
anchor, if equipped. Refer to the  
child restraint instructions and the  
following steps:  
1. Attach and tighten the lower  
attachments to the lower  
2.1. Find the top tether anchor.  
anchors. If the child restraint  
does not have lower attachments  
or the desired seating position  
does not have lower anchors,  
secure the child restraint with the  
top tether and the safety belts.  
Refer to your child restraint  
manufacturer instructions and the  
instructions in this manual.  
If the position you are using  
does not have a headrest  
or head restraint and  
you are using a dual tether,  
route the tether over the  
seatback.  
2.2. Route, attach, and tighten  
the top tether according to  
your child restraint  
instructions and the  
following instructions:  
1.1. Find the lower anchors for  
the desired seating position.  
1.2. Put the child restraint on  
the seat.  
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower  
attachments on the child  
restraint to the lower  
anchors.  
If the position you are using  
does not have a headrest or  
head restraint and you are  
using a single tether, route  
the tether over the seatback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-36  
Seats and Restraint System  
Securing a Child  
Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position  
When securing a child restraint in a  
rear seating position, study the  
instructions that came with the child  
restraint to make sure it is  
compatible with this vehicle.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH  
on page 1-31 for how and where to  
install the child restraint using  
LATCH. If a child restraint is secured  
in the vehicle using a safety belt  
and it uses a top tether, see Lower  
(LATCH) on page 1-31 for top tether  
anchor locations.  
If the position you are using  
has an adjustable headrest  
or head restraint and  
you are using a dual tether,  
route the tether around  
the headrest or head  
restraint.  
If the position you are using  
has an adjustable headrest  
or head restraint and  
you are using a single  
tether, raise the headrest or  
head restraint and route  
the tether under the  
headrest or head restraint  
and in between the headrest  
or head restraint posts.  
Do not secure a child seat in a  
position without a top tether anchor  
if a national or local law requires  
that the top tether be anchored, or if  
the instructions that come with  
the child restraint say that the top  
strap must be anchored.  
3. Push and pull the child restraint  
in different directions to be sure  
it is secure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-37  
In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have  
a top tether, and that the tether  
be attached.  
If the child restraint does not have  
the LATCH system, you will be using  
the safety belt to secure the child  
restraint in this position. Be sure to  
follow the instructions that came  
with the child restraint. Secure the  
child in the child restraint when  
and as the instructions say.  
3. Push the latch plate into the  
buckle until it clicks.  
4. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt  
If more than one child restraint  
needs to be installed in the  
rear seat, be sure to read Where to  
Put the Restraint on page 1-29.  
all the way out of the retractor to  
set the lock.  
Position the release button on  
the buckle so that the safety belt  
could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
1. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
2. Pick up the latch plate, and  
run the lap and shoulder portions  
of the vehicle’s safety belt  
through or around the restraint.  
The child restraint instructions  
will show you how.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-38  
Seats and Restraint System  
6. If the child restraint has a top  
Securing a Child  
tether, follow the child restraint  
manufacturer’s instructions  
regarding the use of the top  
on page 1-31 for more  
Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position  
The vehicle has airbags. A rear seat  
is a safer place to secure a  
forward-facing child restraint. See  
page 1-29.  
information.  
7. Push and pull the child restraint  
in different directions to be sure  
it is secure.  
In addition, the vehicle has a  
passenger sensing system which is  
designed to turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag under  
certain conditions. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 1-49  
Indicator on page 3-26 for more  
information, including important  
safety information.  
To remove the child restraint,  
5. To tighten the belt, push down  
on the child restraint, pull the  
shoulder portion of the belt  
to tighten the lap portion of the  
belt and feed the shoulder  
belt back into the retractor. When  
installing a forward-facing child  
restraint, it may be helpful to use  
your knee to push down on  
the child restraint as you tighten  
the belt.  
unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and  
let it return to the stowed position.  
If the top tether is attached to a top  
tether anchor, disconnect it.  
A label on the sun visor says,  
“Never put a rear-facing child seat  
in the front.” This is because the risk  
to the rear-facing child is so great,  
if the airbag deploys.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-39  
If the child restraint has the LATCH  
on page 1-31 for how and where to  
install the child restraint using  
LATCH. If a child restraint is secured  
using a safety belt and it uses a  
top tether, see Lower Anchors and  
on page 1-31 for top tether anchor  
locations.  
{ CAUTION  
CAUTION (Continued)  
A child in a rear-facing child  
restraint can be seriously injured  
or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is  
because the back of the  
rear-facing child restraint would  
be very close to the inflating  
airbag. A child in a forward-facing  
child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates and the  
passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints  
in a rear seat, even if the airbag is  
off. If you secure a forward-facing  
child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger  
seat as far back as it will go. It is  
better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
Do not secure a child seat in a  
position without a top tether anchor  
if a national or local law requires  
that the top tether be anchored, or if  
the instructions that come with  
the child restraint say that the top  
strap must be anchored.  
on page 1-49 for additional  
information.  
If the vehicle does not have a rear  
seat that will accommodate a  
rear-facing child restraint, a  
rear-facing child restraint should not  
be installed in the vehicle, even if  
the airbag is off.  
Even if the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can  
guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is  
turned off.  
In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have  
a top tether, and that the tether  
be attached.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-40  
Seats and Restraint System  
You will be using the lap-shoulder  
belt to secure the child restraint in  
this position. Follow the instructions  
that came with the child restraint.  
1. Move the seat as far back as it  
will go before securing the  
forward-facing child restraint.  
When the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the  
right front passenger frontal  
airbag, the off indicator on the  
passenger airbag status indicator  
should light and stay lit when  
the vehicle is started. See  
4. Push the latch plate into the  
buckle until it clicks.  
5. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt  
all the way out of the retractor to  
set the lock.  
Position the release button on  
the buckle so that the safety belt  
could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
Indicator on page 3-26.  
2. Put the child restraint on  
the seat.  
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run  
the lap and shoulder portions of  
the vehicle’s safety belt  
through or around the restraint.  
The child restraint instructions  
will show you how.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-41  
7. If the vehicle does not have a  
Airbag System  
The vehicle has the following  
airbags:  
rear seat and the child restraint  
has a top tether, follow the  
child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions regarding the use  
of the top tether. See Lower  
(LATCH) on page 1-31 for  
more information.  
A frontal airbag for the driver.  
A frontal airbag for the right front  
passenger.  
A seat-mounted side impact  
airbag for the driver.  
8. Push and pull the child restraint  
in different directions to be sure  
it is secure.  
A seat-mounted side impact  
airbag for the right front  
passenger.  
6. To tighten the belt, push down  
on the child restraint, pull the  
shoulder portion of the belt  
to tighten the lap portion of the  
belt and feed the shoulder  
belt back into the retractor. When  
installing a forward-facing child  
restraint, it may be helpful to use  
your knee to push down on  
the child restraint as you tighten  
the belt.  
If the airbag is off, the off indicator  
in the passenger airbag status  
indicator will come on and stay on  
when the vehicle is started.  
A roof-rail airbag for the driver  
and the passenger seated  
directly behind the driver.  
A roof-rail airbag for the right  
front passenger and the  
If a child restraint has been  
installed and the on indicator is lit,  
see “If the On Indicator is Lit for a  
Child Restraint ” under Passenger  
Sensing System on page 1-49 for  
more information.  
passenger seated directly behind  
the right front passenger.  
All of the airbags in the vehicle will  
have the word AIRBAG embossed  
in the trim or on an attached  
To remove the child restraint,  
unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and  
let it return to the stowed position.  
label near the deployment opening.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-42  
Seats and Restraint System  
For frontal airbags, the word  
Here are the most important things  
to know about the airbag system:  
{ CAUTION  
AIRBAG will appear on the middle  
part of the steering wheel for  
the driver and on the instrument  
panel for the right front passenger.  
Be sure that cargo is not near an  
airbag. In a crash, an inflating  
airbag might force that object  
toward a person. This could  
cause severe injury or even  
death. Secure objects away from  
the area in which an airbag would  
inflate. For more information, see  
page 1-44 and Loading the  
Vehicle on page 4-18.  
{ CAUTION  
You can be severely injured or  
killed in a crash if you are not  
wearing your safety belt — even if  
you have airbags. Airbags are  
designed to work with safety  
belts, but do not replace them.  
Also, airbags are not designed to  
deploy in every crash. In some  
crashes safety belts are your only  
restraint. See When Should an  
Airbag Inflate? on page 1-45.  
With seat-mounted side impact  
airbags, the word AIRBAG  
will appear on the side of the  
seatback closest to the door.  
With roof-rail airbags, the word  
AIRBAG will appear along the  
headliner or trim.  
Even if you do not have a right front  
passenger seat in the vehicle  
there is still an active frontal airbag  
in the right side of the instrument  
panel. Do not place cargo in front of  
this airbag.  
Airbags are designed to supplement  
the protection provided by safety  
belts. Even though today’s airbags  
are also designed to help reduce  
the risk of injury from the force of an  
inflating bag, all airbags must  
Wearing your safety belt during a  
crash helps reduce your chance  
of hitting things inside the vehicle  
or being ejected from it. Airbags  
are “supplemental restraints” to  
the safety belts. Everyone in your  
vehicle should wear a safety belt  
properly — whether or not there is  
an airbag for that person.  
inflate very quickly to do their job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-43  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Airbags inflate with great force,  
faster than the blink of an eye.  
Anyone who is up against, or very  
close to, any airbag when it  
inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Do not sit unnecessarily  
close to the airbag, as you would  
be if you were sitting on the edge  
of your seat or leaning forward.  
Safety belts help keep you in  
position before and during a  
crash. Always wear your safety  
belt, even with airbags. The driver  
should sit as far back as possible  
while still maintaining control of  
the vehicle.  
Children who are up against, or  
very close to, any airbag when it  
inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Airbags plus lap-shoulder  
belts offer protection for adults  
and older children, but not for  
young children and infants.  
Neither the vehicle’s safety belt  
system nor its airbag system is  
designed for them. Young children  
and infants need the protection  
that a child restraint system can  
provide. Always secure children  
properly in your vehicle. To read  
how, see Older Children on  
There is ass light  
on the instrument panel cluster,  
which shows the airbag symbol.  
The system checks the airbag  
electrical system for malfunctions.  
The light tells you if there is an  
electrical problem. See Airbag  
Readiness Light on page 3-25 for  
more information.  
Children on page 1-25.  
Occupants should not lean on or  
sleep against the door or side  
windows in seating positions with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags  
and/or roof-rail airbags.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-44  
Seats and Restraint System  
Where Are the Airbags?  
The right front passenger frontal  
airbag is in the instrument panel on  
the passenger side.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger  
Side similar  
The driver frontal airbag is in the  
middle of the steering wheel.  
The seat-mounted side impact  
airbags for the driver and right front  
passenger are in the side of the  
seatbacks closest to the door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-45  
When Should an Airbag  
Inflate?  
{ CAUTION  
If something is between an  
occupant and an airbag, the  
airbag might not inflate properly or  
it might force the object into that  
person causing severe injury or  
even death. The path of an  
inflating airbag must be kept  
clear. Do not put anything  
between an occupant and an  
airbag, and do not attach or put  
anything on the steering wheel  
hub or on or near any other  
airbag covering.  
Frontal airbags are designed to  
inflate in moderate to severe frontal  
or near-frontal crashes to help  
reduce the potential for severe  
injuries mainly to the driver’s or right  
front passenger’s head and chest.  
However, they are only designed to  
inflate if the impact exceeds a  
predetermined deployment  
threshold. Deployment thresholds  
are used to predict how severe a  
crash is likely to be in time for the  
airbags to inflate and help restrain  
the occupants.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger  
Side similar  
The roof-rail airbags for the driver,  
right front passenger, and second  
row outboard passengers are in the  
ceiling above the side windows.  
Do not use seat accessories that  
block the inflation path of a  
seat-mounted side impact airbag.  
Whether the frontal airbags will or  
should deploy is not based on  
how fast your vehicle is traveling. It  
depends largely on what you hit,  
the direction of the impact, and how  
quickly your vehicle slows down.  
Never secure anything to the roof  
of a vehicle with roof-rail airbags  
by routing a rope or tie down  
through any door or window  
opening. If you do, the path of an  
inflating roof-rail airbag will be  
blocked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-46  
Seats and Restraint System  
Frontal airbags may inflate at  
different crash speeds. For example:  
Frontal airbags are not intended to  
inflate during vehicle rollovers, rear  
impacts, or in many side impacts.  
system’s designed threshold level.  
The threshold level can vary  
with specific vehicle design.  
If the vehicle hits a stationary  
object, the airbags could inflate at  
a different crash speed than if the  
vehicle hits a moving object.  
In addition, the vehicle has  
dual-stage frontal airbags.  
Seat-mounted side impact airbags  
are not intended to inflate in  
Dual-stage airbags adjust the  
restraint according to crash severity.  
The vehicle has electronic frontal  
sensors, which help the sensing  
system distinguish between a  
moderate frontal impact and a more  
severe frontal impact. For moderate  
frontal impacts, dual-stage airbags  
inflate at a level less than full  
deployment. For more severe frontal  
impacts, full deployment occurs.  
frontal impacts, near-frontal impacts,  
rollovers, or rear impacts. Roof-rail  
airbags are not intended to inflate in  
rear impacts. A seat-mounted  
side impact airbag is intended to  
deploy on the side of the vehicle that  
is struck. Both roof-rail airbags  
will deploy when either side of the  
vehicle is struck, or if the sensing  
system predicts that the vehicle  
is about to roll over, or in a severe  
frontal impact.  
If the vehicle hits an object that  
deforms, the airbags could inflate  
at a different crash speed than if  
the vehicle hits an object that  
does not deform.  
If the vehicle hits a narrow object  
(like a pole), the airbags could  
inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits a wide  
object (like a wall).  
The vehicle has seat-mounted side  
impact and roof-rail airbags. See  
Airbag System on page 1-41.  
Seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags are intended  
to inflate in moderate to severe side  
crashes. In addition, these roof-rail  
airbags are intended to inflate during  
a rollover or in a severe frontal  
impact. Seat-mounted side impact  
and roof-rail airbags will inflate if the  
crash severity is above the  
If the vehicle goes into an object  
at an angle, the airbags could  
inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle goes straight  
into the object.  
In any particular crash, no one can  
say whether an airbag should  
have inflated simply because of the  
damage to a vehicle or because  
of what the repair costs were.  
For frontal airbags, inflation is  
determined by what the vehicle hits,  
the angle of the impact, and how  
quickly the vehicle slows down. For  
seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags, deployment  
Thresholds can also vary with  
specific vehicle design.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-47  
is determined by the location and  
severity of the side impact. In  
a rollover event, roof-rail airbag  
deployment is determined by  
the direction of the roll.  
in the ceiling of the vehicle, near the  
side windows that have occupant  
seating positions.  
Rollover capable roof-rail airbags  
are designed to help contain  
the head and chest of occupants in  
the outboard seating positions in  
the first and second rows. The  
rollover capable roof-rail airbags are  
designed to help reduce the risk  
of full or partial ejection in rollover  
events, although no system can  
prevent all such ejections.  
How Does an Airbag  
Restrain?  
In moderate to severe frontal or  
near frontal collisions, even belted  
occupants can contact the steering  
wheel or the instrument panel.  
In moderate to severe side  
What Makes an Airbag  
Inflate?  
In a deployment event, the sensing  
system sends an electrical signal  
triggering a release of gas from the  
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills  
the airbag causing the bag to break  
out of the cover and deploy. The  
inflator, the airbag, and related  
hardware are all part of the airbag  
module.  
But airbags would not help in many  
types of collisions, primarily  
because the occupant’s motion is  
not toward those airbags. See When  
collisions, even belted occupants  
can contact the inside of the vehicle.  
Airbags supplement the protection  
provided by safety belts. Frontal  
airbags distribute the force of  
the impact more evenly over the  
occupant’s upper body, stopping the  
occupant more gradually.  
page 1-45 for more information.  
Airbags should never be regarded  
as anything more than a supplement  
to safety belts.  
Frontal airbag modules are located  
inside the steering wheel and  
instrument panel. For vehicles with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags,  
there are airbag modules in the side  
of the front seatbacks closest to  
the door. For vehicles with roof-rail  
airbags, there are airbag modules  
Seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags distribute the force  
of the impact more evenly over  
the occupant’s upper body.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-48  
Seats and Restraint System  
controls for those features. You  
must first, however, turn the ignition  
key to the following ignition switch  
positions:  
What Will You See After  
an Airbag Inflates?  
{ CAUTION  
When an airbag inflates, there  
may be dust in the air. This dust  
could cause breathing problems  
for people with a history of  
asthma or other breathing trouble.  
To avoid this, everyone in the  
vehicle should get out as soon as  
it is safe to do so. If you have  
breathing problems but cannot get  
out of the vehicle after an airbag  
inflates, then get fresh air by  
opening a window or a door. If  
you experience breathing  
After the frontal airbags and  
seat-mounted side impact airbags  
inflate, they quickly deflate, so  
quickly that some people may not  
even realize an airbag inflated.  
Roof-rail airbags may still be at least  
partially inflated for some time  
after they deploy. Some components  
of the airbag module may be hot  
for several minutes. For location of  
the airbag modules, see What  
page 1-47.  
1. Turn the ignition key to  
LOCK/OFF.  
2. Turn the ignition key to ON/RUN.  
In many crashes severe enough  
to inflate the airbag, windshields are  
broken by vehicle deformation.  
Additional windshield breakage may  
also occur from the right front  
passenger airbag.  
Airbags are designed to inflate  
only once. After an airbag  
problems following an airbag  
deployment, you should seek  
medical attention.  
The parts of the airbag that come  
into contact with you may be warm,  
but not too hot to touch. There  
may be some smoke and dust  
coming from the vents in the  
deflated airbags. Airbag inflation  
does not prevent the driver  
from seeing out of the windshield or  
being able to steer the vehicle,  
nor does it prevent people from  
leaving the vehicle.  
inflates, you will need some new  
parts for the airbag system. If  
you do not get them, the airbag  
system will not be there to  
help protect you in another crash.  
A new system will include  
airbag modules and possibly  
other parts. The service manual  
for your vehicle covers the  
The vehicle has a feature that may  
automatically unlock the doors,  
turn the interior lamps on, and turn  
the hazard warning flashers on  
when the airbags inflate. You can  
lock the doors, turn the interior  
lamps off, and turn the hazard  
warning flashers off by using the  
need to replace other parts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-49  
check. When the system check is  
complete, either the word ON  
or OFF, or the symbol for on or off,  
will be visible. See Passenger  
page 3-26.  
The vehicle has a crash sensing  
and diagnostic module which  
records information after a crash.  
and Privacy on page 7-14  
page 7-14.  
Passenger Sensing  
System  
The vehicle has a passenger  
sensing system for the right front  
passenger position. The passenger  
airbag status indicator will be  
visible on the instrument panel when  
the vehicle is started.  
The passenger sensing system  
turns off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag and seat-mounted  
side impact airbag under certain  
conditions. The driver airbags  
and the roof-rail airbags are not  
affected by the passenger sensing  
system.  
Let only qualified technicians  
work on the airbag systems.  
Improper service can mean that  
an airbag system will not  
work properly. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
United States  
The passenger sensing system  
works with sensors that are part of  
the right front passenger seat  
and safety belt. The sensors are  
designed to detect the presence of  
a properly-seated occupant and  
determine if the right front  
Canada  
passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag  
should be enabled (may inflate)  
or not.  
The words ON and OFF, or the  
symbol for on and off, are visible  
during the system check. If you are  
using remote start, if equipped,  
to start the vehicle from a distance,  
you may not see the system  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-50  
Seats and Restraint System  
According to accident statistics,  
children are safer when properly  
secured in a rear seat in a correct  
child restraint for their weight  
and size.  
{ CAUTION  
CAUTION (Continued)  
A child in a rear-facing child  
(if equipped), no system is  
fail-safe. No one can guarantee  
that an airbag will not deploy  
under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the  
airbag(s) are off.  
restraint can be seriously injured or  
killed if the right front passenger  
airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child  
restraint would be very close to the  
inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can  
be seriously injured or killed if the  
right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is  
in a forward position.  
We recommend that children be  
secured in a rear seat, including: an  
infant or a child riding in a  
rear-facing child restraint; a child  
riding in a forward-facing child seat;  
an older child riding in a booster  
seat; and children, who are  
Secure rear-facing child  
restraints in a rear seat, even  
if the airbag(s) are off. If you  
secure a forward-facing child  
restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger  
seat as far back as it will go. It is  
better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
large enough, using safety belts.  
A label on the sun visor says,  
“Never put a rear-facing child seat  
in the front.” This is because the risk  
to the rear-facing child is so great,  
if the airbag deploys.  
Even if the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-51  
If the vehicle does not have a rear  
seat that will accommodate a  
rear-facing child restraint, a  
rear-facing child restraint should not  
be installed in the vehicle, even if  
the airbag is off.  
The passenger sensing system is  
designed to turn on (may inflate) the  
right front passenger frontal airbag  
and seat-mounted side impact  
airbag anytime the system senses  
that a person of adult size is  
sitting properly in the right front  
passenger seat.  
The system determines that a  
small child is present in a  
booster seat.  
A right front passenger takes  
his/her weight off of the seat  
for a period of time.  
The passenger sensing system is  
designed to turn off the right  
front passenger airbag and  
The right front passenger seat is  
occupied by a smaller person,  
such as a child who has  
When the passenger sensing  
system has allowed the airbags to  
be enabled, the on indicator will light  
and stay lit to remind you that the  
airbags are active.  
seat-mounted side impact airbag if:  
outgrown child restraints.  
The right front passenger seat  
is unoccupied.  
Or, if there is a critical problem  
with the airbag system or the  
passenger sensing system.  
The system determines that an  
infant is present in a rear-facing  
infant seat.  
When the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag,  
the off indicator will light and stay lit  
to remind you that the airbags  
are off. See Passenger Airbag  
Status Indicator on page 3-26.  
The system determines that a  
small child is present in a  
child restraint.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-52  
Seats and Restraint System  
For some children who have  
5. If, after reinstalling the child  
restraint and restarting the  
vehicle, the on indicator is still lit,  
turn the vehicle off. Then slightly  
recline the vehicle seatback and  
adjust the seat cushion, if  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a  
Child Restraint  
outgrown child restraints and for very  
small adults, the passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the  
right front passenger frontal airbag  
and seat-mounted side impact  
If a child restraint has been installed  
and the on indicator is lit:  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
airbag, depending upon the person’s  
seating posture and body build.  
Everyone in the vehicle who has  
outgrown child restraints should wear  
a safety belt properly —whether or  
not there is an airbag for that person.  
adjustable, to make sure that the  
vehicle seatback is not pushing  
the child restraint into the seat  
cushion.  
2. Remove the child restraint from  
the vehicle.  
3. Remove any additional items  
from the seat such as blankets,  
cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
Also make sure the child  
restraint is not trapped under the  
vehicle head restraint. If this  
happens, adjust the head  
restraint. See Head Restraints  
on page 1-2.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint  
following the directions provided  
by the child restraint manufacturer  
and refer to Securing a Child  
Position on page 1-38.  
{ CAUTION  
If the airbag readiness light ever  
comes on and stays on, it means  
that something may be wrong with  
the airbag system. To help avoid  
injury to yourself or others, have  
the vehicle serviced right away.  
page 3-25 for more information,  
including important safety  
6. Restart the vehicle.  
If the on indicator is still lit with  
an infant present in a child  
restraint, secure the child  
restraint in a rear seat position in  
the vehicle and see your  
dealer/retailer.  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraint System  
1-53  
If this happens, use the following  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
Adult-Size Occupant  
Additional Factors Affecting  
System Operation  
steps to allow the system to detect  
that person and enable the right  
front passenger frontal airbag  
and seat-mounted side impact  
airbag:  
Safety belts help keep the passenger  
in position on the seat during vehicle  
maneuvers and braking, which helps  
the passenger sensing system  
maintain the passenger airbag  
status. See “Safety Belts” and “Child  
Restraints” in the Index for additional  
information about the importance of  
proper restraint use.  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material  
from the seat, such as blankets,  
cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully  
upright position.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in  
the right front passenger seat,  
but the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting  
properly in the seat.  
4. Have the person sit upright in the  
seat, centered on the seat  
cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the  
person remain in this position for  
two to three minutes after the  
on indicator is lit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-54  
Seats and Restraint System  
A thick layer of additional material,  
such as a blanket or cushion, or  
aftermarket equipment such as seat  
covers, seat heaters, and seat  
massagers can affect how well the  
passenger sensing system  
Servicing Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
{ CAUTION  
For up to 10 seconds after the  
ignition is turned off and the battery  
is disconnected, an airbag can still  
inflate during improper service.  
You can be injured if you are close  
to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid  
yellow connectors. They are  
probably part of the airbag system.  
Be sure to follow proper service  
procedures, and make sure the  
person performing work for you is  
qualified to do so.  
Airbags affect how the vehicle  
should be serviced. There are parts  
of the airbag system in several  
places around the vehicle. Your  
dealer/retailer and the service  
manual have information about  
servicing the vehicle and the airbag  
system. To purchase a service  
Ordering Information on page 7-13.  
operates. We recommend that you  
not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment except when  
approved by GM for your specific  
vehicle. See Adding Equipment  
page 1-55 for more information  
about modifications that can affect  
how the system operates.  
{ CAUTION  
Stowing of articles under the  
passenger seat or between the  
passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the  
proper operation of the passenger  
sensing system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-55  
In addition, the vehicle has a  
If you have questions, call  
Adding Equipment to  
Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle  
passenger sensing system for the  
right front passenger position,  
which includes sensors that are  
part of the passenger seat. The  
passenger sensing system may  
not operate properly if the original  
seat trim is replaced with non-GM  
covers, upholstery or trim, or  
with GM covers, upholstery or  
trim designed for a different  
vehicle. Any object, such as an  
aftermarket seat heater or a  
comfort enhancing pad or device,  
installed under or on top of  
Customer Assistance. The phone  
numbers and addresses for  
Customer Assistance are in Step  
Two of the Customer Satisfaction  
Procedure in this manual. See  
on page 7-1.  
Q: Is there anything I might add  
to or change about the  
vehicle that could keep the  
airbags from working  
properly?  
If the vehicle has rollover  
roof-rail airbags, see Different  
page 5-53 for additional  
important information.  
A: Yes. If you add things that  
change the vehicle’s frame,  
bumper system, height, front end  
or side sheet metal, they may  
keep the airbag system from  
working properly. Changing or  
moving any parts of the front  
seats, safety belts, the airbag  
sensing and diagnostic module,  
steering wheel, instrument  
panel, roof-rail airbag modules,  
ceiling headliner or pillar  
the seat fabric, could also  
interfere with the operation of  
the passenger sensing system.  
This could either prevent proper  
deployment of the passenger  
airbag(s) or prevent the  
passenger sensing system from  
properly turning off the passenger  
airbag(s). See Passenger  
garnish trim, front sensors, side  
impact sensors, rollover  
sensor module, or airbag wiring  
can affect the operation of  
the airbag system.  
Sensing System on page 1-49.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-56  
Seats and Restraint System  
Keep safety belts clean and dry.  
page 5-69.  
Q: Because I have a disability, I  
have to get my vehicle  
modified. How can I find out  
whether this will affect my  
airbag system?  
Restraint System  
Check  
Airbags  
Checking the Restraint  
Systems  
The airbag system does not need  
regularly scheduled maintenance or  
replacement. Make sure the  
airbag readiness light is working.  
A: If you have questions, call  
Customer Assistance. The phone  
numbers and addresses for  
Customer Assistance are in Step  
Two of the Customer Satisfaction  
Procedure in this manual. See  
on page 7-1.  
Safety Belts  
Now and then, check that the safety  
belt reminder light, safety belts,  
buckles, latch plates, retractors, and  
anchorages are all working properly.  
on page 3-25 for more information.  
Notice: If an airbag covering  
is damaged, opened, or broken,  
the airbag may not work properly.  
Do not open or break the airbag  
coverings. If there are any opened  
or broken airbag covers, have  
the airbag covering and/or airbag  
module replaced. For the  
location of the airbag modules,  
Inflate? on page 1-47. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
Look for any other loose or  
damaged safety belt system parts  
that might keep a safety belt system  
from doing its job. See your  
dealer/retailer to have it repaired.  
Torn or frayed safety belts may not  
protect you in a crash. They can  
rip apart under impact forces.  
If a belt is torn or frayed, get a new  
one right away.  
In addition, your dealer/retailer and  
the service manual have information  
about the location of the airbag  
sensors, sensing and diagnostic  
module and airbag wiring.  
Make sure the safety belt reminder  
light is working. See Safety Belt  
Reminders on page 3-24 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seats and Restraint System  
1-57  
If the vehicle has the LATCH  
system and it was being used during  
a crash, you may need new  
LATCH system parts.  
If an airbag inflates or the vehicle  
has been in a crash, the vehicle’s  
sensing system may command  
the automatic hybrid battery  
disconnect to open. The battery will  
disconnect. The hybrid battery  
will be off and the vehicle will not  
start. The airbag readiness light may  
come on. See Airbag Readiness  
Light on page 3-25 for more  
information. To operate the vehicle,  
the automatic hybrid battery  
disconnect must be reconnected by  
a qualified service technician and  
sensing system parts will need to be  
replaced. Have the vehicle  
Replacing Restraint  
System Parts After a  
Crash  
New parts and repairs may be  
necessary even if the safety belt or  
LATCH system (if equipped),  
was not being used at the time of  
the crash.  
{ CAUTION  
A crash can damage the restraint  
systems in your vehicle. A  
damaged restraint system may  
not properly protect the person  
using it, resulting in serious injury  
or even death in a crash. To help  
make sure your restraint systems  
are working properly after a crash,  
have them inspected and any  
necessary replacements made as  
soon as possible.  
If an airbag inflates, you will need to  
replace airbag system parts. See  
the part on the airbag system earlier  
in this section.  
Have the safety belt pretensioners  
checked if the vehicle has been in a  
crash, if the airbag readiness light  
stays on after you start the vehicle,  
or while you are driving. See  
serviced right away.  
After a minor crash, replacement of  
safety belts may not be necessary.  
But the safety belt assemblies  
that were used during any crash  
may have been stressed or  
page 3-25.  
damaged. See your dealer/retailer  
to have the safety belt assemblies  
inspected or replaced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1-58  
Seats and Restraint System  
NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-1  
Windows  
Features and  
Controls  
Theft-Deterrent Systems  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Mirrors  
Keys  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Starting and Operating  
...2-4 Your Vehicle  
Doors and Locks  
OnStar® System  
OnStar® System  
Universal Home Remote  
System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-2  
Features and Controls  
Storage Areas  
Keys  
{ CAUTION  
Leaving children in a vehicle with  
the ignition key is dangerous for  
many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even  
killed. They could operate the  
power windows or other controls  
or even make the vehicle move.  
The windows will function with the  
keys in the ignition and children  
could be seriously injured or killed  
if caught in the path of a closing  
window. Do not leave the keys in  
a vehicle with children.  
The two keys can be used for the  
ignition and all locks.  
The key code is stamped on the key  
number plate and can be used to  
make new keys at any dealer/  
retailer. Store this information in a  
safe place outside the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-3  
Notice: If you ever lock your  
keys in the vehicle, you may have  
to damage the vehicle to get in.  
Be sure you have spare keys.  
This device complies with Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. Operation is subject  
to the following two conditions:  
Changes or modifications to this  
system by other than an authorized  
service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
1. This device may not cause  
interference.  
If you are locked out of the vehicle,  
contact Roadside Assistance. See  
page 7-5 for more information.  
If there is a decrease in the RKE  
operating range, try this:  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
Check the distance. The  
transmitter may be too far from  
the vehicle. Stand closer  
undesired operation of the device.  
Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System  
If this vehicle has the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) system, it  
operates on a radio frequency  
subject to Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) Rules and  
with Industry Canada.  
during rainy or snowy weather.  
This device complies with RSS-210  
of Industry Canada. Operation is  
subject to the following two  
conditions:  
Check the location. Other vehicles  
or objects may be blocking the  
signal. Take a few steps to the left  
or right, hold the transmitter  
higher, and try again.  
1. This device may not cause  
interference.  
Check the transmitter’s battery.  
See “Battery Replacement” later  
in this section.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
If the transmitter is still not  
working correctly, see your  
dealer/retailer or a qualified  
technician for service.  
undesired operation of the device.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-4  
Features and Controls  
Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System Operation  
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter functions work up to  
65 feet (20 m) away from the vehicle.  
L (Vehicle Locator/Panic  
Alarm): Press and release to  
activate the alarm. The turn signal  
lamps flash and the horn sounds  
three times.  
Press and hold L for more than  
two seconds and the turn signal  
lamps flash and the horn sounds  
for 30 seconds.  
There are other conditions which can  
affect the performance of the  
transmitter. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 2-3.  
To turn the alarm off, press L again  
or turn the ignition to ON/RUN.  
Q (Lock): Press to lock all the  
doors, including the liftgate.  
K (Unlock): Press once to unlock  
the driver door. If K is pressed  
again within five seconds, all other  
doors unlock. The interior lamps  
come on for 20 seconds or until the  
ignition is turned on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-5  
Programming Transmitters to  
the Vehicle  
Battery Replacement  
Replace the battery if the REPLACE  
REMOTE KEY FOB BATTERY  
message displays on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). See  
“REPLACE REMOTE KEY FOB  
BATTERY” under DIC Warnings  
and Messages on page 3-42.  
Only RKE transmitters programmed  
to the vehicle will work. If a  
transmitter is lost or stolen, a  
replacement can be purchased and  
programmed through your dealer/  
retailer. When the replacement  
transmitter is programmed to the  
vehicle, all remaining transmitters  
must also be programmed. Any lost  
or stolen transmitters no longer work  
once the new transmitter is  
Notice: When replacing the  
battery, do not touch any of the  
circuitry on the transmitter. Static  
from your body could damage  
the transmitter.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Separate the transmitter with a  
flat thin object inserted into the  
notch on the side.  
programmed. Each vehicle can have  
up to eight transmitters programmed  
to it. See “HOLD STEM TO  
2. Remove the old battery. Do not  
use a metal object.  
RELEARN REMOTE KEY” under  
page 3-36.  
3. Insert the new battery, positive  
side facing down. Replace with  
a CR2032 or equivalent battery.  
4. Reassemble the transmitter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-6  
Features and Controls  
Power Door Locks  
Doors and Locks  
CAUTION (Continued)  
T : The power door lock switches  
are located on the driver door.  
Door Locks  
Young children who get into  
unlocked vehicles may be  
unable to get out. A child can  
be overcome by extreme heat  
and can suffer permanent  
injuries or even death from  
heat stroke. Always lock your  
vehicle whenever you leave it.  
Outsiders can easily enter  
through an unlocked door  
when you slow down or stop  
your vehicle. Locking your  
doors can help prevent this  
from happening.  
Press the right side of the switch  
to unlock the doors.  
{ CAUTION  
Remove the ignition key and  
press the left side of the switch to  
lock all of the doors.  
Unlocked doors can be  
dangerous.  
Passengers, especially  
children, can easily open the  
doors and fall out of a moving  
vehicle. When a door is  
Delayed Locking  
A chime will sound to indicate a  
door or liftgate is open when you try  
to lock the doors with the power  
door lock switch. The doors will not  
lock, and the theft-deterrent  
system will not arm until all the  
doors are closed and five seconds  
have passed.  
locked, the handle will not  
open it. You increase the  
chance of being thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash if the  
doors are not locked. So, wear  
safety belts properly and lock  
the doors whenever you drive.  
To lock or unlock a door, use the  
key from the outside or the door lock  
from the inside.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-7  
To set the locks, insert a key into the  
slot and turn it to the horizontal  
position. The door can only be  
opened from the outside with the  
door unlocked. To return the door to  
normal operation, turn the slot to the  
vertical position.  
Automatic Door Lock  
The doors are programmed to  
automatically lock when the shift  
lever is moved into a forward gear.  
Rear Door Security  
Locks  
The vehicle has rear door security  
locks to prevent passengers  
from opening the rear doors from  
the inside.  
The automatic door lock feature  
cannot be disabled.  
Lockout Protection  
Automatic Door Unlock  
When the power door lock switch is  
pressed with the key in the ignition,  
and any door is open, all the doors  
lock and the driver door unlocks.  
When doors are closed with the key  
in the ignition, the horn will sound as  
a reminder.  
The doors will automatically  
unlock when the shift lever is moved  
into (P) Park.  
If the doors are locked with the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter, and the key is in the  
ignition, a chime sounds and  
all except the driver door lock.  
Open the rear doors to access the  
security locks on the inside edge  
of each door.  
The lockout protection feature can be  
overridden by holding the power door  
lock switch for three seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-8  
Features and Controls  
Liftgate Operation with Loss of  
Power  
Liftgate  
CAUTION (Continued)  
{ CAUTION  
If the vehicle is equipped with  
a power liftgate, disable the  
power liftgate function.  
Exhaust gases may enter the  
vehicle if it is driven with the  
liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with  
any objects that pass through the  
seal between the body and the  
trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon  
Monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
For more information about  
carbon monoxide, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 2-26.  
To lock or unlock the liftgate, press  
the button on the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) transmitter twice  
or the power door lock switch.  
If the vehicle must be driven with  
the liftgate, or trunk/hatch open:  
Close all of the windows.  
Fully open the air outlets on or  
under the instrument panel.  
Adjust the Climate Control  
system to a setting that brings  
in only outside air and set the  
fan speed to the highest  
To open the liftgate, press  
the touchpad on the underside of  
the liftgate handle and pull up.  
To open the liftgate if the vehicle’s  
battery is disconnected or the  
voltage is low, access the release  
lever. Remove the interior trim cover  
on the inside of the liftgate. Use a  
tool to push the lever on the  
To close the liftgate, pull down using  
the handle and close until it latches.  
latch until the liftgate releases.  
setting. See Climate Control  
System in the Index.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-9  
Windows  
CAUTION (Continued)  
The windows will function and  
{ CAUTION  
they could be seriously injured or  
killed if caught in the path of a  
closing window. Do not leave  
keys in a vehicle with children.  
Leaving children, helpless adults,  
or pets in a vehicle with the  
windows closed is dangerous.  
They can be overcome by the  
extreme heat and suffer  
permanent injuries or even death  
from heat stroke. Never leave a  
child, a helpless adult, or a pet  
alone in a vehicle, especially with  
the windows closed in warm or  
hot weather.  
When there are children in the  
rear seat use the window lockout  
button to prevent unintentional  
operation of the windows.  
Power Windows  
{ CAUTION  
Leaving children in a vehicle with  
the keys is dangerous for many  
reasons, children or others could  
be badly injured or even killed.  
They could operate the power  
windows or other controls or even  
make the vehicle move.  
The window switches for all doors  
are located on the driver door.  
Each door also has a switch.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-10  
Features and Controls  
To open or close a window, press  
or pull up on the switch.  
Window Lockout  
Theft-Deterrent  
Systems  
Vehicle theft is big business,  
especially in some cities. This vehicle  
has theft-deterrent features,  
however, they do not make it  
impossible to steal.  
o (Window Lockout): The  
vehicle has a lockout feature to  
prevent rear seat passengers from  
operating the windows. Press  
the lockout button, located with the  
power window switches, to turn  
the feature on and off.  
The power windows operate when  
the ignition is in ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY, or while in  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP).  
(RAP) on page 2-15.  
Express-Down Window  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
This vehicle may have a content  
theft-deterrent alarm system.  
Sun Visors  
The driver window switch has an  
express-down feature that lowers  
the window without holding the  
switch. Press the switch part way  
and the window will open a  
small amount. Press the switch  
down all the way and release it and  
the window lowers all the way.  
To block out glare, swing the sun  
visor down, or detach the driver sun  
visor from the center mount and  
slide it along the rod from  
side-to-side.  
On a visor with a mirror, lift the  
cover to use it.  
To stop the window while it  
is lowering, press and release the  
switch.  
United States shown,  
Canada similar  
The security light is located near the  
center of the instrument panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-11  
To arm the theft-deterrent system,  
The theft-deterrent system also  
activates if the doors are locked  
with the key.  
3. Wait for the security light to  
flash slowly.  
close all doors and press Q on the  
RKE transmitter. The security light  
comes on solid for approximately  
30 seconds and then flashes slowly.  
If Q is pressed a second time, the  
theft-deterrent system activates  
immediately. The content theft  
deterrent alarm is not armed until  
the security light flashes slowly.  
4. Reach in through the window to  
unlock the door with the manual  
door lock and open the door.  
This should set off the alarm.  
To avoid setting off the alarm by  
accident, always unlock a door  
with the RKE transmitter or a key.  
Unlocking a door any other way  
sets off the alarm if the system  
has been armed.  
If the alarm does not sound when it  
should, but the vehicle’s headlamps  
flash, check to see if the horn  
works. The horn fuse may be blown.  
To replace the fuse, see Fuses  
and Circuit Breakers on page 5-75.  
If the alarm is set off by accident,  
If any door or the liftgate are opened  
without using the key or pressing  
K on the RKE transmitter, the  
exterior lamps flash and the horn  
press Q or K on the RKE  
transmitter or place the key in  
the ignition and turn it to START  
to turn it off.  
If the alarm does not sound or  
the vehicle’s headlamps do  
not flash, see your dealer/retailer  
for service.  
sounds for about 30 seconds. If Q or  
Testing the Alarm  
K on the RKE transmitter is not  
pressed, the alarm sounds and  
periodically repeats. If the system  
does not operate as described  
above, see your dealer/retailer  
for service.  
To test the alarm:  
1. From inside the vehicle, lower  
the driver’s window and open  
the driver door.  
2. Get out of the vehicle, close the  
door and activate the system by  
pressing Q on the RKE  
transmitter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-12  
Features and Controls  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer  
The PASS-Key III+ system operates  
on a radio frequency subject to  
Federal Communications  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer Operation  
This vehicle has PASS-Key® III+  
(Personalized Automotive Security  
System) theft-deterrent system.  
PASS-Key® III+ is a passive  
theft-deterrent system.  
This device complies with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada.  
Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions:  
1. This device may not cause  
interference.  
Commission (FCC) Rules and  
with Industry Canada.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the  
device.  
This device complies with Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. Operation is subject  
to the following two conditions:  
The system is automatically armed  
when the key is removed from  
the ignition.  
1. This device may not cause  
harmful interference.  
You do not have to manually arm or  
disarm the system.  
Changes or modifications to  
this system by other than an  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
The security light comes on if there is  
a problem with arming or disarming  
the theft-deterrent system.  
PASS-Key III+ uses a radio  
frequency transponder in the key  
that matches a decoder in the  
vehicle.  
When the PASS-Key® III+ system  
senses that someone is using  
the wrong key, it prevents the  
vehicle from starting. Anyone using  
a trial-and-error method to start  
the vehicle will be discouraged  
because of the high number  
of electrical key codes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-13  
When trying to start the vehicle if  
the engine does not start and  
the security light on the instrument  
panel cluster comes on, there  
may be a problem with your  
theft-deterrent system. Turn the  
ignition off and try again.  
It is possible for the PASS-Key® III+  
decoder to “learn” the transponder  
value of a new or replacement key.  
Up to 10 keys may be programmed  
for the vehicle. The following  
procedure is for programming  
additional keys only. If all the  
currently programmed keys are  
lost or do not operate, you must see  
your dealer/retailer or a locksmith  
who can service PASS-Key® III+  
to have keys made and programmed  
to the system.  
3. After the engine has started, turn  
the key to LOCK/OFF, and  
remove the key.  
4. Insert the key to be programmed  
and turn it to the ON/RUN  
position within five seconds of  
the original key being turned  
to the LOCK/OFF position.  
If the engine still does not start,  
and the key appears to be not  
damaged, wait about five minutes  
and try another ignition key and  
check the fuse. See Fuses  
and Circuit Breakers on page 5-75.  
If the engine still does not start  
with the other key, the vehicle  
needs service. If the vehicle does  
start, the first key may be faulty.  
See your dealer/retailer who  
can service the PASS-Key® III+  
to have a new key made. In  
The security light turns off once  
the key has been programmed.  
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4  
if additional keys are to be  
programmed.  
If the PASS-Key® III+ key is lost or  
damaged, see your dealer/retailer  
or a locksmith to have a new  
key made.  
See your dealer/retailer or a  
locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to get a new key  
blank that is cut exactly as the  
ignition key that operates the system.  
To program the new key:  
Do not leave the key or device that  
disarms or deactivates the theft  
deterrent system in the vehicle.  
1. Verify that the new key has  
an emergency, contact Roadside  
Assistance. See Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 7-5.  
a 1 stamped on it.  
2. Insert the already programmed  
key in the ignition and start the  
engine. If the engine does not  
start, see your dealer/retailer  
for service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-14  
Features and Controls  
To shift out of P (Park), turn the  
ignition to ON/RUN and apply  
the regular brake pedal.  
Do not tow a trailer during  
break-in. See Towing a  
Trailer on page 4-26 for the  
trailer towing capabilities  
of your vehicle and more  
information.  
Starting and  
Operating Your  
Vehicle  
Notice: Using a tool to force the  
key to turn in the ignition could  
cause damage to the switch  
or break the key. Use the correct  
key, make sure it is all the  
way in, and turn it only with  
your hand. If the key cannot be  
turned by hand, see your  
New Vehicle Break-In  
Following break-in, engine speed  
and load can be gradually  
increased.  
Notice: The vehicle does  
not need an elaborate break-in.  
But it will perform better in  
the long run if you follow these  
guidelines:  
Ignition Positions  
dealer/retailer.  
Do not drive at any one  
LOCK/OFF: This position locks the  
ignition. It also locks the steering  
wheel and the transmission. The key  
can only be removed in LOCK/OFF.  
The shift lever must be in P (Park) to  
turn the ignition switch to LOCK/OFF.  
constant speed, fast or slow,  
for the first 500 miles (805 km).  
Do not make full-throttle  
starts. Avoid downshifting to  
brake or slow the vehicle.  
Avoid making hard stops for  
the first 200 miles (322 km)  
or so. During this time the  
new brake linings are not yet  
broken in. Hard stops with new  
linings can mean premature  
wear and earlier replacement.  
Follow this breaking-in  
The steering can bind with the  
wheels turned off center. If this  
happens, move the steering wheel  
from right to left while turning the key  
to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this doesn’t  
work, the vehicle needs service.  
The ignition switch has four different  
positions.  
guideline every time you  
get new brake linings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-15  
ACC (ACC/ACCESSORY): This is  
the position in which you can operate  
the electrical accessories or items  
plugged into the accessory power  
outlets.  
START: This is the position that  
starts the engine. When the engine  
starts, release the key. The ignition  
switch returns to ON/RUN for driving.  
Starting the Engine  
(Automatic Engine  
Start/Stop)  
Place the transmission in the  
proper gear.  
A warning tone will sound when the  
driver door is opened, the ignition is  
in ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/OFF  
and the key is in the ignition.  
Use this position if the vehicle must  
be pushed or towed.  
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or  
N (Neutral). The engine will not start  
in any other position. To restart the  
engine when the vehicle is already  
moving, use N (Neutral) only.  
ON/RUN: This position can be used  
to operate the electrical accessories  
and to display some instrument  
panel cluster warning and indicator  
lights. The switch stays in this  
position when the engine is running.  
The transmission is also unlocked in  
this position. If you leave the key in  
the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN  
positions with the engine off, the  
battery could be drained. You may  
not be able to start the vehicle if the  
battery is allowed to drain for an  
extended period of time.  
Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP)  
These vehicle accessories may be  
used for up to 10 minutes after  
the ignition key is turned off:  
Notice: Do not try to shift to  
P (Park) if the vehicle is moving.  
If you do, you could damage  
the transmission. Shift to P (Park)  
only when the vehicle is stopped.  
Outside Mirror  
Power Windows  
Radio  
Starting Procedure  
1. With your foot off the accelerator  
pedal, turn the ignition key to  
START. When the engine starts,  
let go of the key. The idle speed  
will go down as your engine gets  
warm. Do not race the engine  
immediately after starting it.  
All these features work when the  
ignition key is in the ON/RUN  
or ACC/ACCESSORY positions,  
until a door is opened.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-16  
Features and Controls  
Operate the engine and  
Notice: Cranking the engine for  
long periods of time, by returning  
the key to the START position  
immediately after cranking has  
ended, can overheat and damage  
the cranking motor, and drain the  
battery. Wait at least 15 seconds  
between each try, to let the  
accelerator. If the vehicle starts  
briefly but then stops again,  
repeat the procedure. This clears  
the extra gasoline from the  
engine. Do not race the engine  
immediately after starting it.  
Operate the engine and  
transmission gently until the oil  
warms up and lubricates all  
moving parts.  
transmission gently to allow the  
oil to warm up and lubricate all  
moving parts.  
The vehicle has a  
Computer-Controlled Cranking  
System. This feature assists in  
starting the engine and protects  
components. If the ignition key is  
turned to the START position,  
and then released when the  
engine begins cranking, the  
engine will continue cranking for a  
few seconds or until the vehicle  
starts. If the engine does not start  
and the key is held in START,  
cranking stops after 15 seconds  
to prevent cranking motor  
cranking motor cool down.  
2. If the engine does not start after  
5-10 seconds, especially in  
Notice: Your engine is designed  
to work with the electronics in  
your vehicle. If you add electrical  
parts or accessories, you could  
change the way the engine  
operates. Before adding electrical  
equipment, check with your  
dealer/retailer. If you do not,  
your engine might not perform  
properly. Any resulting damage  
would not be covered by your  
vehicle’s warranty.  
very cold weather (below 0°F  
or 18°C), it could be flooded with  
too much gasoline. Try pushing  
the accelerator pedal all the way  
to the floor and holding it there as  
you hold the key in START for a  
maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at  
least 15 seconds between each  
try, to allow the cranking motor to  
cool down. When the engine  
starts, let go of the key and  
damage. To prevent gear  
damage, this system also  
prevents cranking if the engine is  
already running. Engine cranking  
can be stopped by turning the  
ignition switch to the ACC/  
ACCESSORY or LOCK/OFF  
position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-17  
The vehicle has an automatic  
engine start/stop feature that is  
a part of the hybrid system. After the  
engine is started and has reached  
operating temperature, the AUTO  
STOP feature may turn the  
engine off when you apply the  
brakes and come to a complete  
stop. When you take your foot  
off the brake pedal or press the  
accelerator pedal, the engine  
will start. The engine will continue  
to run until the next AUTO STOP.  
If you are on an incline, the vehicle  
may roll backwards a short distance  
until the engine performs an AUTO  
START. The Hill Start Assist feature  
will help start the vehicle on a  
moderate or steep incline. To restart  
the engine during the AUTO STOP,  
release the brake pedal or press the  
accelerator pedal. The engine starts  
immediately. The vehicle continues  
to run until the next stop.  
Automatic Engine Start/Stop  
{ CAUTION  
There is something about the  
vehicle that can make it move  
suddenly, and you or others can  
be seriously injured. This can  
happen if the vehicle is in the  
Auto Stop mode, and the shift  
lever is in D (Drive). Because the  
vehicle has the Automatic Engine  
Start/Stop feature, the vehicle’s  
engine might seem to be shut off  
when you come to a complete  
stop. However, if you then start to  
exit the vehicle, as soon as you  
take your foot off the brake pedal,  
the engine will start again and the  
vehicle can move forward. If you  
are going to exit the vehicle,  
There are several conditions that  
may prevent an AUTO STOP  
or cause an AUTO START.  
The AUTO STOP mark on the  
tachometer indicates that the engine  
is in AUTO STOP mode. If the  
driver door is opened while in AUTO  
STOP mode, a chime will sound.  
first shift to P (Park) and turn the  
ignition to LOCK/OFF. Then exit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-18  
Features and Controls  
The Engine Will Remain  
Running When:  
The Engine Will Restart When:  
The climate control system is  
turned from Off to On (econ  
or normal A/C, or floor/  
defog/defrost) See Automatic  
page 3-17 for more information.  
The brake pedal is released.  
The engine, transmission, or  
hybrid battery is not warmed  
up yet.  
The accelerator pedal is applied.  
When shifting from D (Drive)  
to P (Park), R (Reverse),  
N (Neutral) or M (Manual Mode),  
the engine will restart  
The outside temperature is  
high — usually above  
The engine is required to run for  
either heater or climate control  
performance. See “Air  
95°F (35°C) and the climate  
control system is working to  
cool the vehicle in A/C mode  
(yellow light illuminated on  
A/C button) or if defrost is  
selected. See Automatic Climate  
Control System on page 3-17  
for more information.  
immediately.  
Conditioning and Engine  
If the A/C button (green light  
illuminated on A/C) button is  
selected, the duration of  
Start/Stop” under Automatic  
page 3-17 for more information.  
the AUTO STOP will depend on  
the outside temperature. This  
economy mode improves  
fuel economy by limiting the  
effects of the air conditioning.  
The warmer it is outside,  
the shorter the time before the  
engine is restarted to provide  
cabin cooling.  
The hybrid battery pack charge is  
low and requires recharging.  
The shift lever is in P (Park),  
R (Reverse), N (Neutral) or  
M (Manual Mode).  
Auto Stop time is greater than  
two minutes.  
The hybrid battery pack  
charge is low.  
The 12V vehicle battery charge  
is low, or loads are high.  
The hood is not fully closed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-19  
To Use the Engine Coolant  
Heater  
1. Turn off the engine.  
Engine Coolant Heater  
The engine coolant heater can  
provide easier starting and better  
fuel economy during engine  
warm-up in cold weather conditions  
at or below 0°F (18°C). Vehicles  
with an engine coolant heater should  
be plugged in at least four hours  
before starting. Some models  
may have an internal thermostat  
in the cord which will prevent engine  
coolant heater operation at  
{ CAUTION  
Plugging the cord into an  
ungrounded outlet could cause an  
electrical shock. Also, the wrong  
kind of extension cord could  
overheat and cause a fire. You  
could be seriously injured. Plug  
the cord into a properly grounded  
three-prong 110-volt AC outlet.  
If the cord will not reach, use a  
heavy-duty three-prong extension  
cord rated for at least 15 amps.  
2. Open the hood and unwrap the  
electrical cord. The engine  
coolant heater cord is located  
near the air cleaner box on  
the passenger side of the engine  
compartment. See Engine  
page 5-10 for more information  
on location.  
temperatures above 0°F (18°C).  
3. Plug the cord into a normal,  
grounded 110-volt AC outlet.  
4. Before starting the engine, be  
sure to unplug and store the  
cord as it was before to keep  
it away from moving engine  
parts. If you do not, it could be  
damaged.  
The length of time the heater should  
remain plugged in depends on  
several factors. Ask a dealer/retailer  
in the area where you will be  
parking the vehicle for the best  
advice on this.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-20  
Features and Controls  
the shift lever button before you can  
shift from P (Park) when the ignition  
key is in RUN. If you cannot shift out  
of P (Park), ease pressure on the  
shift lever and push the shift lever all  
the way into P (Park) as you maintain  
brake application. Then press the  
shift lever button and move the shift  
lever into another gear. See Shifting  
Out of Park on page 2-25.  
Automatic Transmission  
Operation  
The shift lever is located on the  
console between the seats.  
{ CAUTION  
It is dangerous to get out of the  
vehicle if the shift lever is not fully  
in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll.  
Do not leave the vehicle when the  
engine is running unless you have  
to. If you have left the engine  
running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be  
injured. To be sure the vehicle will  
not move, even when you are on  
fairly level ground, always set the  
parking brake and move the shift  
lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into  
Park on page 2-23. If you are  
pulling a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailer on page 4-26.  
R (Reverse): Use this gear to  
back up.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse)  
while the vehicle is moving  
forward could damage the  
transmission. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse)  
only after the vehicle is stopped.  
There are several different positions  
for the automatic transmission.  
P (Park): This position locks the  
front wheels. It is the best position  
to use when you start the engine  
because the vehicle cannot  
move easily.  
To rock the vehicle back and  
forth to get out of snow, ice or sand  
without damaging the transmission,  
page 4-17.  
Make sure the shift lever is fully in  
P (Park) before starting the engine.  
The vehicle has an automatic  
transmission shift lock control  
system. You have to fully apply the  
regular brakes first and then press  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-21  
N (Neutral): In this position, the  
engine does not connect with  
the wheels. To restart the engine  
when the vehicle is already moving,  
use N (Neutral) only. Also, use  
N (Neutral) when your vehicle is  
being towed.  
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park)  
or N (Neutral) with the engine  
running at high speed may  
damage the transmission. The  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Be sure  
the engine is not running at high  
speed when shifting the vehicle.  
Downshifting the transmission in  
slippery road conditions could result  
in skidding, see “Skidding” under  
Loss of Control on page 4-11.  
M (Manual Mode): This position  
allows you to change gears similar  
to a manual transmission. If the  
vehicle has this feature, see Manual  
Shift Mode.  
{ CAUTION  
D (Drive): This position is for normal  
driving with the automatic  
transmission. It provides the best  
fuel economy. If you need more  
power for passing, and you are:  
Notice: Spinning the tires or  
holding the vehicle in one place  
on a hill using only the  
accelerator pedal may damage  
the transmission. The repair  
will not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. If you are stuck, do  
not spin the tires. When stopping  
on a hill, use the brakes to  
hold the vehicle in place.  
Shifting into a drive gear while the  
engine is running at high speed is  
dangerous. Unless your foot is  
firmly on the brake pedal, the  
vehicle could move very rapidly.  
You could lose control and hit  
people or objects. Do not shift into  
a drive gear while the engine is  
running at high speed.  
Going less than about 35 mph  
(55 km/h), push the accelerator  
pedal about halfway down.  
Going about 35 mph (55 km/h),  
push the accelerator all the  
way down.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-22  
Features and Controls  
The transmission will only allow you  
to shift into a gear range appropriate  
for the vehicle speed.  
Manual Shift Mode (MSM)  
(Automatic Transmission)  
Parking Brake  
To use this feature, do the following:  
The transmission will not  
automatically shift to the next  
higher gear range without  
pressing the button on the  
shifter handle.  
1. Move the shift lever from  
D (Drive) rearward to the  
M (Manual Mode).  
The display will show a 3 for  
third gear.  
The transmission will not allow  
shifting to the next lower gear  
if the vehicle speed is too high.  
When coming to a stop in  
the manual position, the  
vehicle will automatically shift  
to 1 (First) gear.  
If the vehicle does not respond to a  
gear change, or detects a problem  
with the transmission, the range  
of gears may be reduced and  
the Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
will come on. See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 3-30.  
2. Press the plus (+) button to  
upshift or the minus () button  
to downshift.  
The parking brake lever is located in  
the center console between the  
front seats.  
While driving in MSM, the vehicle  
will have sportier performance. Use  
this when you want the vehicle  
to stay in gear longer or to downshift  
for more power or engine braking.  
To set the parking brake, hold the  
brake pedal down and pull up on the  
parking brake lever. If the ignition  
is in ON/RUN, the brake system  
warning light will come on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-23  
To release the parking brake, hold  
the brake pedal down. Pull the  
parking brake lever up until you can  
press the release button. Hold  
the release button in as you move  
the brake lever all the way down.  
Regenerative Braking  
Regenerative braking takes some of  
the energy from the moving  
vehicle and turns it back into  
electrical energy. This energy is  
then stored back into the vehicle’s  
hybrid battery system, contributing  
to increased fuel efficiency.  
Shifting Into Park  
{ CAUTION  
It can be dangerous to get out of  
the vehicle if the shift lever is not  
fully in P (Park) with the parking  
brake firmly set. The vehicle can  
roll. If you have left the engine  
running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be  
injured. To be sure the vehicle will  
not move, even when you are on  
fairly level ground, use the steps  
that follow. If you are pulling a  
trailer, see Towing a Trailer on  
page 4-26.  
Release the parking brake  
before driving the vehicle.  
Notice: Driving with the parking  
brake on can overheat the  
brake system and cause  
premature wear or damage to  
brake system parts. Make  
sure that the parking brake is  
fully released and the brake  
warning light is off before driving.  
The system works whenever you  
take your foot off the accelerator  
pedal while the vehicle is moving in a  
forward gear. This causes the  
vehicle to slow down more quickly. It  
may feel like the brake pedal is being  
pressed, even when it is not.  
1. Hold the brake pedal down and  
set the parking brake. See  
Parking Brake on page 2-22 for  
more information.  
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park)  
by pressing the button on the  
shift lever and pushing the lever  
all the way toward the front of  
the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-24  
Features and Controls  
3. Turn the ignition key to  
LOCK/OFF.  
If you have to leave the vehicle  
with the engine running, be sure  
the vehicle is in P (Park) and  
the parking brake is firmly set before  
you leave it. After you have  
moved the shift lever into P (Park),  
hold the regular brake pedal  
down. Then, see if you can move  
the shift lever away from P (Park)  
without first pressing the button  
on the console shift lever. If you can,  
it means that the shift lever was  
not fully locked into P (Park).  
You may find it difficult to pull the  
shift lever out of P (Park). This is  
called “torque lock.” To prevent  
torque lock, set the parking brake  
and then shift into P (Park) properly  
before you leave the driver seat. To  
find out how, see Shifting Into Park  
on page 2-23.  
4. Remove the key and take it with  
you. If you can leave the vehicle  
with the key, the vehicle is in  
P (Park).  
Leaving the Vehicle With the  
Engine Running  
When you are ready to drive, move  
the shift lever out of P (Park) before  
you release the parking brake.  
{ CAUTION  
If torque lock does occur, you may  
need to have another vehicle  
push yours a little uphill to take  
some of the pressure from the  
parking pawl in the transmission, so  
you can pull the shift lever out of  
P (Park).  
It can be dangerous to leave the  
vehicle with the engine running.  
The vehicle could move suddenly  
if the shift lever is not fully in  
P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. And, if you leave the  
vehicle with the engine running, it  
could overheat and even catch  
fire. You or others could be  
Torque Lock  
If you are parking on a hill and you  
do not shift the transmission into  
P (Park) properly, the weight of the  
vehicle may put too much force on  
the parking pawl in the transmission.  
injured. Do not leave the vehicle  
with the engine running.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-25  
If the vehicle has an uncharged  
battery or a battery with low voltage,  
try charging or jump starting the  
battery. See Jump Starting on  
page 5-28 for more information.  
If you still cannot move the shift  
lever from P (Park), consult  
your dealer/retailer or a professional  
towing service.  
Shifting Out of Park  
The vehicle has an electronic shift  
lock release system. The shift  
lock release is designed to:  
Prevent ignition key removal  
unless the shift lever is in  
P (Park) with the shift lever  
button fully released.  
Parking Over Things  
That Burn  
To shift out of P (Park):  
1. Apply the brake pedal.  
2. Press the shift lever button.  
{ CAUTION  
Prevent movement of the shift  
lever out of P (Park), unless  
the ignition is in ON/RUN and the  
regular brake pedal is applied.  
3. Move the shift lever to the  
desired position.  
Things that can burn could touch  
hot exhaust parts under the  
vehicle and ignite. Do not park  
over papers, leaves, dry grass, or  
other things that can burn.  
If you still are unable to shift out of  
P (Park):  
The shift lock release is always  
functional except in the case of an  
uncharged or low voltage (less  
than 9 volt) battery.  
1. Fully release the shift lever  
button.  
2. Hold the brake pedal down and  
press the shift lever button  
again.  
3. Move the shift lever to the  
desired position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-26  
Features and Controls  
Engine Exhaust  
Running the Vehicle  
While Parked  
It is better not to park with the  
engine running. But if you ever have  
to, here are some things to know.  
CAUTION (Continued)  
{ CAUTION  
There are holes or openings  
in the vehicle body from  
damage or after-market  
modifications that are not  
completely sealed.  
Engine exhaust contains Carbon  
Monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. Exposure to CO  
can cause unconsciousness and  
even death.  
{ CAUTION  
If unusual fumes are detected or if  
it is suspected that exhaust is  
coming into the vehicle:  
Drive it only with the windows  
completely down.  
Exiting the vehicle, without first  
shifting into P (Park), may cause  
the vehicle to move, and you or  
others can be seriously injured.  
Because the vehicle has the  
Automatic Engine Start/Stop  
feature, the vehicle’s engine might  
seem to be shut off when you  
come to a complete stop.  
However, once the brake pedal is  
released, the vehicle can move.  
The vehicle’s engine can also  
restart at any time.  
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:  
The vehicle idles in areas  
with poor ventilation (parking  
garages, tunnels, deep snow  
that may block underbody  
airflow or tail pipes).  
The exhaust smells or  
sounds strange or different.  
The exhaust system leaks  
due to corrosion or damage.  
The vehicle’s exhaust system  
has been modified, damaged  
or improperly repaired.  
Have the vehicle repaired  
immediately.  
Never park the vehicle with the  
engine running in an enclosed  
area such as a garage or a  
building that has no fresh air  
ventilation.  
Shift to P (Park) and turn the  
ignition to LOCK/OFF, before  
exiting the vehicle.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-27  
about OnStar® and how to subscribe  
to it. See OnStar® System on  
page 2-29 for more information  
about the services OnStar®  
provides.  
Mirrors  
{ CAUTION  
Manual Rearview Mirror  
The vehicle has a manual rearview  
mirror. It can be adjusted by  
holding the mirror in the center to  
move it for a clearer view behind  
your vehicle. Reduce the glare  
of headlamps from behind by  
pushing the lever forward or pulling  
it back for daytime/nighttime use.  
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed  
area with poor ventilation is  
dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust  
contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled.  
It can cause unconsciousness  
and even death. Never run the  
engine in an enclosed area that  
has no fresh air ventilation. For  
more information, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 2-26.  
O (On/Off): Press to turn the  
dimming feature on or off.  
Automatic Dimming Mirror  
Operation  
The automatic dimming mirror  
reduces the glare from the  
headlamps of the vehicle behind  
you. The dimming feature comes on  
and the indicator light illuminates  
each time the ignition is turned  
to start.  
Automatic Dimming  
Rearview Mirror  
The vehicle has an automatic  
dimming rearview mirror.  
Follow the proper steps to be sure  
the vehicle will not move. See  
Shifting Into Park on page 2-23.  
Vehicles with OnStar® have  
three additional control buttons  
for the OnStar® system. See your  
dealer/retailer for more information  
If parking on a hill and pulling  
a trailer, see Towing a Trailer on  
page 4-26.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-28  
Features and Controls  
To adjust the power mirrors:  
Outside Power Mirrors  
Outside Convex Mirror  
1. Turn the knob to choose the  
left (L) or the (R) right mirror.  
{ CAUTION  
2. Adjust each mirror so that you can  
see the side of your vehicle and  
the area behind your vehicle.  
A convex mirror can make things  
(like other vehicles) look farther  
away than they really are. If you  
cut too sharply into the right lane,  
you could hit a vehicle on the  
right. Check the inside mirror or  
glance over your shoulder before  
changing lanes.  
3. Return the control to the center  
position so the mirror cannot be  
moved.  
The mirrors can be manually folded  
inward toward the vehicle. Return  
to the original position to use  
correctly.  
The passenger side mirror is convex  
shaped. A convex mirror’s surface  
is curved so more can be seen from  
the driver seat.  
Controls for the outside power  
mirrors are located on the  
driver door.  
Outside Heated Mirrors  
For vehicles with outside heated  
mirrors:  
= (Rear Window Defogger):  
Press to heat the outside rearview  
mirrors. See “Rear Window  
Defogger” under Automatic Climate  
Control System on page 3-17 for  
more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-29  
OnStar® System  
OnStar service is provided subject  
to the OnStar Terms and Conditions  
included in the OnStar Subscriber  
glove box literature.  
Not all OnStar services are available  
on all vehicles. To check if this  
vehicle is able to provide the  
services described below, or for a  
full description of OnStar services  
and system limitations, see the  
OnStar Owner’s Guide in the glove  
box or visit www.onstar.com  
(U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada),  
contact OnStar at 1-888-4-ONSTAR  
(1-888-466-7827) or TTY  
Some services such as Remote  
Door Unlock or Stolen Vehicle  
Location Assistance may not be  
available until the owner of the  
vehicle registers with OnStar. After  
the first prepaid year, contact  
OnStar to select a monthly or annual  
subscription payment plan. If a  
payment plan is not selected, the  
OnStar system and all services,  
including airbag notification  
OnStar uses several innovative  
technologies and live advisors to  
provide a wide range of safety,  
security, information, and  
convenience services. If the airbags  
deploy, the system is designed to  
make an automatic call to OnStar  
Emergency advisors who can  
request emergency services be sent  
to your location. If the keys are  
locked in the vehicle, call OnStar at  
1-888-4-ONSTAR to have a signal  
sent to unlock the doors. OnStar  
Hands-Free Calling, including 30 trial  
minutes good for 60 days, is  
available on most vehicles. OnStar  
Turn-by-Turn Navigation service,  
with one trial route, is available on  
most vehicles. Press the OnStar  
button to have an OnStar advisor  
contact Roadside Service.  
1-877-248-2080, or press the  
OnStar button to speak with an  
OnStar advisor 24 hours a day,  
7 days a week.  
and emergency services, may be  
deactivated and no longer available.  
For more information visit  
OnStar Services Available  
with the Safe & Sound Plan  
Automatic Notification of  
Airbag Deployment  
www.onstar.com (U.S.) or  
www.onstar.ca (Canada), or press  
the OnStar button to speak with  
an advisor.  
Advanced Automatic Crash  
Notification (AACN) (If equipped)  
Link to Emergency Services  
Roadside Assistance  
Stolen Vehicle Location  
Assistance  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-30  
Features and Controls  
Remote Door Unlock/  
Vehicle Alert  
OnStar Hands-Free Calling  
OnStar Turn-by-Turn  
Navigation  
OnStar Hands-Free Calling allows  
eligible OnStar subscribers to  
make and receive calls using voice  
commands. Hands-Free Calling  
is fully integrated into the vehicle,  
and can be used with OnStar  
Pre-Paid Minute Packages. Most  
vehicles include 30 trial minutes  
good for 60 days. Hands-Free  
Calling can also be linked to a  
Verizon Wireless service plan in  
the U.S. or a Bell Mobility service  
plan in Canada, depending on  
eligibility. To find out more, refer to  
the OnStar Owner’s Guide in  
the vehicle’s glove box, visit  
www.onstar.com or www.onstar.ca,  
or speak with an OnStar advisor  
by pressing the OnStar button  
or calling 1-888-4-ONSTAR  
OnStar Vehicle Diagnostic Email  
Vehicles with the OnStar  
Turn-by-Turn Navigation system  
can provide voice-guided driving  
directions. Press the OnStar button  
to have an OnStar advisor locate a  
business or address and download  
driving directions to the vehicle.  
Voice-guided directions to the  
desired destination will play through  
the audio system speakers. See the  
OnStar Owner’s Guide for more  
information.  
GM Goodwrench On Demand  
Diagnostics  
OnStar Hands-Free Calling  
with 30 trial minutes  
OnStar Virtual Advisor  
(U.S. Only)  
OnStar Services Included with  
Directions & Connections Plan  
All Safe and Sound Plan Services  
OnStar Turn-by-Turn Navigation  
(If equipped) or Driving  
Directions - Advisor delivered  
OnStar Virtual Advisor  
OnStar Virtual Advisor is a feature of  
OnStar Hands-Free Calling that uses  
minutes to access location-based  
weather, local traffic reports, and  
stock quotes. Press the phone button  
and give a few simple voice  
RideAssist  
Information and Convenience  
Services  
(1-888-466-7827).  
commands to browse through the  
various topics. See the OnStar  
Owner’s Guide for more information.  
This feature is only available in the  
continental U.S.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-31  
a place where the wireless service  
provider OnStar has hired for  
that area has coverage, network  
capacity and reception when  
the service is needed, and  
technology that is compatible with  
the OnStar service. Not all services  
are available everywhere,  
OnStar Steering Wheel  
Controls  
How OnStar Service Works  
The OnStar system can record and  
transmit vehicle information. This  
information is automatically sent to  
an OnStar Call Center when the  
OnStar button is pressed, the  
emergency button is pressed, or if  
the airbags or AACN system deploy.  
This information usually includes  
the vehicles GPS location and,  
in the event of a crash, additional  
information regarding the crash that  
the vehicle was involved in (e.g.  
the direction from which the vehicle  
was hit). When the Virtual Advisor  
feature of OnStar Hands-Free  
Calling is used, the vehicle also  
sends OnStar the vehicles  
This vehicle may have a Talk/Mute  
button that can be used to  
interact with OnStar Hands-Free  
Controls on page 3-82 for more  
information.  
particularly in remote or enclosed  
areas, or at all times.  
OnStar voice command does not  
work unless Personal Calling  
is activated. To activate Personal  
Calling, see the OnStar Owner’s  
Guide.  
Location information about the  
vehicle is only available if the GPS  
satellite signals are unobstructed  
and available.  
On some vehicles, the mute button  
can be used to dial numbers  
into voice mail systems, or to dial  
phone extensions. See the OnStar  
Owner’s Guide for more  
The vehicle must have a working  
electrical system, including adequate  
battery power, for the OnStar  
equipment to operate. There are  
other problems OnStar cannot  
control that may prevent OnStar from  
providing OnStar service at any  
particular time or place. Some  
GPS location so they can provide  
services where it is located.  
information.  
OnStar service cannot work unless  
the vehicle is in a place where  
OnStar has an agreement with a  
wireless service provider for service  
in that area. OnStar service also  
cannot work unless the vehicle is in  
examples are damage to important  
parts of the vehicle in a crash, hills,  
tall buildings, tunnels, weather or  
wireless phone network congestion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-32  
Features and Controls  
Your Responsibility  
This device complies with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada.  
Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions:  
Universal Home  
Remote System  
The Universal Home Remote  
System provides a way to  
replace up to three hand-held  
Radio-Frequency (RF) transmitters  
used to activate devices such  
as garage door openers, security  
systems, and home lighting.  
Increase the volume of the radio if  
the OnStar advisor cannot be heard.  
If the light next to the OnStar  
buttons is red, the system may not  
be functioning properly. Press  
the OnStar button and request a  
vehicle diagnostic. If the light  
appears clear (no light is appearing),  
your OnStar subscription has  
expired and all services have been  
deactivated. Press the OnStar  
button to confirm that the OnStar  
equipment is active.  
1. This device may not cause  
interference.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the  
device.  
This device complies with Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. Operation is subject  
to the following two conditions:  
Changes or modifications to  
this system by other than an  
authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
1. This device may not cause  
harmful interference.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-33  
Do not use the Universal Home  
Remote with any garage door  
opener that does not have the stop  
and reverse feature. This includes  
any garage door opener model  
manufactured before April 1, 1982.  
When programming a garage door,  
park outside of the garage. Park  
directly in line with and facing  
the garage door opener motor-head  
or gate motor-head. Be sure that  
people and objects are clear of the  
garage door or gate that is being  
programmed.  
Universal Home Remote  
System Operation  
Read the instructions completely  
before attempting to program the  
Universal Home Remote. Because of  
the steps involved, it may be helpful  
to have another person available to  
assist you in the programming the  
Universal Home Remote.  
It is recommended that a new  
battery be installed in your  
hand-held transmitter for quicker  
and more accurate transmission of  
the radio-frequency signal.  
If there is one triangular Light  
Emitting Diode (LED) indicator light  
above the Universal Home  
Remote buttons, follow the  
instructions below.  
Keep the original hand-held  
transmitter for use in other vehicles  
as well as for future Universal  
Home Remote programming. It is  
also recommended that upon  
the sale of the vehicle, the  
programmed Universal Home  
Remote buttons should be erased  
for security purposes. See “Erasing  
Universal Home Remote Buttons”  
later in this section.  
Programming the Universal  
Home Remote System  
This system provides a way to  
replace up to three remote control  
transmitters used to activate devices  
such as garage door openers,  
security systems, and home  
automation devices.  
For questions or help programming  
the Universal Home Remote  
System, call 1-800-355-3515  
or go to homelink.com.  
Programming a garage door opener  
involves time-sensitive actions,  
so read the entire procedure before  
starting. Otherwise, the device  
will time out and the procedure will  
have to be repeated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-34  
Features and Controls  
To program up to three devices:  
2. Hold the end of your hand-held  
transmitter about 1 to 3 inches  
(3 to 8 cm) away from the  
4. The indicator light on the  
Universal Home Remote  
will flash slowly at first and then  
rapidly after Universal Home  
Remote successfully receives  
the frequency signal from  
the hand-held transmitter.  
Release both buttons.  
Universal Home Remote buttons  
while keeping the indicator light in  
view. The hand-held transmitter  
was supplied by the manufacturer  
of your garage door opener  
receiver (motor head unit).  
5. Press and hold the newly-trained  
Universal Home Remote button  
and observe the indicator light.  
3. At the same time, press and hold  
both the Universal Home Remote  
button to be used to control the  
garage door and the hand-held  
transmitter button. Do not release  
the Universal Home Remote  
button or the hand-held  
If the indicator light stays on  
continuously, the programming is  
complete and the garage door  
should move when the Universal  
Home Remote button is pressed  
and released. There is no need to  
continue programming Steps 6  
through 8.  
1. From inside the vehicle, press  
and hold down the two outside  
buttons at the same time,  
transmitter button until Step 4  
has been completed.  
releasing only when the Universal  
Home Remote indicator light  
begins to flash, after 20 seconds.  
This step will erase the factory  
settings or all previously  
Some entry gates and garage  
door openers may require  
substitution of Step 3 with the  
procedure noted in “Gate  
Operator and Canadian  
Programming” later in this  
section.  
If the Universal Home Remote  
indicator light blinks rapidly  
for two seconds and then turns  
to a constant light, continue  
with the programming Steps 6  
through 8.  
programmed buttons.  
Do not hold down the buttons for  
longer than 30 seconds and do  
not repeat this step to program  
the remaining two Universal  
Home Remote buttons.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-35  
It may be helpful to have another  
person assist with the remaining  
steps.  
7. Firmly press and release the  
“Learn” or “Smart” button.  
After you press this button,  
you will have 30 seconds  
to complete Step 8.  
To program the remaining  
two Universal Home Remote  
buttons, begin with Step 2 of  
“Programming the Universal Home  
Remote System.” Do not repeat  
Step 1, as this will erase all previous  
programming from the Universal  
Home Remote buttons.  
8. Immediately return to the vehicle.  
Firmly press and hold the  
Universal Home Remote button,  
chosen in Step 3 to control  
the garage door, for two seconds,  
and then release it. If the  
Gate Operator and Canadian  
Programming  
If you have questions or need  
help programming the Universal  
Home Remote System, call  
1-800-355-3515 or go to  
homelink.com.  
garage door does not move,  
press and hold the same button  
a second time for two seconds,  
and then release it. Again, if  
the door does not move, press  
and hold the same button a  
third time for two seconds, and  
then release.  
6. After Steps 1 through 5 have  
been completed, locate inside  
the garage the garage door  
opener receiver (motor-head  
unit). Locate the “Learn” or  
“Smart” button. The name and  
color of the button may vary  
by manufacturer.  
Canadian radio-frequency laws  
require transmitter signals to time  
out or quit after several seconds of  
transmission. This may not be long  
enough for Universal Home Remote  
to pick up the signal during  
The Universal Home Remote  
should now activate the  
garage door.  
programming. Similarly, some U.S.  
gate operators are manufactured to  
time out in the same manner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-36  
Features and Controls  
If you live in Canada, or you are  
having difficulty programming a gate  
operator or garage door opener  
by using the “Programming  
Proceed with Step 4 under  
“Programming Universal Home  
Remote” to complete.  
To erase all programmed buttons on  
the Universal Home Remote device:  
Using Universal Home Remote  
Universal Home Remote”  
procedures, regardless of where  
you live, replace Step 3 under  
“Programming Universal Home  
Remote” with the following:  
Press and hold the appropriate  
Universal Home Remote button for  
at least half of a second. The  
indicator light will come on while the  
signal is being transmitted.  
Continue to press and hold the  
Universal Home Remote button  
while you press and release every  
two seconds (cycle) the hand-held  
transmitter button until the frequency  
signal has been successfully  
accepted by the Universal Home  
Remote. The Universal Home  
Remote indicator light will flash  
slowly at first and then rapidly.  
Erasing Universal Home  
Remote Buttons  
The programmed buttons should be  
erased when the vehicle is sold  
or the lease ends.  
1. Press and hold down the  
two outside buttons until the  
indicator light begins to flash,  
after 20 seconds.  
2. Release both buttons.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features and Controls  
2-37  
Reprogramming a Single  
Universal Home Remote  
Button  
Sunglasses Storage  
Compartment  
Your vehicle may have a sunglasses  
storage compartment located near  
the rearview mirror. Push the  
cover to open.  
Storage Areas  
Glove Box  
To open the glove box, lift up on the  
lever. The glove box divider can  
be removed. The slots on the  
To reprogram any of the three  
Universal Home Remote buttons,  
repeat the programming instructions  
earlier in this section, beginning  
with Step 2.  
left side are for storing the divider.  
Center Console Storage  
For help or information on the  
Universal Home Remote System,  
call the customer assistance phone  
Offices on page 7-5.  
Cupholders  
There are cupholders located in  
front of and behind the center  
console.  
Your vehicle has a center console  
with an upper, lower and rear  
storage area. To access the upper  
storage area, lift up on the top  
lever. To access the lower storage  
area, lift up on the bottom lever.  
To access the cupholders behind  
the center console, push the button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-38  
Features and Controls  
The top of the center console can  
extend forward. To adjust, hold  
the top of the lever up and pull the  
top of the center console forward.  
Driver Storage  
Compartment  
Your vehicle has a storage area  
located to left of the steering wheel.  
Pull down on the handle to access.  
Convenience Net  
Use the convenience net, located in  
the rear, to store small loads as  
far forward as possible. The  
net should not be used to store  
heavy loads.  
Rear Seat Armrest  
Cargo Cover  
For vehicles with a cargo cover, use  
it to cover items in the rear of the  
vehicle.  
To remove the cover and remove it  
from the vehicle, pull both ends  
toward each other. To reinstall,  
place each end of the cover in the  
holes behind the rear seat.  
To open the cover of the the rear  
storage area, push the button  
located at the top.  
To access the rear seat armrest, pull  
the handle down. Lift the top of the  
armrest to access the storage area.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Features and Controls  
2-39  
The hooks hold the mesh pocket.  
To insert a hook on the rail,  
place the hook in the upper groove  
of the rail and press it into the  
lower groove.  
Cargo Tie Downs  
Four cargo tie-downs are located in  
the rear compartment of the  
vehicle. The tie-downs can be used  
to secure small loads.  
Cargo Management  
System  
The adapters are used to hold the  
net. Slide the adapters to the  
desired location on the upper and  
lower rail and turn the handle  
up to lock it in place. Compress the  
rods of the net and insert them  
into the corresponding openings of  
the adapter. The longer rod is  
for the upper adapter.  
If the vehicle has a cargo  
management system in the rear of  
the vehicle, it will have rails with  
adapters and hooks. These are used  
to hold the net and mesh pocket.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2-40  
Features and Controls  
NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-1  
Warning Lights, Gages,  
and Indicators  
Instrument Panel  
Instrument Panel  
Overview  
StabiliTrak®/Traction  
Climate Controls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-2  
Instrument Panel  
Driver Information  
Center (DIC)  
Audio System(s)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-3  
NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4  
Instrument Panel  
Instrument Panel Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-5  
The main components of the  
instrument panel are the following:  
Hazard Warning Flashers  
on page 3-82.  
| (Hazard Warning Flasher):  
Press this button located on  
page 3-22.  
page 3-9.  
the instrument panel, to make the  
front and rear turn signal lamps flash  
on and off. This warns others that  
you are having trouble.  
page 3-14.  
on page 4-8  
R. Shift Lever. See Automatic  
page 2-20.  
on page 3-6.  
Press | again to turn the  
flashers off.  
page 3-23.  
System on page 3-17.  
E. Windshield Wipers on page 3-7.  
Horn  
F. Audio System(s) on page 3-56.  
page 3-5.  
Press near or on the horn symbols  
on the steering wheel pad to  
sound the horn.  
G. Auxiliary Input Jack. See  
Radio(s) on page 3-58.  
Indicator on page 3-26.  
H. Exterior Lamps on page 3-12.  
(DIC) on page 3-36.  
page 3-24.  
W. Glove Box on page 2-37.  
page 2-38.  
K. Hood Release on page 5-9.  
L. Cruise Control on page 3-9.  
M. Tilt Wheel on page 3-6.  
N. Horn on page 3-5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-6  
Instrument Panel  
Tilt Wheel  
The tilt lever lets the steering wheel  
be adjusted.  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Turn and Lane-Change  
Lever  
Signals  
An arrow on the instrument panel  
cluster flashes in the direction of the  
turn or lane change.  
Move the lever all the way up or  
down to signal a turn.  
The lever on the left side of the  
steering column includes:  
Raise or lower the lever until the  
arrow starts to flash and then  
release, to signal a lane change.  
The turn signal flashes automatically  
three times.  
G : Turn and Lane-Change  
Signals  
3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam  
Changer  
The tilt lever is located on the left  
side of the steering column.  
The lever returns to its starting  
position whenever it is released.  
Flash-to-Pass Feature.  
To adjust the steering wheel, hold  
the wheel and push the lever down.  
Then move the wheel to a  
comfortable position and pull the  
lever up firmly to lock the steering  
column in place.  
Information for these features is on  
the pages following.  
If after signaling a turn or lane  
change the arrow flashes rapidly or  
does not come on, a signal bulb  
may be burned out.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-7  
Have the bulbs replaced. If a bulb is  
not burned out, check the fuse. See  
Flash-to-Pass  
8 (Mist): For a single wiping  
cycle. The lever returns to its  
This feature lets you use your  
high-beam headlamps to signal a  
driver in front of you that you want  
to pass.  
starting position when released. For  
more cycles, hold the lever down  
before releasing it.  
page 5-75 and for burned-out bulbs.  
Headlamp High/  
Low-Beam Changer  
9 (Off): Turns the wipers off.  
To flash the high beams  
from low beam, pull the turn  
signal/multifunction lever all the  
way towards you. Then release it.  
& (Intermittent): Sets a delay  
between wipes. To set for a shorter  
or longer delay between wipes,  
move the switch on top of the lever  
left or right to decrease or  
2 3 Headlamp High/Low Beam  
Changer: Push the turn  
signal/multifunction lever away from  
you to turn the high beams on.  
Windshield Wipers  
Pull the lever towards you to return  
to low beams.  
increase wiper movement.  
a (Low): For slow, steady wiping  
cycles.  
1 (High): For rapid wiping cycles.  
Clear ice and snow from the wiper  
blades before using them. If the  
wiper blades are frozen to the  
windshield, gently loosen or thaw  
them. If they become damaged,  
install new blades or blade inserts.  
Replacement on page 5-38.  
This indicator light turns on in the  
instrument panel cluster when  
the high beam headlamps are on.  
The windshield wiper lever is  
located on the right side of the  
steering column.  
Push up or pull down on the lever to  
place it in one of the following  
positions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-8  
Instrument Panel  
Heavy snow or ice can overload the  
wiper motor. A circuit breaker will  
stop the motor until it cools down.  
Since different drivers have  
Windshield Washer  
different setting preferences, it is  
recommended that the mid-range  
setting (position 3) be used initially.  
For more wipes, select the higher  
settings; for fewer wipes, select the  
lower settings located closer to the  
off position on the multifunction lever.  
{ CAUTION  
Rainsense™ II Wipers  
In freezing weather, do not use  
your washer until the windshield is  
warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the  
For vehicles with Rainsense™ II  
windshield wipers, the moisture  
sensor is located next to the inside  
rearview mirror and is mounted  
on the windshield. When active,  
these sensors are able to detect  
moisture on the windshield and  
automatically turn on the wipers.  
The sensor will automatically control  
the frequency of the wipes from  
the off setting to the high speed  
setting according to the weather  
conditions. The wipers can be left in  
a rainsense mode even when it is  
not raining.  
windshield, blocking your vision.  
Pull the windshield wiper lever  
toward you to spray washer fluid on  
the windshield. The wipers will run  
for a few cycles to clear the  
windshield. For more wash cycles,  
pull the lever forward and hold.  
To turn on the Rainsense feature,  
the wipers must be set to one  
of the five delay settings on the  
multifunction lever. Each of the five  
settings adjusts the sensitivity of  
the sensor.  
When Rainsense is active, the  
headlamps will turn on automatically  
if the exterior lamp control is in  
the AUTO position and the wipers  
are active.  
Heated Windshield Washer  
Nozzles  
This feature prevents the windshield  
washer fluid from freezing on the  
nozzle during cold conditions.  
The heated nozzles are turned on  
when the rear window defogger  
is activated. See Automatic Climate  
Control System on page 3-17.  
Notice: Going through an  
automatic car wash with the  
wipers on can damage them. Turn  
the wipers off when going  
through an automatic car wash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-9  
Rear Window  
Wiper/Washer  
The rear wiper and rear wash  
button is located on the instrument  
panel above the climate control  
system.  
Cruise Control  
{ CAUTION  
With cruise control, the vehicle can  
maintain a speed of about 25 mph  
(40 km/h) or more without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator.  
Cruise control does not work at  
speeds below 25 mph (40 km/h).  
Cruise control can be dangerous  
where you cannot drive safely at a  
steady speed. So, do not use the  
cruise control on winding roads or  
in heavy traffic.  
= (Rear Wiper/Washer): Press to  
For vehicles with the StabiliTrak®  
system that begins to limit wheel  
spin while you are using cruise  
control, the cruise control will  
automatically disengage. See  
StabiliTrak® System on page 4-7.  
Cruise control can be dangerous  
on slippery roads. On such roads,  
fast changes in tire traction can  
cause excessive wheel slip, and  
you could lose control. Do not use  
cruise control on slippery roads.  
wash and wipe the rear window.  
The rear window washer uses  
the same reservoir as the windshield  
washer. Check the windshield  
washer reservoir level if the front  
windshield can be worked, but  
no fluid is sprayed when the rear  
washer is activated. See Windshield  
Washer Fluid on page 5-24.  
5 (Delay): Press to turn the  
delayed wiping on or off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-10  
Instrument Panel  
Setting Cruise Control  
Resuming a Set Speed  
E (On/Off): Press to turn the cruise  
control system on and off. An  
indicator light comes on.  
If the cruise control is set at a  
{ CAUTION  
desired speed and then the brakes  
are applied, the cruise control is  
disengaged. The indicator light on  
the instrument panel cluster goes  
out when the cruise is no longer  
engaged. To return to the previously  
set speed, press the thumbwheel up  
toward RES+ briefly when the  
RES+ (Resume/Accel): Move the  
thumbwheel up to resume a set  
speed or to accelerate to a higher  
speed.  
If you leave your cruise control on  
when you are not using cruise,  
you might hit a button and go into  
cruise when you do not want to.  
You could be startled and even  
lose control. Keep the cruise  
control switch off until you want to  
use cruise control.  
SET(Set/Coast): Move the  
thumbwheel down to set a speed or  
to decrease the speed.  
vehicle has reached a speed of  
about 25 mph (40 km/h) or more.  
To set a speed:  
This accelerates the vehicle to the  
previously selected speed.  
1. Press E to turn cruise control on.  
The indicator light on the button  
comes on.  
Increasing Speed While Using  
Cruise Control  
2. Get to the speed desired.  
To increase the cruise speed while  
using cruise control:  
3. Press the thumbwheel toward  
SET and release it.  
Press the thumbwheel up toward  
RES+ and hold it until the vehicle  
accelerates to the desired speed,  
and then release the switch.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator  
pedal.  
When the brakes are applied, the  
cruise control shuts off.  
The cruise control buttons are  
located on the left side of the  
steering wheel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-11  
Passing Another Vehicle While  
Using Cruise Control  
Ending Cruise Control  
To increase the speed in small  
amounts, press the thumbwheel  
up toward RES+ briefly and then  
release it. Each time this is done,  
the vehicle goes about 1 mph  
(1.6 km/h) faster.  
There are three ways to disengage  
the cruise control:  
Use the accelerator pedal to  
increase the vehicle’s speed. When  
you take your foot off the pedal,  
the vehicle will slow down to  
the previously set cruise control  
speed.  
Step lightly on the brake pedal or  
clutch; when cruise control  
disengages, the indicator light on  
the instrument panel cluster  
goes out.  
Use the accelerator pedal to  
reach the desired speed  
and press the thumbwheel  
towards SET. The new desired  
speed must be greater than  
the previous set speed by  
typically 5 mph.  
Using Cruise Control on Hills  
Press E to turn off the cruise  
control system.  
How well the cruise control works on  
hills depends upon the vehicle’s  
speed, load, and the steepness of  
the hills. When going up steep  
hills, you might have to step on the  
accelerator pedal to maintain the  
vehicle’s speed. When going  
downhill, you might have to brake or  
shift to a lower gear to maintain  
the vehicle’s speed. For some  
vehicles the transmission may  
automatically downshift when going  
down hills to help maintain the  
vehicle’s speed. When the brakes  
are applied the cruise control  
shuts off.  
Erasing Speed Memory  
The cruise control set speed memory  
is erased when the cruise control or  
the ignition is turned off.  
Reducing Speed While Using  
Cruise Control  
If the cruise control system is  
already engaged,  
Push the thumbwheel toward  
SET and hold until the desired  
lower speed is reached, then  
release it.  
To slow down in very small  
amounts, push the thumbwheel  
toward SET briefly. Each time  
this is done, the vehicle goes  
about 1 mph (1.6 km/h) slower.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-12  
Instrument Panel  
AUTO (Automatic): Automatically  
turns the exterior lamps on and  
off, depending on outside lighting.  
Exterior Lamps  
Wiper Activated  
Headlamps  
This feature automatically turns  
on the headlamps and parking  
lamps if the exterior lamp control is  
set in the AUTO position and the  
windshield wipers are turned on and  
have completed eight wipe cycles.  
See Exterior Lamps on page 3-12  
for additional information.  
; (Parking Lamps): Turns on the  
parking lamps together with the  
following:  
Sidemarker Lamps  
Taillamps  
License Plate Lamps  
Instrument Panel Lights  
When the ignition is turned off,  
the wiper-activated headlamps  
immediately turn off. They also turn  
off if the windshield wiper control  
is turned off.  
2 (Headlamps): Turns on the  
headlamps, together with the  
previously listed lamps and lights.  
The exterior lamp control is located  
on the instrument panel to the  
left of the steering wheel.  
The exterior lamp control can be  
turned to the following positions:  
Lamps On Reminder  
A warning chime sounds, if the driver  
door is opened while the ignition is  
off and the lamps are on.  
9 (Off): Turns off the exterior  
lamps. The knob returns to  
the AUTO position after it is  
released.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-13  
When the DRL are on, the low-beam  
headlamps will be on. The taillamps,  
sidemarker, instrument panel lights  
and other lamps will not be on.  
Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL)  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can  
make it easier for others to see  
the front of your vehicle during the  
day. Fully functional daytime  
Automatic Headlamp  
System  
When it is dark enough outside, the  
headlamps come on automatically.  
When the exterior lamp band is  
turned to the headlamp position, the  
regular headlamps will come on. The  
other lamps that come on with the  
headlamps will also come on.  
running lamps are required on all  
vehicles first sold in Canada.  
The DRL system makes the  
low-beam headlamps come on  
in daylight when the following  
conditions are met:  
When the headlamps are turned off,  
the regular lamps also turn off, and  
the low-beam headlamps turn on.  
The regular headlamp system  
should be used when needed.  
The engine is running,  
The exterior lamp band is in  
AUTO, and  
There is a light sensor located on top  
of the instrument panel. Do not cover  
the sensor or the headlamps will  
come on when they are not needed.  
The light sensor determines it is  
daytime.  
The system may also turn on the  
headlamps when driving through a  
parking garage or tunnel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-14  
Instrument Panel  
ACC/ACCESSORY position. The  
lights will then gradually dim until it  
is no longer lit.  
Instrument Panel  
Brightness  
This feature controls the brightness  
of the instrument panel lights.  
Dome Lamp  
* (Dome Lamp Override): Press  
this button to keep the dome  
lamps and other interior lamps  
turned off while any door is open.  
Press this button again to return it to  
the out position and the lamps  
automatically come on when any  
door is opened.  
Reading Lamps  
The reading lamps are located on  
the overhead console.  
To turn the reading lamps on or off,  
press the button located next to  
each lamp.  
+ (On/Off): Press this button to  
turn the dome lamps on and off  
while the doors are closed.  
Electric Power  
Management  
The vehicle has Electric Power  
Management (EPM) that estimates  
the battery’s temperature and  
state of charge. It then adjusts the  
voltage for best performance  
Entry Lighting  
If the dome lamp override button is  
in the out position, the lamps  
inside the vehicle automatically  
come on when any door is opened  
or when the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) unlock button is  
pressed. After the door is opened  
the lights remain on and stay on for  
20 seconds after the doors are  
closed, or until the key is put into  
the ignition and turned to the  
The thumbwheel for this feature is  
located on the left side of the  
steering wheel next to the exterior  
lamps control.  
and extended life of the battery.  
When the battery’s state of charge is  
low, the voltage is raised slightly to  
quickly bring the charge back up.  
When the state of charge is high, the  
voltage is lowered slightly to prevent  
overcharging. If the vehicle has a  
voltmeter gage or a voltage display  
Turn the thumbwheel to the right or  
left to brighten or dim the lights.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-15  
on the Driver Information Center  
EPM works to prevent excessive  
discharge of the battery. It does this  
by balancing the generator’s output  
and the vehicle’s electrical needs. It  
can increase engine idle speed to  
generate more power, whenever  
needed. It can temporarily reduce  
the power demands of some  
accessories.  
Battery Run-Down  
Protection  
The battery saver feature is  
designed to protect the vehicle’s  
battery.  
(DIC), you may see the voltage move  
up or down. This is normal. If there is  
a problem, an alert will be displayed.  
The battery can be discharged at  
idle if the electrical loads are  
very high. This is true for all  
vehicles. This is because the  
generator (alternator) may not be  
spinning fast enough at idle to  
produce all the power that is needed  
for very high electrical loads.  
If any interior or exterior lamp is left  
on and the ignition is turned off, the  
battery rundown protection system  
automatically turns the lamp off after  
10 minutes.  
Normally, these actions occur in  
steps or levels, without being  
noticeable. In rare cases at the  
highest levels of corrective action,  
this action may be noticeable to the  
driver. If so, a Driver Information  
Center (DIC) message might be  
displayed, such as BATTERY  
SAVER ACTIVE, BATTERY  
VOLTAGE LOW, or LOW BATTERY.  
If this message is displayed, it is  
recommended that the driver reduce  
the electrical loads as much as  
possible. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 3-42.  
A high electrical load occurs when  
several of the following are on, such  
as: headlamps, high beams, fog  
lamps, rear window defogger,  
climate control fan at high speed,  
heated seats, engine cooling fans,  
trailer loads, and loads plugged into  
accessory power outlets.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-16  
Instrument Panel  
Notice: Leaving electrical  
equipment on for extended  
periods will drain the battery.  
Always turn off electrical  
equipment when not in use and  
do not plug in equipment that  
exceeds the maximum 20 ampere  
rating.  
When adding electrical equipment,  
be sure to follow the installation  
instructions included with the  
equipment.  
Accessory Power  
Outlet(s)  
The accessory power outlets can be  
used to connect electrical equipment,  
such as a cellular phone.  
Notice: Improper use of the  
power outlet can cause damage  
not covered by the warranty.  
Do not hang any type of  
accessory or accessory bracket  
from the plug because the  
power outlets are designed for  
accessory power plugs only.  
The accessory power outlets are  
located on the rear of the center  
storage console and in the  
rear cargo compartment. There may  
be a power outlet located inside  
the instrument panel storage  
area below the climate controls.  
Certain electrical accessories may  
not be compatible with the  
accessory power outlet and could  
result in blown vehicle or adapter  
fuses. If you experience a problem,  
see your dealer/retailer for  
To use the outlets, remove the cover.  
When not in use, always cover the  
outlet with the protective cap.  
additional information on the  
accessory power outlet.  
Notice: Adding any electrical  
equipment to your vehicle  
may damage it or keep other  
components from working as they  
should. The repairs would not  
be covered by your warranty.  
Check with your dealer/retailer  
before adding electrical  
equipment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-17  
Climate Controls  
Climate Control Influence on  
Hybrid Operation and Fuel  
Economy  
Automatic Climate Control System  
To maximize your fuel economy, use  
the following settings (as indicated  
by the green marking):  
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can be controlled with  
this system.  
Set the fan knob to AUTO.  
Set the air delivery knob  
to AUTO.  
Select an air temperature setting  
near 75°F (23°C).  
Select the Hybrid A/C button, if  
A/C is required.  
Avoid using these settings that may  
lead to fewer auto stops and to  
higher fuel consumption:  
E. Hybrid Air Conditioning  
F. Recirculation  
A. Fan Control  
Manual fan speed operation.  
B. Temperature Control  
C. Air Delivery Mode Control  
D. Normal Air Conditioning  
Defrost mode. Only use this  
setting to clear the windows.  
G. Rear Window Defogger  
Extreme cold or hot air  
temperature settings, such as  
60°F (16°C) or 90°F (32°C).  
Normal air conditioning mode, if  
A/C is required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-18  
Instrument Panel  
AUTO (Automatic Air Delivery  
Mode): Turn the air delivery mode  
knob to AUTO for the system to  
automatically control the direction of  
the airflow to help reach the  
The length of time needed to warm  
the interior depends on the  
outside temperature and inside  
temperature of the vehicle.  
Automatic Operation  
This climate control system  
automatically maintains the desired  
temperature inside the vehicle.  
Manual Operation  
Do not cover the sensor located on  
the top of the instrument panel  
near the windshield or the sensor  
grille below the climate control  
faceplate. These two sensors help  
regulate the inside air temperature.  
desired inside temperature.  
It is best to use the automatic  
settings to maximize fuel economy.  
The system automatically controls  
the air inlet to supply the outside air  
or recirculated inside air needed  
to cool the vehicle faster. The  
indicator light on the recirculation  
button will be lit whenever the  
system changes to recirculation.  
Press the recirculation button  
to change to outside air. However,  
the recirculation mode may turn  
back on automatically.  
A (Fan Control): Turn clockwise  
or counterclockwise to increase  
or decrease the fan speed. To turn  
the fan off, turn the left knob to  
AUTO (Automatic Fan): Turn  
the fan knob to AUTO for the system  
to automatically adjust the fan  
speed to reach the desired inside  
temperature.  
the 9 position. In any setting other  
than off, the fan runs continuously  
with the ignition on. The fan must be  
turned on to run the air conditioning  
compressor. There will be some  
airflow noticeable from the various  
outlets when driving, even with  
the fan in the off position. This is to  
ensure some fresh air is always  
available in the vehicle. To turn off  
the air completely, turn the fan  
Temperature Control: Select the  
desired air temperature between  
60-90°F (16-32°C). Typically,  
the best setting is near 75°F (23°C).  
Choosing the coldest or warmest  
temperature setting does not cause  
the system to heat or cool any  
faster.  
In cold weather, if the fan and air  
delivery modes are in automatic, the  
system starts at lower fan speeds  
to avoid directing cold air into  
the vehicle until warmer air is  
available. The climate control  
system directs air to the floor, but  
may automatically change modes as  
the vehicle warms up to maintain  
the chosen temperature setting.  
to 9 and select the recirculation  
button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-19  
Temperature Control: Turn  
clockwise or counterclockwise to  
increase or decrease the  
temperature. Typically, the best  
setting is near 75°F (23°C).  
Choosing the coldest or warmest  
temperature setting does not cause  
the system to heat or cool any faster.  
6 (Floor): Air is directed to the  
floor outlets with some air directed to  
the windshield. When this mode is  
selected, the system turns the  
recirculation mode off. Recirculation  
mode cannot be selected while  
in floor mode. This is to help prevent  
window fogging.  
0 (Defrost): This mode removes  
fog or frost from the windshield  
more quickly. Air is directed to the  
windshield, with some air directed to  
the side window outlets and the  
floor outlets. In this mode, the  
system turns the recirculation mode  
off automatically and runs the air  
conditioning compressor unless the  
outside air is at or below freezing.  
The recirculation mode cannot  
be selected while in defrost mode.  
This helps prevent window  
fogging and moisture building up  
inside the vehicle. In this mode, the  
climate control system prevents  
all automatic engine start/stop  
operations. This ensures the best  
defrost performance.  
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn  
clockwise or counterclockwise  
to change the direction of the  
airflow inside the vehicle.  
- (Defog): This mode clears the  
windows of fog or moisture. Air  
is directed to the floor outlets, with  
some air directed to the windshield  
and side window outlets. In this  
mode, the system turns the  
recirculation mode off and runs the  
air conditioning compressor  
unless the outside air is at or below  
freezing. Recirculation mode  
cannot be selected while in defog  
mode. This helps prevent window  
fogging.  
Select from the following air delivery  
modes:  
H (Vent): Air is directed to the  
instrument panel outlets.  
) (Bi-Level): Air is divided  
between the instrument panel and  
the floor outlets.  
For best results, clear all snow and  
ice from the windshield before  
defrosting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-20  
Instrument Panel  
any mode, except defrost as long as  
the fan is on and the outside air  
temperature is above freezing.  
Hybrid A/C cannot be selected at  
the same time as the normal  
air conditioning. A flashing indicator  
light shows the air conditioning  
compressor is not available.  
the recirculation mode during high  
periods of humidity and cool outside  
temperatures since this may  
result in increased window fogging.  
If window fogging is experienced,  
select the defrost mode.  
# (Normal Air Conditioning):  
Press to turn the air conditioning  
system on or off. An indicator  
light comes on to show that the air  
conditioning is on. Normal Air  
Conditioning (A/C) can be selected  
in any mode as long as the fan  
is on and the outside air temperature  
is above freezing. Normal A/C  
cannot be selected at the same time  
as Hybrid Air Conditioning (A/C).  
A flashing indicator light indicates  
that the air conditioning compressor  
is currently not available.  
Recirculation mode is not available  
in floor, defog or defrost modes.  
If the button is selected in  
these modes, the indicator will flash.  
This helps prevent window fogging  
and moisture building up inside  
the vehicle.  
The Hybrid A/C works to balance  
fuel economy and air conditioning  
comfort. When Hybrid A/C is used in  
warm weather, the vehicle gets  
better fuel economy by allowing  
more frequent start/stops. For  
additional cooling, select Normal  
A/C. See “Air Conditioning and  
Automatic Engine Start/Stop” later in  
this section.  
Rear Window Defogger  
When Normal A/C is selected, the  
climate control system prevents  
all automatic engine start/stop  
operations. This will ensure the  
cabin comfort is maintained.  
See “Air Conditioning and Automatic  
Engine Start/Stop” later in this  
section.  
The rear window defogger uses a  
warming grid to remove fog from the  
rear window.  
The rear window defogger will only  
work when the ignition is in  
ON/RUN.  
@ (Recirculation): Press to  
toggle between the recirculation and  
outside air modes. The indicator  
light turns on when the recirculation  
mode is selected. This mode can  
be used to prevent outside air  
and odors from entering the vehicle  
or to help cool the air inside the  
vehicle more quickly. Avoid using  
< (Rear Window Defogger):  
Press to turn the rear window  
defogger on or off. An indicator light  
on the button comes on to show  
that it is activated.  
N (Hybrid Air Conditioning):  
Press to turn the Hybrid A/C system  
on or off. An indicator light comes  
on to show that Hybrid A/C is  
on. Hybrid A/C can be selected in  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-21  
The rear window defogger stays on  
for about 10 minutes if the vehicle  
remains at slower vehicle speeds or  
until the button is pressed, or  
unless the ignition is turned to  
ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/OFF. If  
turned on again, the defogger  
only runs for about five minutes  
before turning off again. At higher  
vehicle speeds, the defogger  
The use of Hybrid A/C allows  
automatic engine start/stop  
Air Conditioning and Engine  
Start/Stop  
operations while the vehicle is at a  
complete stop. The air conditioning  
compressor can not run when  
the engine is not running, resulting  
in reduced cooling performance.  
The climate control system  
may keep the engine running or  
restart the engine during a stop to  
continue cooling. Selecting the  
Normal A/C button forces the engine  
and air conditioning compressor  
to restart automatically. For  
On hot days, use the automatic fan  
and automatic air delivery mode  
settings and the vehicle will reach  
the desired temperature more  
quickly. The desired fan and air  
delivery mode settings can still be  
adjusted manually. Open the  
windows to let the hot inside air  
escape, then close them. This helps  
reduce the time it takes for the  
vehicle to cool down and helps the  
system to operate more efficiently.  
may stay on continuously. The  
defogger can also be turned off by  
turning off the ignition.  
Notice: Do not use anything  
sharp on the inside of the rear  
window. If you do, you could cut  
or damage the warming grid, and  
the repairs would not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty. Do not  
attach a temporary vehicle  
more information about Engine  
Start/Stop operation, see Starting  
Start/Stop) on page 2-15.  
When either the Normal A/C or  
Hybrid A/C modes are active, the air  
conditioning system removes  
moisture from the air, so a small  
amount of water may drip under the  
vehicle while idling or after turning  
off the engine. This is normal.  
license, tape, a decal or anything  
similar to the defogger grid.  
The use of Normal A/C causes the  
engine to keep running while  
the vehicle is at a complete stop to  
allow the climate control system  
to continue cooling.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-22  
Instrument Panel  
Gages can indicate when there may  
be or is a problem with one of the  
vehicle’s functions. Often gages and  
warning lights work together to  
Outlet Adjustment  
Use the louvers located on the air  
outlets to change the direction of the  
airflow.  
Warning Lights,  
Gages, and Indicators  
Warning lights and gages can  
signal that something is wrong  
before it becomes serious enough  
to cause an expensive repair or  
replacement. Paying attention to the  
warning lights and gages could  
prevent injury.  
indicate a problem with the vehicle.  
When one of the warning lights  
comes on and stays on while  
driving, or when one of the gages  
shows there may be a problem,  
check the section that explains what  
to do. Follow this manual’s advice.  
Waiting to do repairs can be  
Operation Tips  
Clear away any ice, snow, or  
leaves from the air inlets at  
the base of the vehicle that may  
block the flow of air into the  
vehicle.  
Warning lights come on when there  
may be or is a problem with one  
of the vehicle’s functions. Some  
warning lights come on briefly when  
the engine is started to indicate  
they are working.  
costly and even dangerous.  
Do not use any non-GM  
approved hood deflectors that  
could adversely affect the  
performance of the system.  
Keep the path under the front  
seats clear of objects to help  
circulate the air inside of  
the vehicle more effectively.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-23  
Instrument Panel Cluster  
The instrument panel cluster is designed to indicate how the vehicle is running. It shows how fast the vehicle is  
going, about how much fuel the vehicle has left and many other things needed to drive safely and economically.  
United States cluster, Canada similar  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-24  
Instrument Panel  
The auto stop indicator is located at  
the bottom of the tachometer. For  
more information see Auto Stop  
Mode on page 3-35.  
Speedometer and  
Odometer  
The speedometer shows the  
vehicle’s speed in both miles  
per hour (mph) and kilometers  
per hour (km/h).  
Trip Odometer  
The trip odometer is located on the  
instrument panel and shows how  
far the vehicle has been driven since  
the trip odometer was last reset.  
To reset the trip odometer to zero,  
press and hold the trip/reset  
button on the speedometer for  
about two seconds. Press the  
trip/reset button to switch between  
the trip odometer and odometer.  
Safety Belt Reminders  
Driver Safety Belt Reminder  
Light  
The odometer shows how far the  
vehicle has been driven, in  
either miles or kilometers.  
When the engine is started, a chime  
sounds for several seconds to  
remind the driver to fasten their  
safety belt, unless it is already  
buckled.  
If the vehicle needs a new odometer  
installed, the new one is set to  
the mileage total of the old  
Tachometer  
odometer. If it cannot, it will be set  
at zero and a label must be put  
on the driver’s door to show the old  
mileage reading when the new  
odometer was installed. If the  
mileage is unknown, the label  
should then indicate that the  
previous mileage is unknown.  
The safety on and  
stays on for several seconds,  
then flashes for several more.  
U.S. shown, Canada similar  
The tachometer displays the  
engine speed in revolutions  
per minute (rpm).  
This chime and light are repeated if  
the driver safety belt remains  
unbuckled and the vehicle is in  
motion. If the driver safety belt is  
already buckled, neither the  
chime nor the light comes on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-25  
The front passenger safety belt  
warning light and chime may turn on  
if an object is put on the seat  
such as a briefcase, handbag,  
grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device. To turn off the  
warning light and or chime, remove  
the object from the seat or buckle  
the safety belt.  
Passenger Safety Belt  
Reminder Light  
{ CAUTION  
Several seconds after the engine  
is started, a chime sounds for  
If the airbag readiness light stays  
on after the vehicle is started or  
comes on while driving, it means  
the airbag system might not be  
working properly. The airbags in  
the vehicle might not inflate in a  
crash, or they could even inflate  
without a crash. To help avoid  
injury, have the vehicle serviced  
right away.  
several seconds to remind the front  
passenger to buckle their safety belt.  
This only occurs if the passenger  
airbag is enabled. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 1-49 for  
more information. The passenger  
safety belt light, located on the  
instrument panel, comes on and  
stays on for several seconds and  
then flashes for several more.  
Airbag Readiness Light  
There is an airbag readiness light on  
the instrument panel cluster,  
which shows the airbag symbol. The  
system checks the airbag’s  
electrical system for malfunctions.  
The light indicates if there is an  
electrical problem. The system  
check includes the airbag sensor,  
the pretensioners, the airbag  
modules, the wiring and the crash  
sensing and diagnostic module.  
For more information on the airbag  
system, see Airbag System on  
page 1-41.  
The airbag readiness light comes on  
when the vehicle is started, and  
flashes for a few seconds. The light  
goes out when the system is ready.  
This chime and light are repeated if  
the passenger remains unbuckled  
and the vehicle is in motion.  
If the passenger safety belt is  
buckled before the engine is started,  
neither the chime nor the light  
comes on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-26  
Instrument Panel  
If the airbag readiness light stays on  
after the vehicle is started or  
comes on while driving, the airbag  
system may not work properly. Have  
the vehicle serviced right away.  
or either the on or off symbol to let  
you know the status of the right  
front passenger frontal and  
Passenger Airbag Status  
Indicator  
The vehicle has the passenger  
sensing system. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 1-49  
for important safety information. The  
instrument panel has a passenger  
airbag status indicator.  
seat-mounted side impact airbags.  
If the word ON or the on symbol  
is lit on the passenger airbag status  
indicator, it means that the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag are  
enabled (may inflate).  
The airbag readiness light should  
flash for a few seconds when  
the engine is started. If the light  
does not come on then, have it fixed  
immediately. If there is a problem  
with the airbag system, an  
airbag Driver Information Center  
(DIC) message may also come on.  
on page 3-42 for more information.  
If the word OFF or the off symbol is  
lit on the airbag status indicator,  
it means that the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag.  
United States  
If, after several seconds, both status  
indicator lights remain on, or if  
there are no lights at all, there may  
be a problem with the lights or  
the passenger sensing system. See  
your dealer/retailer for service.  
Canada  
When the vehicle is started, the  
passenger airbag status indicator  
will light ON and OFF, or the symbol  
for on and off, for several seconds  
as a system check. Then, after  
several more seconds, the status  
indicator will light either ON or OFF,  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-27  
If the light stays on, or comes on  
while driving, there could be a  
problem with the electrical charging  
system. Have it checked by your  
dealer/retailer. Driving while this light  
is on could drain the battery.  
light stays on if the parking brake  
does not fully release. If it stays on  
after the parking brake is fully  
released, there is a brake problem.  
Have the brake system inspected  
immediately.  
{ CAUTION  
If the airbag readiness light ever  
comes on and stays on, it means  
that something may be wrong with  
the airbag system. To help avoid  
injury to yourself or others, have  
the vehicle serviced right away.  
page 3-25 for more information,  
including important safety  
If a short distance must be driven  
with the light on, be sure to turn off  
all accessories, such as the  
radio and air conditioner.  
{ CAUTION  
The brake system might not be  
working properly if the brake  
system warning light is on. Driving  
with the brake system warning  
light on can lead to a crash. If the  
light is still on after the vehicle  
has been pulled off the road and  
carefully stopped, have the  
Brake System Warning  
Light  
information.  
Charging System Light  
vehicle towed for service.  
United States  
Canada  
The brake indicator light should  
come on briefly as the engine  
is started. If it does not come on  
have the vehicle serviced by  
your dealer/retailer.  
If the light comes on while driving, a  
chime sounds. Pull off the road and  
stop. The pedal might be harder to  
push or go closer to the floor. It might  
also take longer to stop. If the light is  
still on, have the vehicle towed for  
service. See Towing Your Vehicle on  
page 4-22.  
The charging system light comes on  
briefly when the ignition is turned  
on, but the engine is not running, as  
a check to show the light is  
working. It should go out when the  
engine is started.  
When the ignition is on, the brake  
system warning light comes on  
when the parking brake is set. The  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-28  
Instrument Panel  
If the ABS light remains on after  
resetting the system or comes  
on again while driving, the vehicle  
needs service. If the ABS light is on,  
but the regular brake system  
warning light is not on, the antilock  
brakes are not working properly,  
but the regular brakes are still  
functioning. Have the vehicle  
serviced right away. If both brake  
lights are on, the vehicle does  
not have antilock brakes, and there  
is a problem with the regular  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS) Warning Light  
StabiliTrak®/Traction  
Control System (TCS)  
Warning Light  
For vehicles with the Antilock Brake  
System (ABS), this light should  
come on briefly as the engine  
is started. If it does not come on  
have the vehicle serviced by  
your dealer/retailer.  
The Traction Control System  
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® system warning  
light comes on briefly as the  
engine is started.  
brakes as well. Have the vehicle  
towed for service. See Towing Your  
Vehicle on page 4-22.  
If it does not, have the vehicle  
serviced by your dealer/retailer. If  
the system is working normally  
the indicator lights go off.  
If the ABS light stays on longer than  
a few seconds after engine is  
started, or comes on and stays on  
while driving, try resetting the  
system. To reset the system:  
This light flashes while the Traction  
Control System (TCS) and/or the  
StabiliTrak system are working.  
It also flashes when the Antilock  
Brake System (ABS) is activated.  
1. While driving, pull over when it is  
safe to do so.  
2. Place the vehicle in P (PARK).  
3. Turn off the ignition.  
If the light comes on and stays  
on while driving there is a problem  
with the Traction Control System  
(TCS) or the StabiliTrak system. The  
4. Then restart the engine.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-29  
TCS and/or StabiliTrak system  
automatically turns off and vehicle  
needs service.  
If this light comes on and stays on,  
the engine has overheated. Pull  
over and see Engine Overheating on  
page 5-23 for more information.  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature Warning  
Light  
The engine coolant temperature  
light should come on briefly as the  
engine is started. If it does not  
come on have the vehicle serviced  
by your dealer/retailer.  
When this light is on, the TCS  
system does not limit wheel spin  
and/or the StabiliTrak system does  
not assist with vehicle control.  
Tire Pressure Light  
When the Traction Control system  
and/or StabiliTrak system are turned  
off, the light comes on.  
If the vehicle has a tire pressure  
monitoring system, the tire pressure  
light should come on briefly as  
the engine is started. If it does not,  
have the vehicle serviced by  
your dealer/retailer. It provides  
information about tire pressures and  
the Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System.  
When the Traction Control System  
and/or StabiliTrak system are  
turned on, the light turns off.  
Notice: Driving with the engine  
coolant temperature warning light  
on could cause the vehicle to  
overheat. See Engine Overheating  
on page 5-23. The vehicle’s  
engine could be damaged, and it  
might not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Never drive with  
the engine coolant temperature  
warning light on.  
on page 4-8 and StabiliTrak®  
System on page 4-7 for more  
information.  
When the Light is On Steady  
This indicates that one or more of  
the tires are significantly  
underinflated.  
A tire pressure message in the  
Driver Information Center (DIC), can  
accompany the light. See DIC  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-30  
Instrument Panel  
page 3-42 for more information.  
Stop and check the tires as soon as  
it is safe to do so. If underinflated,  
inflate to the proper pressure.  
See Tires on page 5-38 for more  
information.  
If the check engine light comes on  
and stays on, while the engine  
is running, this indicates that there  
is an OBD II problem and service  
is required.  
Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp  
Check Engine Light  
A computer system called OBD II  
(On-Board Diagnostics-Second  
Generation) monitors operation of  
the fuel, ignition, and emission  
control systems. It ensures  
that emissions are at acceptable  
levels for the life of the vehicle,  
helping to produce a cleaner  
environment.  
Malfunctions often are indicated by  
the system before any problem  
is apparent. Being aware of the light  
can prevent more serious damage  
to the vehicle. This system  
assists the service technician in  
correctly diagnosing any  
When the Light Flashes First and  
Then is On Steady  
This indicates that there could be a  
problem with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System. The light flashes  
for about a minute and stays  
malfunction.  
on steady for the remainder of the  
ignition cycle. This sequence  
repeats with every ignition cycle.  
on page 5-45 for more information.  
Notice: If the vehicle is  
continually driven with this light  
on, after a while, the emission  
controls might not work as well,  
the vehicle’s fuel economy  
might not be as good, and the  
engine might not run as  
smoothly. This could lead to  
costly repairs that might not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
This light comes on when the  
ignition is on, but the engine is not  
running, as a check to show it  
is working. If it does not, have the  
vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-31  
Notice: Modifications made to  
the engine, transmission, exhaust,  
intake, or fuel system of the  
vehicle or the replacement of the  
original tires with other than those  
of the same Tire Performance  
Criteria (TPC) can affect the  
vehicle’s emission controls and  
can cause this light to come on.  
Modifications to these systems  
could lead to costly repairs not  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
This could also result in a failure  
to pass a required Emission  
Inspection/Maintenance test. See  
page 5-3.  
The following can prevent more  
serious damage to the vehicle:  
An emission system malfunction  
might be corrected by:  
Reduce vehicle speed.  
Avoid hard accelerations.  
Avoid steep uphill grades.  
Make sure the fuel cap is fully  
installed. See Filling the Tank  
on page 5-7. The diagnostic  
system can determine if the fuel  
cap has been left off or  
If towing a trailer, reduce the  
amount of cargo being hauled  
as soon as it is possible.  
improperly installed. A loose or  
missing fuel cap allows fuel  
to evaporate into the atmosphere.  
A few driving trips with the cap  
properly installed should turn  
the light off.  
If the light continues to flash, when  
it is safe to do so, stop the  
vehicle. Find a safe place to park  
the vehicle. Turn the key off, wait at  
least 10 seconds, and restart the  
engine. If the light is still flashing,  
follow the previous steps and  
see your dealer/retailer for service  
as soon as possible.  
If the vehicle has been driven  
through a deep puddle of  
water, the vehicle’s electrical  
system might be wet. The  
condition is usually corrected  
when the electrical system dries  
out. A few driving trips should  
turn the light off.  
This light comes on during a  
malfunction in one of two ways:  
Light On Steady: An emission  
control system malfunction has been  
detected on the vehicle. Diagnosis  
and service might be required.  
Light Flashing: A misfire condition  
has been detected. A misfire  
increases vehicle emissions and  
could damage the emission control  
system on the vehicle. Diagnosis  
and service might be required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-32  
Instrument Panel  
Make sure to fuel the vehicle  
with quality fuel. Poor fuel  
quality causes the engine not to  
run as efficiently as designed  
and may cause: stalling  
after start-up, stalling when the  
vehicle is changed into gear,  
misfiring, hesitation on  
acceleration, or stumbling on  
acceleration. These conditions  
might go away once the engine is  
warmed up.  
Emissions Inspection and  
Maintenance Programs  
The vehicle will not pass this  
inspection if the OBD II  
(on-board diagnostic) system  
determines that critical emission  
control systems have not  
been completely diagnosed by  
the system. The vehicle would be  
considered not ready for  
inspection. This can happen if  
the battery has recently been  
replaced or if the battery has run  
down. The diagnostic system  
is designed to evaluate critical  
emission control systems  
during normal driving. This can  
take several days of routine  
driving. If this has been done and  
the vehicle still does not pass  
the inspection for lack of OBD II  
system readiness, your  
Some state/provincial and local  
governments have or might begin  
programs to inspect the emission  
control equipment on the vehicle.  
Failure to pass this inspection could  
prevent getting a vehicle  
registration.  
Here are some things to know to  
help the vehicle pass an inspection:  
If one or more of these conditions  
occurs, change the fuel brand  
used. It will require at least  
one full tank of the proper fuel to  
turn the light off.  
The vehicle will not pass this  
inspection if the check engine  
light is on with the engine  
running, or if the key is in  
ON/RUN and the light is not on.  
page 5-5.  
dealer/retailer can prepare the  
vehicle for inspection.  
If none of the above have made the  
light turn off, your dealer/retailer can  
check the vehicle. The dealer/retailer  
has the proper test equipment and  
diagnostic tools to fix any mechanical  
or electrical problems that might  
have developed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
Security Light  
3-33  
If the light comes on and stays on,  
it means that oil is not flowing  
through the engine properly. The  
vehicle could be low on oil and  
might have some other system  
problem.  
Oil Pressure Light  
{ CAUTION  
Do not keep driving if the oil  
pressure is low. The engine can  
become so hot that it catches fire.  
Someone could be burned. Check  
the oil as soon as possible and  
have the vehicle serviced.  
For information regarding this light  
and the vehicle’s security system,  
see PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer on page 2-12.  
Change Engine Oil Light  
Cruise Control Light  
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil  
maintenance can damage the  
engine. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always follow the maintenance  
schedule in this manual for  
changing engine oil.  
Change engine oil light means that  
service is required on the vehicle.  
on page 6-3 and Engine Oil on  
page 5-11 for more information.  
The cruise control light comes on  
whenever the cruise control is set.  
After the engine oil is changed the  
engine oil life system needs to  
be reset in order to turn off this light.  
page 5-14 for more information.  
The light goes out when the  
cruise control is turned off. See  
Cruise Control on page 3-9 for more  
information.  
The oil pressure light should come  
on briefly as the engine is started.  
If it does not come on have the  
vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-34  
Instrument Panel  
It takes a little more or less fuel  
to fill up than the fuel gage  
indicates.  
Highbeam On Light  
Fuel Gage  
The gage moves a little while  
turning a corner or accelerating.  
The gage takes a few seconds to  
stabilize after the ignition is  
turned on, and goes back  
to empty after the ignition is  
turned off.  
The highbeam on light comes on  
when the high-beam headlamps are  
in use.  
United States  
Canada  
When the ignition is on, the fuel  
gage shows about how much fuel is  
in the fuel tank.  
Changer on page 3-7 for more  
information.  
For the fuel tank capacity, see  
page 5-81.  
An arrow on the fuel gage indicates  
the side of the vehicle the fuel  
door is on.  
Low Washer Fluid  
Warning Light  
Low Fuel Warning Light  
When the indicator nears empty, the  
low fuel light comes on. There still  
is a little fuel left, but the fuel  
tank should be refueled soon. See  
page 3-34 for more information.  
The low fuel warning light, below  
the fuel gage, comes on briefly when  
the engine is started.  
Four things that can happen but do  
not mean the fuel gage is not  
functioning properly are:  
The low washer fluid warning light  
comes on when the windshield  
washer fluid is low. See Windshield  
Washer Fluid on page 5-24 for  
more information.  
At the service station, the fuel  
pump shuts off before the  
gage reads full.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-35  
This light also comes on when the  
fuel tank is low on fuel. When fuel is  
added, the light should go off. If it  
does not, have the vehicle serviced.  
If the hybrid battery or other hybrid  
components are very hot or cold, the  
CHARGE and ASSIST functions can  
be suspended until the component  
temperatures are normal.  
Charge/Assist Gage  
Auto Stop Mode  
Fuel Economy Light  
The CHARGE/ASSIST gage  
displays the charge into and out of  
the hybrid battery.  
The ECO light comes on when the  
vehicle is achieving fuel economy  
close to its rated performance.  
United States  
Canada  
When the gage indicates ASSIST,  
the electric motor is performing  
an automatic restart of the engine,  
or the electric motor is assisting  
for maximum acceleration.  
This mark on the tachometer  
signifies that the engine is in Auto  
Stop mode which is a fuel saving  
operation.  
Driving habits that improve  
fuel economy increases the time  
that the fuel economy light is on.  
When the vehicle is off, the  
When the gage indicates CHARGE,  
the electric motor operates as a  
generator to perform regenerative  
braking, while decelerating. See  
Regenerative Braking on page 2-23  
for more information.  
tachometer needle moves to OFF. If  
the driver’s door is opened while  
in Auto Stop, a chime sounds.  
To enable or disable the fuel  
economy light, while in park, press  
the Vehicle Info button on the  
DIC until PRESS V TO SET ECO is  
displayed. Then press the set/reset  
button to select off or on. For  
more information see Trip Odometer  
on page 3-24 and DIC Operation  
and Displays on page 3-36.  
The gage also indicates CHARGE  
when the system is recharging  
the hybrid battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-36  
Instrument Panel  
retailer. If an abnormal temperature  
reading is displayed for an  
extended period of time, consult  
your dealer/retailer. Under certain  
circumstances, especially when the  
engine is idling, a delay updating the  
temperature display is normal.  
The DIC also allows some features  
to be customized. See DIC Vehicle  
Customization on page 3-49 for more  
information.  
Driver Information  
Center (DIC)  
Your vehicle has a Driver  
Information Center (DIC).  
DIC Buttons  
All information appears in the DIC  
display located in the instrument  
panel cluster.  
See DIC Compass on page 3-40  
Operation on page 2-20 for more  
information.  
The DIC comes on when the  
ignition is on. After a short delay,  
the DIC displays the information that  
was last displayed before the  
engine was turned off.  
The buttons are the trip/fuel, vehicle  
information, customization, and  
set/reset buttons. The button  
functions are detailed in the  
following pages.  
DIC Operation and  
Displays  
The DIC has different displays  
which can be accessed by pressing  
the DIC buttons located on the  
instrument panel, below the  
headlamp switch.  
The DIC displays trip, fuel, and  
vehicle system information, and  
warning messages if a system  
problem is detected.  
3 (Trip/Fuel): Press this button  
to display the odometer, trip  
The DIC also displays the compass  
direction, outside air temperature,  
and shift position indicator at the top  
of the DIC display. If there is a  
problem with the system that controls  
the temperature display, the  
numbers will be replaced with  
dashes. If this occurs, have the  
vehicle serviced by your dealer/  
odometer, fuel range, average  
economy, and instantaneous  
economy. The compass and outside  
temperature will also be shown in  
the display. The temperature will be  
shown in °F or °C depending on  
the units selected.  
The DIC displays trip, fuel, and  
vehicle system information, and  
warning messages if a system  
problem is detected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-37  
The trip odometer can be reset to  
zero by pressing the set/reset button  
while the trip odometer is displayed.  
You can also reset the trip  
odometer while it is displayed by  
pressing and holding the trip  
odometer reset stem.  
Trip/Fuel Menu Items  
T (Vehicle Information): Press  
this button to display the oil life,  
units, tire pressure readings  
for vehicles with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS), Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter  
programming, economy light on/off,  
compass zone setting, and  
3 (Trip/Fuel): Press this button  
to scroll through the following  
menu items:  
Odometer  
Press the trip/fuel button until  
ODOMETER displays. This display  
shows the distance the vehicle  
has been driven in either miles (mi)  
or kilometers (km). Pressing the  
trip odometer reset stem will  
also display the odometer.  
Fuel Range  
compass recalibration on vehicles  
with this feature.  
Press the trip/fuel button until  
FUEL RANGE displays. This  
display shows the approximate  
number of remaining miles (mi) or  
kilometers (km) the vehicle can be  
driven without refueling. The display  
will show LOW if the fuel level is low.  
U (Customization): Press this  
button to customize the feature  
settings on your vehicle. See DIC  
Vehicle Customization on page 3-49  
for more information.  
To switch between English and  
metric measurements, see “Units”  
later in this section.  
The fuel range estimate is based on  
an average of the vehicle’s fuel  
economy over recent driving history  
and the amount of fuel remaining  
in the fuel tank. This estimate  
will change if driving conditions  
change. For example, if driving in  
traffic and making frequent  
stops, this display may read one  
number, but if the vehicle is driven  
on a freeway, the number may  
change even though the same  
V (Set/Reset): Press this button to  
set or reset certain functions and  
to turn off or acknowledge  
Trip Odometer  
Press the trip/fuel button until TRIP  
displays. This display shows the  
current distance traveled in  
either miles (mi) or kilometers (km)  
since the last reset for the trip  
odometer. Pressing the trip  
messages on the DIC.  
odometer reset stem will also  
display the trip odometer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-38  
Instrument Panel  
amount of fuel is in the fuel tank.  
This is because different driving  
conditions produce different  
fuel economies. Generally, freeway  
driving produces better fuel  
economy than city driving. Fuel  
range cannot be reset.  
Instantaneous Fuel Economy  
Vehicle Information Menu  
Items  
If the vehicle has this display, press  
the trip/fuel button until INSTANT  
FUEL ECONOMY displays.  
This display shows the current fuel  
economy at a particular moment  
and will change frequently as driving  
conditions change. This display  
shows the instantaneous fuel  
economy in miles per gallon (mpg)  
or liters per 100 kilometers  
T (Vehicle Information): Press  
this button to scroll through the  
following menu items:  
Oil Life  
If the vehicle is low on fuel, the  
FUEL LEVEL LOW message will be  
displayed. See “FUEL LEVEL  
LOW” under DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 3-42.  
Press the vehicle information button  
until OIL LIFE REMAINING  
displays. This display shows an  
estimate of the oil’s remaining useful  
life. If you see 99% OIL LIFE  
REMAINING on the display, that  
means 99% of the current oil  
life remains. The engine oil life  
system will alert you to change the  
oil on a schedule consistent with  
your driving conditions.  
(L/100 km). Unlike average fuel  
economy, this display cannot  
be reset.  
Average Fuel Economy  
Press the trip/fuel button until  
AVERAGE FUEL ECONOMY  
displays. This display shows the  
approximate average miles per  
gallon (mpg) or liters per  
Blank Display  
This display shows no information.  
100 kilometers (L/100 km). This  
number is calculated based on the  
number of mpg (L/100 km)  
recorded since the last time this  
menu item was reset. To reset the  
AVERAGE FUEL ECONOMY,  
press and hold the set/reset button.  
The display will show zero.  
When the remaining oil life is low,  
the CHANGE ENGINE OIL  
SOON message will appear on the  
display. See “CHANGE ENGINE  
OIL SOON” under DIC Warnings  
and Messages on page 3-42.  
You should change the oil as soon  
as you can. See Engine Oil on  
page 5-11. In addition to the engine  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-39  
oil life system monitoring the  
oil life, additional maintenance is  
recommended in the Maintenance  
Schedule in this manual. See  
for more information.  
FRONT TIRES PSI (kPa) LEFT ##  
RIGHT ##. Press the vehicle  
information button again until the  
DIC displays REAR TIRES PSI  
(kPa) LEFT ## RIGHT ##.  
Relearn Remote Key  
This display allows you to match  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitters to your vehicle. To  
match an RKE transmitter to your  
vehicle:  
If a low or high tire pressure  
condition is detected by the system  
while driving, a message advising  
you to check the pressure in a  
specific tire will appear in the  
on page 5-43 and DIC Warnings  
and Messages on page 3-42  
for more information.  
Units  
1. Press the vehicle information  
button until PRESS V TO  
RELEARN REMOTE KEY  
displays.  
Press the vehicle information button  
until UNITS displays. This display  
allows you to select between English  
or Metric units of measurement.  
Once in this display, press the  
set/reset button to select between  
ENGLISH or METRIC units. All  
of the vehicle information will then  
be displayed in the unit of  
2. Press the set/reset button until  
REMOTE KEY LEARNING  
ACTIVE is displayed.  
3. Press and hold the lock and  
unlock buttons on the first  
transmitter at the same time for  
about 15 seconds.  
If the tire pressure display shows  
dashes instead of a value, there  
may be a problem with your vehicle.  
If this consistently occurs, see  
your dealer/retailer for service.  
measurement selected.  
Tire Pressure  
A chime will sound indicating  
that the transmitter is matched  
and REMOTE KEY LEARNING  
COMPLETE will be shown  
on the display.  
If your vehicle has the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS), the  
pressure for each tire can be viewed  
in the DIC. The tire pressure will  
be shown in either pounds per  
square inch (psi) or kilopascals  
(kPa). Press the vehicle information  
button until the DIC displays  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-40  
Instrument Panel  
4. To match additional transmitters  
at this time, repeat Step 3.  
be available when the vehicle is in  
P (Park). Once in the display,  
press the set/reset button to select  
ON or OFF.  
Compass variance is the difference  
between the earth’s magnetic  
north and true geographic north. If  
the compass is not set to the  
zone where you live, the compass  
may give false readings. The  
compass must be set to the variance  
zone in which the vehicle is  
traveling.  
Each vehicle can have a  
maximum of eight transmitters  
matched to it.  
Blank Display  
5. To exit the programming mode,  
you must cycle the key to  
LOCK/OFF.  
This display shows no information.  
DIC Compass  
Your vehicle may have a  
compass in the Driver Information  
Center (DIC).  
Compass Zone Setting  
To adjust for compass variance, use  
the following procedure:  
This display allows for setting the  
compass zone. See DIC Compass  
on page 3-40 for more information.  
Compass Variance (Zone)  
Procedure  
Compass Zone  
Compass Recalibration  
The zone is set to zone eight upon  
leaving the factory. Your dealer/  
retailer will set the correct zone for  
your location.  
1. Do not set the compass zone  
when the vehicle is moving.  
Only set it when the vehicle is in  
P (Park).  
This display allows for calibrating  
the compass. See DIC Compass on  
page 3-40 for more information.  
Under certain circumstances, such  
as during a long distance  
Press the vehicle information  
button until PRESS V TO SET  
COMPASS ZONE: ## displays.  
ECO (Economy) Light On/Off  
This display allows you to turn the  
ECO light in the cluster on and  
on page 3-35 for more information.  
Press the vehicle information  
button until PRESS V SET ECO  
displays. This display will only  
cross-country trip or moving to a  
new state or province, it will  
be necessary to compensate for  
compass variance by resetting the  
zone through the DIC if the zone  
is not set correctly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-41  
5. If calibration is necessary,  
calibrate the compass. See  
“Compass Calibration Procedure”  
following.  
antenna mount, a magnetic  
emergency light, magnetic note pad  
holder, or any other magnetic  
item. Turn off the vehicle, move the  
magnetic item, then turn on the  
vehicle and calibrate the compass.  
Compass Calibration  
The compass can be manually  
calibrated. Only calibrate the  
compass in a magnetically clean  
and safe location, such as an open  
parking lot, where driving the  
vehicle in circles is not a danger. It  
is suggested to calibrate away  
from tall buildings, utility wires,  
manhole covers, or other industrial  
structures, if possible.  
To calibrate the compass, use  
the following procedure:  
Compass Calibration Procedure  
1. Before calibrating the compass,  
make sure the compass is set  
to the variance zone in which the  
vehicle is located. See  
2. Find the vehicle’s current  
location and variance zone  
number on the map.  
Zones 1 through 15 are  
available.  
“Compass Variance (Zone)  
Procedure” earlier in this section.  
If CAL should ever appear in the  
DIC display, the compass should be  
calibrated.  
3. Press and hold the set/reset  
button to scroll through and  
select the appropriate  
variance zone.  
Do not operate any switches  
such as window, sunroof, climate  
controls, seats, etc. during the  
calibration procedure.  
If the DIC display does not show a  
heading, for example, N for  
4. Press the trip/fuel button until the  
vehicle heading, for example,  
N for North, is displayed in  
the DIC.  
2. Press the vehicle information  
North, or the heading does not  
change after making turns, there  
may be a strong magnetic field  
interfering with the compass. Such  
interference may be caused by  
a magnetic CB or cell phone  
button until PRESS V TO  
CALIBRATE COMPAS  
(Compass) displays.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-42  
Instrument Panel  
3. Press the set/reset button to start  
the compass calibration.  
instrument panel cluster to  
acknowledge that you received the  
messages and to clear them  
from the display.  
accessories. If the vehicle is not  
running, start and run the engine for  
at least 10 minutes to allow the  
battery to recharge. If the engine is  
running and the condition persists,  
see your dealer/retailer immediately.  
4. The DIC will display  
CALIBRATING COMPASS:  
TURN IN CIRCLES. Drive the  
vehicle in tight circles at less than  
5 mph (8 km/h) to complete the  
calibration. The DIC will display  
COMPASS CALIBRATION  
COMPLETE for a few seconds  
when the calibration is complete.  
The DIC display will then return to  
the previous menu.  
Some messages cannot be cleared  
from the DIC display because they  
are more urgent. These messages  
require action before they can be  
cleared. Take any messages that  
appear on the display seriously and  
remember that clearing the  
messages will only make the  
messages disappear, not correct the  
problem.  
CALIBRATING COMPASS:  
TURN IN CIRCLES  
This message displays when  
calibrating the compass. Drive the  
vehicle in circles at less than  
5 mph (8 km/h) to complete the  
calibration. See DIC Compass on  
page 3-40.  
DIC Warnings and  
Messages  
The following are the possible  
messages that can be displayed  
and some information about them.  
CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON  
Messages are displayed on the DIC  
to notify the driver that the status  
of the vehicle has changed and that  
some action may be needed by  
the driver to correct the condition.  
Multiple messages may appear one  
after another.  
This message displays when service  
is required for the vehicle. See  
your dealer/retailer. See Engine Oil  
on page 5-11 and Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 6-3 for more  
information.  
BATTERY SAVER ACTIVE  
This message displays when  
the charging system detects that the  
battery is being drained. You may  
notice that the vehicle attempts  
to reduce the drain for you by  
turning off accessories, such as  
interior fans, rear defogger,  
Some messages may not require  
immediate action, but you can press  
any of the DIC buttons, or the trip  
odometer reset stem on the  
and heated seats. Turn off all  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-43  
Acknowledging this message will  
not reset the OIL LIFE REMAINING  
display. That must be done at  
the OIL LIFE screen. See “OIL LIFE”  
on page 3-36 and Engine Oil  
Life System on page 5-14 for more  
information.  
low, the low tire pressure warning  
light comes on. See Tire Pressure  
Light on page 3-29.  
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS), this  
message displays when the  
COMPASS CALIBRATION  
COMPLETE  
pressure in one or more of the  
vehicle’s tires needs to be checked.  
This message also displays LEFT  
FRONT, RIGHT FRONT, LEFT  
REAR, or RIGHT REAR to indicate  
which tire needs to be checked.  
You can receive more than one tire  
pressure message at a time. To  
read the other messages that may  
have been sent at the same  
time, press the set/reset button. If a  
tire pressure message appears  
on the DIC, stop as soon as  
you can. Have the tire pressures  
checked and set to those shown on  
the Tire Loading Information  
This message displays when the  
compass calibration is complete.  
See DIC Compass on page 3-40.  
CHANGE TRANSMISSION  
FLUID  
CRUISE CONTROL SET  
TO XXX  
Notice: Use of the incorrect  
automatic transmission fluid may  
damage the vehicle, and the  
damages may not be covered by  
the vehicle’s warranty. Always  
use the automatic transmission  
fluid listed in Recommended  
This message displays whenever  
the cruise control is set. See Cruise  
Control on page 3-9 for more  
information.  
DRIVER DOOR OPEN  
This message displays when the  
driver door is not closed properly.  
Close the door completely.  
page 6-11.  
label. See Tires on page 5-38,  
Loading the Vehicle on page 4-18,  
page 5-43. The DIC also shows the  
tire pressure values. See DIC  
This message displays when the life  
of the transmission fluid has  
expired and it should be changed.  
on page 6-3 and Recommended  
Fluids and Lubricants on page 6-11  
for the proper fluid and change  
intervals.  
page 3-36. If the tire pressure is  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-44  
Instrument Panel  
and/or DIC, stop the vehicle as  
soon as possible. Do not increase  
the engine speed above normal  
idling speed. See Engine  
Overheating on page 5-23 for  
more information.  
turn the engine off immediately to  
avoid severe engine damage.  
page 5-23.  
ENGINE HOT A/C  
(Air Conditioning) OFF  
This message displays when the  
engine coolant becomes hotter than  
the normal operating temperature.  
To avoid added strain on a hot  
engine, the air conditioning  
compressor is automatically turned  
off. When the coolant temperature  
returns to normal, the A/C operation  
automatically resumes. You can  
continue to drive your vehicle.  
ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED  
This message displays when the  
vehicle’s engine power is reduced.  
Reduced engine power can affect the  
vehicle’s ability to accelerate. If this  
message is on, but there is no  
reduction in performance, proceed to  
your destination. The performance  
may be reduced the next time the  
vehicle is driven. The vehicle may be  
driven at a reduced speed while this  
message is on, but acceleration and  
speed may be reduced. Anytime this  
message stays on, the vehicle  
should be taken to your dealer/  
retailer for service as soon as  
This message displays when the  
engine coolant temperature is  
too hot. Stop and allow the vehicle  
to idle until it cools down.  
ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP  
ENGINE  
ENGINE OIL LOW: ADD OIL  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle  
while the engine is overheating,  
severe engine damage may occur.  
If an overheat warning appears  
on the instrument panel cluster  
and/or DIC, stop the vehicle  
as soon as possible. See Engine  
Overheating on page 5-23 for  
more information.  
Your vehicle may have an engine oil  
level sensor. If it does, this  
message displays when the oil is  
low. See Engine Oil on page 5-11  
for more information.  
ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLE  
ENGINE  
possible.  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle  
while the engine is overheating,  
severe engine damage may occur.  
If an overheat warning appears  
on the instrument panel cluster  
This message displays along with a  
continuous chime when the  
engine has overheated. Stop and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-45  
FUEL LEVEL LOW  
OIL PRESSURE LOW STOP  
ENGINE  
PASSENGER DOOR OPEN  
This message displays when your  
vehicle is low on fuel. Refill the  
fuel tank as soon as possible. See  
Fuel Gage on page 3-34 and  
Filling the Tank on page 5-7 for  
more information.  
This message displays when one or  
more of the passenger doors are  
not closed properly. Close the doors  
completely.  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle  
while the engine oil pressure  
is low, severe engine damage  
may occur. If a low oil pressure  
warning appears on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC), stop the  
vehicle as soon as possible.  
Do not drive the vehicle until the  
cause of the low oil pressure  
is corrected. See Engine Oil on  
page 5-11 for more information.  
REMOTE KEY LEARNING  
ACTIVE  
HOOD OPEN  
This message displays while  
This message displays on some  
vehicles when the hood is not closed  
properly. Close the hood completely.  
See Hood Release on page 5-9.  
matching a Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter to your vehicle.  
See “MATCHING TRANSMITTERS  
TO YOUR VEHICLE” under  
System Operation on page 2-4 and  
page 3-36 for more information.  
This message displays when  
the vehicle’s engine oil pressure is  
low. The oil pressure light also  
appears on the instrument panel  
on page 3-33.  
ICE POSSIBLE DRIVE  
WITH CARE  
This message displays when the  
outside air temperature is cold  
enough to create icy road  
conditions. Adjust your driving  
accordingly.  
Stop the vehicle immediately, as  
engine damage can result from  
driving a vehicle with low oil  
pressure. Have the vehicle serviced  
by your dealer/retailer as soon as  
possible when this message is  
displayed.  
LIFTGATE OPEN  
This message displays when the  
liftgate is not closed completely.  
Close the liftgate completely. See  
Liftgate on page 2-8.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-46  
Instrument Panel  
REMOTE KEY LEARNING  
COMPLETE  
SERVICE A/C  
(Air Conditioning) SYSTEM  
SERVICE HILL START ASSIST  
This message displays if there is  
a problem with the hill start  
assist function. Have your vehicle  
serviced by your dealer/retailer.  
This message displays while  
This message displays when there  
is a problem detected in the air  
conditioning system. Have the  
vehicle serviced by your  
matching a Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter to your vehicle.  
See “MATCHING TRANSMITTERS  
TO YOUR VEHICLE” under  
SERVICE HYBRID SYSTEM  
dealer/retailer.  
System Operation on page 2-4 and  
page 3-36 for more information.  
This message displays if the hybrid  
components need to be serviced.  
Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer.  
SERVICE AIR BAG  
This message displays when there  
is a problem with the airbag  
system. Have your vehicle serviced  
by your dealer/retailer immediately.  
page 3-25 for more information.  
REPLACE REMOTE KEY FOB  
BATTERY  
SERVICE POWER STEERING  
This message displays if there  
has been a problem detected with  
the power steering. See Steering on  
page 4-9 for more information.  
This message displays if a Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter  
battery is low. The battery needs to  
be replaced in the transmitter.  
See “Battery Replacement” under  
SERVICE BRAKE SYSTEM  
This message displays along with  
the brake system warning light  
if there is a problem with the brake  
system or when the brake fluid  
level is low. See Brake System  
Warning Light on page 3-27. Have  
the brake system serviced by  
your dealer/retailer as soon as  
possible.  
System Operation on page 2-4.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-47  
(TCS) on page 4-8 for more  
SERVICE STABILITRAK  
SERVICE TIRE MONITORING  
SYSTEM  
information. Have the TCS serviced  
by your dealer/retailer as soon  
as possible.  
This message displays if there has  
been a problem detected with  
StabiliTrak®. A warning light also  
appears on the instrument  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS), this  
message displays if a part on the  
TPMS is not working properly.  
The tire pressure light also flashes  
and then remains on during the  
same ignition cycle. See Tire  
Pressure Light on page 3-29.  
Several conditions may cause this  
message to appear. See Tire  
page 5-46 for more information. If  
the warning comes on and stays on,  
there may be a problem with the  
TPMS. See your dealer/retailer.  
SERVICE TRANSMISSION  
panel cluster. See StabiliTrak®/  
Warning Light on page 3-28. See  
StabiliTrak® System on page 4-7 for  
more information.  
This message displays when there  
is a problem with the transmission.  
See your dealer/retailer for  
service.  
SERVICE VEHICLE SOON  
If this message turns on while you  
are driving, pull off the road as soon  
as possible and stop carefully.  
Try resetting the system by turning  
the ignition off and then back  
on. If this message still stays on or  
turns back on again while you  
are driving, your vehicle needs  
service. Have the system inspected  
by your dealer/retailer as soon  
as possible.  
This message displays when  
a non-emissions related malfunction  
occurs. Have the vehicle serviced  
by your dealer/retailer as soon  
as possible.  
SPEED LIMITED TO  
XXX MPH (KM/H)  
SERVICE TRACTION  
CONTROL  
This message displays when your  
vehicle speed is limited to 80 mph  
(128 km/h) because the vehicle  
detects a problem in the speed  
variable assist steering system.  
Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer.  
This message displays when the  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
is not functioning properly. A  
warning light also appears on the  
instrument panel cluster. See  
StabiliTrak®/Traction Control System  
(TCS) Warning Light on page 3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-48  
Instrument Panel  
off-road conditions and require more  
wheel spin. See If Your Vehicle is  
page 4-17. To turn the StabiliTrak  
system on or off, see StabiliTrak®  
System on page 4-7.  
STABILITRAK NOT READY  
TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE  
If your vehicle has StabiliTrak, this  
message may display and the  
StabiliTrak indicator light on the  
instrument panel cluster may be on  
after first driving the vehicle and  
exceeding 20 mph (32 km/h)  
for 30 seconds. The StabiliTrak  
system is not functional until the light  
has turned off. See StabiliTrak®  
System on page 4-7 for more  
information.  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS), this  
message displays when the TPMS  
is re-learning the tire positions  
on your vehicle. The tire positions  
must be re-learned after rotating the  
tires or after replacing a tire or  
sensor. See Tire Inspection  
and Rotation on page 5-50, Tire  
page 5-45, and Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 5-43 for more  
information.  
TIGHTEN GAS CAP  
This message may display along  
with the check engine light on  
the instrument panel cluster if the  
vehicle’s fuel cap is not tightened  
Lamp on page 3-30. Reinstall  
the fuel cap fully. See Filling the  
Tank on page 5-7. The diagnostic  
system can determine if the fuel cap  
has been left off or improperly  
installed. A loose or missing fuel  
cap allows fuel to evaporate into the  
atmosphere. A few driving trips  
with the cap properly installed  
should turn this light and  
STABILITRAK OFF  
If your vehicle has StabiliTrak, this  
message displays when you  
turn off the StabiliTrak, or when the  
stability control has been  
automatically disabled. To limit  
wheel spin and realize the full  
benefits of the stability enhancement  
system, you should normally  
leave StabiliTrak on. However, you  
should turn StabiliTrak off if your  
vehicle gets stuck in sand, mud, ice,  
or snow and you want to rock  
your vehicle to attempt to free it, or  
if you are driving in extreme  
TRACTION CONTROL OFF  
This message displays when  
the Traction Control System (TCS)  
turns off. See Traction Control  
System (TCS) on page 4-8 for more  
information.  
This message only displays while  
the ignition is in ON/RUN and  
disappears after 10 seconds, unless  
it is acknowledged or an urgent  
warning appears.  
message off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-49  
Any of the following conditions may  
cause the TCS to turn off:  
Do not drive your vehicle with  
overheated transmission fluid or  
while the transmission  
DIC Vehicle  
Customization  
Your vehicle may have customization  
capabilities that allow you to program  
certain features to one preferred  
setting. Customization features can  
only be programmed to one setting  
on the vehicle and cannot be  
The TCS is turned off by pressing  
the TCS/StabiliTrak button. See  
StabiliTrak® System on  
temperature warning is displayed.  
This message displays along with  
a chime if the transmission fluid  
in the vehicle gets hot. Driving with  
the transmission fluid temperature  
high can cause damage to the  
vehicle. Stop the vehicle and let it  
idle to allow the transmission to cool.  
This message clears and the  
page 4-7 for more information.  
The battery is low.  
There is a TCS failure. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
programmed to a preferred setting  
for two different drivers.  
TRACTION CONTROL ON  
All of the customization options may  
not be available on your vehicle.  
Only the options available will  
be displayed on the DIC.  
This message displays when the  
Traction Control System (TCS) turns  
on. See StabiliTrak® System on  
page 4-7 for more information.  
chime stops when the fluid  
temperature reaches a safe level.  
TURN SIGNAL ON  
The default settings for the  
This message displays and a chime  
sounds as a reminder to turn off  
the turn signal if you drive your  
vehicle for more than about 3/4 mile  
(1.2 km) with a turn signal on.  
on page 3-6 for more information.  
customization features were set  
when your vehicle left the factory,  
but may have been changed  
from their default state since then.  
TRANSMISSION HOT IDLE  
ENGINE  
Notice: If you drive your vehicle  
while the transmission fluid is  
overheating and the transmission  
temperature warning is displayed  
on the instrument panel cluster  
and/or DIC, you can damage  
The customization preferences  
are automatically recalled.  
the transmission. This could lead  
to costly repairs that would  
not be covered by your warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-50  
Instrument Panel  
To change customization  
preferences, use the following  
procedure.  
Press the customization button until  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
the PRESS V TO DISPLAY IN  
ENGLISH screen appears on the  
DIC display. Press the set/reset  
button once to display all DIC  
messages in English.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
Entering the Feature  
Settings Menu  
1. Turn the ignition on and place  
the vehicle in P (Park).  
DISPLAY LANGUAGE  
AUTO DOOR LOCK  
To avoid excessive drain on the  
battery, it is recommended that  
the headlamps are turned off.  
This feature allows you to select the  
language in which the DIC  
messages will appear.  
This feature allows you to select  
when the vehicle’s doors will  
automatically lock. See Automatic  
Door Lock on page 2-7 for more  
information.  
2. Press the customization button to  
scroll through the available  
customizable options.  
Press the customization button until  
the PRESS V TO SET DISPLAY  
LANGUAGE screen appears on the  
DIC display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings  
for this feature. Then press the  
customization button to scroll  
Press the customization button until  
PRESS V TO SET AUTO DOOR  
LOCK appears on the DIC display.  
Press the set/reset button once  
to access the settings for this  
feature. Then press the  
Feature Settings Menu Items  
The following are customization  
features that allow you to program  
settings to the vehicle:  
through the following settings:  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
DISPLAY IN ENGLISH  
ENGLISH (default): All messages  
will appear in English.  
This feature will only display if a  
language other than English  
has been set. This feature allows  
you to change the language in which  
the DIC messages appear to  
English.  
SHIFT OUT OF PARK (default):  
The doors will automatically  
lock when the vehicle is shifted out  
of P (Park).  
FRANCAIS: All messages will  
appear in French.  
ESPANOL: All messages will  
appear in Spanish.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-51  
AT VEHICLE SPEED: The doors  
will automatically lock when the  
vehicle speed is above 8 mph  
(13 km/h) for three seconds.  
Press the customization button until  
ALL DOORS IN PARK (default):  
All of the doors will unlock when the  
vehicle is shifted into P (Park).  
PRESS V TO SET AUTO DOOR  
UNLOCK appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for  
this feature. Then press the  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
OFF: None of the doors will  
automatically unlock.  
REMOTE DOOR LOCK  
DRIVER DOOR AT KEY OUT: Only  
the driver’s door will unlock when  
the key is taken out of the ignition.  
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK  
This feature allows you to select the  
type of feedback you will receive  
when locking the vehicle with  
the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter. You will not receive  
feedback when locking the vehicle  
with the RKE transmitter if the doors  
are open. See Remote Keyless  
page 2-4 for more information.  
This feature allows you to select  
whether or not to turn off the  
automatic door unlocking feature. It  
also allows you to select which  
doors and when the doors will  
automatically unlock. See Automatic  
Door Unlock on page 2-7 for  
more information.  
DRIVER DOOR IN PARK: Only  
the driver’s door will unlock  
when the vehicle is shifted into  
P (Park).  
ALL DOORS AT KEY OUT: All of  
the doors will unlock when the  
key is taken out of the ignition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-52  
Instrument Panel  
Press the customization button until  
VERIFICATION HORN & LIGHTS  
(default): The exterior lamps  
will flash when you press the lock  
button on the RKE transmitter,  
and the horn will sound when the  
lock button is pressed again  
within five seconds of the previous  
command.  
Operation on page 2-4 for more  
information.  
PRESS V TO SET REMOTE  
DOOR LOCK appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings  
for this feature. Then press the  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
Press the customization button until  
PRESS V TO SET REMOTE  
DOOR UNLOCK appears on the  
DIC display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings  
for this feature. Then press the  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
VERIFICATION NO CHANGE: No  
change will be made to this  
feature. The current setting will  
remain.  
VERIFICATION OFF: There will be  
no feedback when you press the  
lock button on the RKE transmitter.  
VERIF LIGHTS OFF: The exterior  
lamps will not flash when you  
press the unlock button on the RKE  
transmitter.  
VERIFICATION LIGHTS ONLY:  
The exterior lamps will flash  
when you press the lock button on  
the RKE transmitter.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
REMOTE DOOR UNLOCK  
VERIF LIGHTS ON (default): The  
exterior lamps will flash when  
you press the unlock button on the  
RKE transmitter.  
VERIFICATION HORN ONLY: The  
horn will sound on the second  
press of the lock button on the RKE  
transmitter.  
This feature allows you to select the  
type of feedback you will receive  
when unlocking the vehicle with the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter. You will not receive  
feedback when unlocking the vehicle  
with the RKE transmitter if the  
doors are open. See Remote  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-53  
VERIF NO CHANGE: No change  
will be made to this feature.  
The current setting will remain.  
Press the customization button until  
PRESS V TO SET DELAY  
EXIT LIGHTING  
This feature allows you to select the  
amount of time you want the exterior  
lamps to remain on when it is dark  
enough outside. This happens after  
the key is turned from ON/RUN to  
LOCK/OFF.  
DOOR LOCK appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset  
button once to access the settings  
for this feature. Then press the  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
DELAY DOOR LOCK  
Press the customization button until  
On vehicles with a crew cab, this  
feature allows you to select whether  
or not the locking of the vehicle’s  
doors will be delayed. When locking  
the doors with the power door  
lock switch and a door is open, this  
feature will delay locking the  
OFF: There will be no delayed  
locking of the vehicle’s doors.  
PRESS V TO SET EXIT LIGHTING  
appears on the DIC display.  
Press the set/reset button once to  
access the settings for this feature.  
Then press the customization  
button to scroll through the following  
settings:  
ON (default): The doors will not  
lock until five seconds after the last  
door is closed.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
doors until five seconds after the  
last door is closed. You will  
OFF: The exterior lamps will not  
turn on.  
hear three chimes to signal that the  
delayed locking feature is in use.  
The key must be out of the ignition  
for this feature to work. You can  
temporarily override delayed locking  
by pressing the power door lock  
switch twice or the lock button  
on the RKE transmitter twice. See  
Delayed Locking on page 2-6  
for more information.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
10 SECONDS (default): The  
exterior lamps will stay on for  
10 seconds.  
30 SECONDS: The exterior lamps  
will stay on for 30 seconds.  
2 MINUTES: The exterior lamps will  
stay on for two minutes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-54  
Instrument Panel  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
ON (default): If it is dark enough  
outside, the exterior lights will  
turn on briefly when you unlock the  
vehicle with the RKE transmitter.  
CHIME VOLUME  
This feature allows you to select the  
volume level of the chime.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
Press the customization button until  
The lights will remain on for  
20 seconds or until the lock button  
on the RKE transmitter is pressed,  
or the vehicle is no longer off.  
System Operation on page 2-4  
for more information.  
PRESS V TO SET CHIME  
VOLUME appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for  
this feature. Then press the  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
APPROACH LIGHTING  
This feature allows you to select  
whether or not to have the exterior  
lights turn on briefly during low  
light periods after unlocking  
the vehicle using the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
NORMAL: The chime volume will  
be set to a normal level.  
Press the customization button until  
LOUD: The chime volume will be  
set to a loud level.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
PRESS V TO SET APPROACH  
LIGHTING appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for  
this feature. Then press the  
NO CHANGE: No change will be  
made to this feature. The current  
setting will remain.  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
There is no default for chime  
volume. The volume will stay at the  
last known setting.  
OFF: The exterior lights will not  
turn on when you unlock the vehicle  
with the RKE transmitter.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-55  
FACTORY SETTINGS  
EXIT FEATURE SETTINGS  
Exiting the Feature  
Settings Menu  
This feature allows you to set all of  
the customization features back  
to their factory default settings.  
This feature allows you to exit the  
feature settings menu.  
The feature settings menu will be  
exited when any of the following  
occurs:  
Press the customization button until  
Press the customization button until  
PRESS V TO RESTORE  
PRESS V TO EXIT FEATURE  
SETTINGS appears in the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset button  
once to exit the menu.  
The vehicle is no longer in  
ON/RUN.  
FACTORY SET appears on the DIC  
display. Press the set/reset button  
once to access the settings for  
this feature. Then press the  
customization button to scroll  
through the following settings:  
The trip/fuel or vehicle  
information DIC buttons are  
pressed.  
If you do not exit, pressing the  
customization button again will return  
you to the beginning of the feature  
settings menu.  
The end of the feature settings  
menu is reached and exited.  
RESTORE ALL (default): The  
customization features will be set to  
their factory default settings.  
A 40 second time period has  
elapsed with no selection made.  
DO NOT RESTORE: The  
customization features will not be  
set to their factory default settings.  
To select a setting, press the  
set/reset button while the desired  
setting is displayed on the DIC.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-56  
Instrument Panel  
For more information, see Defensive  
Driving on page 4-3.  
The vehicle has Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP). With RAP, the  
audio system can be played even  
after the ignition is turned off.  
(RAP) on page 2-15 for more  
information.  
Audio System(s)  
Determine which radio the vehicle  
has and read the following pages to  
become familiar with its features.  
Notice: Contact your  
dealer/retailer before adding any  
equipment.  
Adding audio or communication  
equipment could interfere  
with the operation of the vehicle’s  
engine, radio, or other systems,  
and could damage them.  
Follow federal rules covering  
mobile radio and telephone  
equipment.  
{ CAUTION  
Setting the Clock  
Taking your eyes off the road  
for extended periods could cause  
a crash resulting in injury or  
death to you or others. Do not  
give extended attention to  
Radio with Single CD (MP3)  
Player  
To set the time and date:  
entertainment tasks while driving.  
1. Turn the ignition key to  
Notice: The chime signals  
related to safety belts, parking  
brake, and other functions of your  
vehicle operate through the  
radio/entertainment system. If  
that equipment is replaced  
or additional equipment is added  
to your vehicle, the chimes  
may not work. Make sure that  
replacement or additional  
ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN.  
Press O to turn the radio on.  
This system provides access to  
many audio and non audio listings.  
2. Press H and the HR, MIN, MM,  
DD, YYYY (hour, minute, month,  
day, and year) displays.  
To minimize taking your eyes off  
the road while driving, do the  
following while the vehicle is parked:  
3. Press the softkey located below  
any one of the tabs that you  
want to change.  
Become familiar with the  
operation and controls of  
the audio system.  
equipment is compatible with  
your vehicle before installing it.  
Set up the tone, speaker  
adjustments, and preset radio  
stations.  
Modifications on page 5-3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-57  
4. To increase the time or date do  
one of the following:  
To change the time default setting  
from 12 hour to 24 hour or to  
change the date default setting from  
month/day/year to day/month/year:  
3. Press the softkey below the H  
tab. The HR, MIN, MM, DD,  
YYYY displays.  
Press the softkey located  
below the selected tab.  
4. Press the softkey below any one  
of the tabs you want to change.  
1. Press H and then the softkey  
located below the forward  
Press ¨SEEK, or \ FWD.  
Turn f clockwise.  
5. To increase the time or date do  
one of the following:  
arrow label. Once the time 12H  
and 24H, and the date  
MM/DD/YYYY (month, day, and  
year) and DD/MM/YYYY (day,  
month, and year) displays.  
5. To decrease the time or date do  
one of the following:  
Press the softkey located  
below the selected tab.  
Press ©SEEK or s REV.  
Turn f counterclockwise.  
Press ¨SEEK, or \ FWD.  
Turn f clockwise.  
2. Press the softkey located below  
the desired option.  
The date does not automatically  
display. To see the date press  
H while the radio is on. The date  
with display times out after a  
few seconds and goes back to the  
normal radio and time display.  
6. To decrease the time or date do  
one of the following:  
3. Press H again to apply the  
selected default, or let the screen  
time out.  
Press ©SEEK or s REV.  
Turn f counterclockwise.  
Six-Disc CD (MP3) Player  
The date does not automatically  
display. To see the date press  
MENU and then softkey below the  
H tab while the radio is on. The  
date with display times out after a  
few seconds and goes back to  
the normal radio and time display.  
To set the time and date:  
1. Turn the ignition key to  
ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN.  
Press O to turn the radio on.  
2. Press MENU.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-58  
Instrument Panel  
To change the time default setting  
from 12 hour to 24 hour or to  
Radio(s)  
change the date default setting from  
month/day/year to day/month/year:  
1. Press MENU, and then the  
softkey below the H tab.  
The HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY  
displays.  
2. Press the softkey below the  
forward arrow tab. The time  
12H and 24H, and the date  
MM/DD/YYYY (month, day, and  
year) and DD/MM/YYYY (day,  
month, and year) displays.  
3. Press the softkey located below  
the desired option.  
4. Press MENU again to apply the  
selected default, or let the  
screen time out.  
Radio with CD shown, Radio with Six-Disc CD similar  
Radio Data System (RDS)  
from these stations and only works  
when the information is available.  
While the radio is tuned to an  
FM-RDS station, the station name  
or call letters displays. In rare cases,  
a radio station can broadcast  
The audio system has a Radio Data  
System (RDS). The RDS feature  
is available for use only on FM  
stations that broadcast RDS  
information. This system relies upon  
receiving specific information  
incorrect information that causes  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-59  
the radio features to work  
improperly. If this happens, contact  
the radio station.  
The radio only seeks and scans  
stations with a strong signal that are  
in the selected band.  
FAV (Favorites): A maximum of  
36 stations can be programmed as  
favorites using the six pushbuttons  
positioned below the radio station  
frequency labels and by using  
the FAV button (radio favorites  
page). Press the FAV button to go  
through up to six pages of  
favorites, each having six favorite  
stations available per page.  
Each page of favorites can contain  
any combination of AM, FM, or  
XM stations. To store a station as a  
favorite:  
Playing the Radio  
4 (Information) (XM™ Satellite  
Radio Service, MP3, and  
RDS Features): Press to display  
additional text information related to  
the current FM-RDS station, XM  
station, or MP3 song. If information  
is available, the song title  
information displays on the top line  
of the display and artist information  
displays on the bottom line.  
When information is not available,  
“NO INFO” displays.  
O (Power/Volume): Press to turn  
the system on and off.  
Turn to increase or decrease the  
volume.  
Finding a Station  
BAND: Press to switch between  
AM, FM, or XM™ (if equipped).  
1. Tune to the desired radio station.  
f (Tune): Turn to select radio  
stations.  
2. Press the FAV button to  
display the page where  
the station is to be stored.  
Storing a Radio Station as a  
Favorite  
©SEEK ¨: Press to go to the  
Drivers are encouraged to set up  
their radio station favorites while the  
vehicle is parked. Tune to favorite  
stations using the presets, favorites  
button, and steering wheel  
controls, if the vehicle has them.  
See Defensive Driving on page 4-3.  
3. Press and hold one of the six  
pushbuttons until a beep  
previous or to the next station.  
To scan stations, press and hold  
either arrow for a few seconds until  
a beep sounds. The radio goes  
to a station, plays for a few seconds,  
then goes to the next station.  
Press either arrow again to stop  
scanning.  
sounds. When that pushbutton is  
pressed and released, the  
station that was set, returns.  
4. Repeat the steps for each  
pushbutton radio station to  
be stored as a favorite.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-60  
Instrument Panel  
The number of favorites pages can  
be setup using the MENU button.  
To setup the number of favorites  
pages:  
To quickly adjust all tone and  
speaker controls to the middle  
position, press the f knob for more  
than two seconds until a beep  
sounds.  
Setting the Tone  
(Bass/Midrange/Treble)  
BASS/MID/TREB (Bass, Midrange,  
or Treble): To adjust bass,  
1. Press the MENU button to  
display the radio setup menu.  
midrange, or treble, press the f  
knob until the tone control tabs  
display. Continue pressing to  
highlight the desired tab, or press  
the pushbutton positioned under the  
desired tab. Turn the f knob to  
adjust the highlighted setting. Bass,  
midrange, or treble can also be  
adjusted by pressing either SEEK  
EQ (Equalization): Press to select  
preset equalization settings.  
2. Press the pushbutton located  
below the FAV 1-6 label.  
To return to the manual mode,  
press the EQ button until Manual  
displays or manually adjust the  
bass, midrange, or treble by  
3. Select the desired number of  
favorites pages by pressing  
the pushbutton located below the  
displayed page numbers.  
pressing the f knob.  
4. Press the FAV button, or let the  
menu time out, to return to the  
original main radio screen  
showing the radio station  
Adjusting the Speakers  
(Balance/Fade)  
arrow, \ FWD, or s REV  
when the setting is highlighted until  
the desired level is obtained. If a  
station’s frequency is weak, or has  
static, decrease the treble.  
BAL/FADE (Balance/Fade): To  
adjust balance or fade, press  
the tune knob until the speaker  
control labels display. Continue  
pressing to highlight the desired tab,  
or press the pushbutton positioned  
under the desired label.  
frequency tabs and to begin the  
process of programming  
favorites for the chosen amount  
of numbered pages.  
To quickly adjust bass, midrange, or  
treble to the middle position,  
press the pushbutton positioned  
under the BASS, MID, or TREB tab  
for more than two seconds. A  
beep sounds and the level adjusts  
to the middle position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-61  
4. To exit the category search  
Finding a Category (CAT)  
Station  
Turn the f knob clockwise or  
counterclockwise to adjust the  
highlighted setting. The highlighted  
setting can also be adjusted by  
pressing either SEEK arrow,  
\ FWD, or s REV until the  
desired levels are obtained.  
mode, press the FAV button  
or BAND button to display  
favorites again.  
CAT (Category): The CAT button  
is used to find XM stations when  
the radio is in the XM mode. To find  
XM channels within a desired  
Undesired XM categories can be  
removed through the setup  
menu. To remove an undesired  
category:  
category, perform the following:  
1. Press the BAND button until the  
XM frequency displays. Press  
the CAT button to display  
To quickly adjust balance or fade  
to the middle position, press the  
pushbutton positioned under the  
BAL or FADE label for more than  
two seconds. A beep sounds and the  
level adjusts to the middle position.  
1. Press the MENU button to  
display the radio setup menu.  
the category tabs on the radio  
display. Continue pressing  
the CAT button until the desired  
category name displays.  
2. Press the pushbutton located  
below the XM CAT tab.  
3. Turn the f knob to display the  
To quickly adjust all speaker and  
tone controls to the middle position,  
press the f knob for more than  
category to be removed.  
2. Press either of the two buttons  
below the desired category tab  
to immediately tune to the  
first XM station associated with  
that category.  
4. Press the pushbutton located  
under the Remove tab until  
the category name along with the  
word Removed displays.  
two seconds until a beep sounds.  
5. Repeat the steps to remove  
more categories.  
3. Turn the f knob, press the  
buttons below the right or  
left arrows displayed, or press  
either SEEK arrow to go to  
the previous or to the next XM  
station within the selected  
category.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-62  
Instrument Panel  
Removed categories can be  
restored by pressing the pushbutton  
under the Add tab when a removed  
category is displayed or by  
pressing the pushbutton under the  
Restore All tab.  
call 1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and  
xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677  
in Canada.  
Playing a CD (Single CD  
Player)  
Insert a CD partway into the slot,  
label side up. The player pulls  
it in and the CD should begin  
playing.  
Radio Messages for XM Only  
page 3-71 later in this section for  
further detail.  
The radio does not allow categories  
to be removed or added while  
the vehicle is moving faster than  
5 mph (8 km/h).  
Playing a CD(s) (Six-Disc CD  
Player)  
Radio Messages  
LOAD ^ : Press to load CDs into  
the CD player. This CD player  
holds up to six CDs.  
Calibration Error: The audio  
XM™ Satellite Radio Service  
system has been calibrated for the  
vehicle from the factory. If Calibration  
Error displays, it means that the radio  
has not been configured properly for  
the vehicle and it must be returned to  
your dealer/retailer for service.  
XM is a satellite radio service  
that is based in the 48 contiguous  
United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio  
has a wide variety of programming  
and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality  
sound. During your trial or when  
you subscribe, you will get unlimited  
access to XM Radio Online for  
when you are not in the vehicle. A  
service fee is required to receive the  
XM service. For more information,  
contact XM at xmradio.com or  
To insert one CD:  
1. Press and release the ^ button.  
2. Wait for the message to insert  
the disc.  
Locked: This message displays  
when the THEFTLOCK® system has  
locked up the radio. Take the  
vehicle to your dealer/retailer for  
service.  
3. Load a CD. Insert the CD  
partway into the slot, label side  
up. The player pulls the CD in.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if  
an error cannot be corrected,  
contact your dealer/retailer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-63  
To insert multiple CDs:  
Care of CDs  
Care of the CD Player  
If playing a CD-R, the sound quality  
can be reduced due to CD-R quality,  
the method of recording, the quality  
of the music that has been recorded,  
and the way the CD-R has been  
handled. Handle them carefully.  
Store CD-R(s) in their original cases  
or other protective cases and away  
from direct sunlight and dust. The CD  
player scans the bottom surface of  
the disc. If the surface of a CD is  
damaged, such as cracked, broken,  
or scratched, the CD does not play  
properly or not at all. Do not touch  
the bottom side of a CD while  
Do not add any label to a CD, it  
could get caught in the CD player. If  
a CD is recorded on a personal  
computer and a description label is  
needed, try labeling the top of  
1. Press and hold the ^ button for  
two seconds. A beep sounds and  
Load All Discs displays.  
2. Follow the displayed instruction  
on when to insert the discs. The  
CD player takes up to six CDs.  
the recorded CD with a marking pen.  
To prevent contaminating the lens  
of the disc optics with lubricants  
internal to the player mechanism the  
use of disc lens cleaners is not  
advised.  
3. Press the ^ button again  
to cancel loading more CDs.  
If the ignition or radio is turned off,  
with a CD in the player, it stays  
in the player. When the ignition or  
radio is turned on, the CD starts  
playing where it stopped, if it  
Notice: If a label is added to a CD,  
or more than one CD is inserted  
into the slot at a time, or an  
was the last selected audio source.  
handling it; this could damage the  
surface. Pick up CDs by grasping the  
outer edges or the edge of the hole  
and the outer edge.  
attempt is made to play scratched  
or damaged CDs, the CD player  
could be damaged. While using  
the CD player, use only CDs in  
good condition without any label,  
load one CD at a time, and keep  
the CD player and the loading slot  
free of foreign materials, liquids,  
and debris.  
When a CD is inserted, the CD  
symbol displays on the CD. As each  
new track starts to play, the track  
number displays.  
If the surface of a CD is soiled, take  
a soft, lint free cloth or dampen a  
clean, soft cloth in a mild, neutral  
detergent solution mixed with water,  
and clean it. Make sure the wiping  
process starts from the center to  
the edge.  
The CD player can play the smaller  
3 inch (8 cm) single CDs with an  
adapter ring. Full-size CDs and the  
smaller CDs are loaded in the  
same manner.  
If an error displays, see “CD  
Messages” later in this section.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-64  
Instrument Panel  
Press the pushbutton positioned  
under the RDM tab until  
Randomize All Discs displays to  
play tracks from all CDs loaded in  
a six-disc CD player in random  
order. Press again to turn off  
random play.  
Z EJECT: To eject the CD that  
is currently playing, press and  
release this button. A beep sounds  
and Ejecting Disc displays. Once  
the disc is ejected, Remove  
Disc displays. The CD can be  
removed. If the CD is not removed,  
after several seconds, the CD  
automatically pulls back into the  
player and begins playing.  
s REV (Fast Reverse): Press  
and hold to reverse playback quickly  
within a track. Sound is heard at  
a reduced volume. Release to  
resume playing the track. The  
elapsed time of the track displays.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press  
and hold to advance playback  
quickly within a track. Sound is  
heard at a reduced volume. Release  
to resume playing the track. The  
elapsed time of the track displays.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio  
when a CD is playing. The CD  
remains inside the radio for future  
listening.  
For the Six-Disc CD player, press  
and hold Z for two seconds  
to eject all discs.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to  
play a CD when listening to the  
radio. The CD icon and track  
number displays when a CD is in  
the player.  
RDM (Random): With the random  
setting, the tracks can be listened to  
in random, rather than sequential  
order, on one CD or all CDs in a  
six-disc CD player.  
f (Tune): Turn to select tracks on  
the CD currently playing.  
©SEEK ¨: Press the left arrow  
to go to the start of the current track,  
if more than ten seconds have  
played. Press the right arrow to go  
to the next track. If either the  
left or right arrow is held, or pressed  
multiple times, the player continues  
moving backward or forward  
The radio system has an auxiliary  
input jack located on the lower right  
side of the faceplate. An external  
audio device such as a portable  
audio player can be connected to  
the auxiliary input jack for use  
To use random:  
Press the pushbutton positioned  
under the RDM tab until Random  
Current Disc displays to play the  
tracks from a CD in random  
order. Press again to turn off  
random play.  
as another source for playing CDs.  
through the tracks on the CD.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-65  
Press the CD/AUX button again and  
the system begins playing audio  
from the connected portable audio  
player. If a portable audio player  
is not connected, “No Input Device  
Found” displays.  
The road is very rough. When  
the road becomes smoother,  
the CD should play.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system has an auxiliary  
input jack located on the lower right  
side of the faceplate. This is not  
an audio output; do not plug  
the headphone set into the front  
auxiliary input jack. An external  
audio device such as an iPod™,  
laptop computer, MP3 player,  
CD changer, etc. can be connected  
to the auxiliary input jack for use  
as another audio source.  
The CD is dirty, scratched, wet,  
or upside down.  
The air is very humid. If so, wait  
about an hour and try again.  
Playing an MP3 CD-R or  
CD-RW Disc  
There could have been a problem  
while burning the CD.  
The vehicle’s radio system may  
have the MP3 feature. If it has this  
feature, it is capable of playing  
an MP3 CD-R or CD-RW disc. For  
more information on how to play  
an MP3 CD-R or CD-RW disc, see  
Using an MP3 on page 3-66  
later in this section.  
The label could be caught in the  
CD player.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up  
any auxiliary device while the  
vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive  
Driving on page 4-3 for more  
If the CD is not playing correctly, for  
any other reason, try a known  
good CD.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if  
an error cannot be corrected,  
contact your dealer/retailer. If the  
radio displays an error message,  
write it down and provide it to your  
dealer/retailer when reporting  
the problem.  
information on driver distraction.  
CD Messages  
To use a portable audio player,  
connect a 3.5 mm (1/8 inch) cable  
to the radio’s front auxiliary input  
jack. When a device is connected,  
press the radio CD/AUX button  
to begin playing audio from  
the device over the vehicle  
speakers.  
CHECK DISC: If this message  
displays and/or the CD comes out, it  
could be:  
It is very hot. When the  
temperature returns to normal,  
the CD should play.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-66  
Instrument Panel  
MP3 Format  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to  
increase or decrease the volume of  
the portable player. Additional  
volume adjustments might have to  
be made from the portable device if  
the volume is not loud or soft  
enough.  
Using an MP3  
To burn an MP3 disc on a personal  
computer:  
MP3 CD-R or CD-RW Disc  
The radio plays MP3 files that were  
recorded on a CD-R or CD-RW disc.  
The files can be recorded with the  
following fixed bit rates: 32 kbps,  
40 kbps, 56 kbps, 64 kbps, 80 kbps,  
96 kbps, 112 kbps, 128 kbps,  
160 kbps, 192 kbps, 224 kbps,  
256 kbps, and 320 kbps or a variable  
bit rate. Song title, artist name, and  
album are available for display by the  
radio when recorded using ID3 tags  
version 1 and 2.  
Make sure the MP3 files are  
recorded on a CD-R or  
CD-RW disc.  
Do not mix standard audio and  
MP3 files on one disc.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio  
when a portable audio device is  
playing. The portable audio device  
continues playing.  
The CD player is able to read  
and play a maximum of  
50 folders, 50 playlists, and  
255 files.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to  
play a CD when a portable audio  
device is playing. Press again  
and the system begins playing audio  
from the connected portable audio  
player. If a portable audio player  
is not connected, “No Input Device  
Found” displays.  
Create a folder structure that  
makes it easy to find songs while  
driving. Organize songs by  
albums using one folder for each  
album. Each folder or album  
should contain 18 songs or less.  
Compressed Audio  
The radio also plays discs that  
contain both uncompressed  
CD audio (.CDA files) and MP3  
files. By default the radio reads only  
the uncompressed audio and  
ignore the MP3 files. Pressing the  
CAT (category) button toggles  
between compressed and  
Avoid subfolders. The system can  
support up to eight subfolders  
deep, however, keep the total  
number of folders to a minimum in  
order to reduce the complexity  
and confusion in trying to locate a  
particular folder during playback.  
uncompressed audio format.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-67  
also be played. If a CD-R or CD-RW  
contains more than the maximum of  
50 folders, 50 playlists, and 255 files,  
the player can access and navigate  
up to the maximum, but all items over  
the maximum are not accessible.  
No Folder  
Make sure playlists have a .mp3  
or .wpl extension, other file  
extensions may not work.  
When the CD contains only  
compressed files, the files are  
located under the root folder. The  
next and previous folder functions do  
not display on a CD that was  
recorded without folders or playlists.  
When displaying the name of the  
folder the radio displays ROOT.  
Minimize the length of the file,  
folder or playlist names. Long file,  
folder, or playlist names, or a  
combination of a large number of  
files and folders, or playlists can  
cause the player to be unable to  
play up to the maximum number  
of files, folders, playlists, or  
sessions. To play a large number  
of files, folders, playlists or  
sessions, minimize the length of  
the file, folder, or playlist name.  
Long names also take up more  
space on the display, potentially  
getting cut off.  
Root Directory  
The root directory of the CD-R or  
CD-RW is treated as a folder. If the  
root directory has compressed audio  
files, the directory displays as F1  
ROOT. All files contained directly  
under the root directory are  
accessed prior to any root directory  
folders. However, playlists (Px) are  
always accessed before root folders  
or files.  
When the CD contains only playlists  
and compressed audio files, but  
no folders, all files are located under  
the root folder. The folder down  
and up buttons searches playlists  
(Px) first and then go to the  
root folder. When the radio displays  
the name of the folder the radio  
displays ROOT.  
Empty Directory or Folder  
Finalize the audio disc before  
burning it. Trying to add music to  
an existing disc can cause the  
disc not to function in the player.  
If a root directory or a folder exists  
somewhere in the file structure that  
contains only folders/subfolders and  
no compressed files directly beneath  
them, the player advances to the  
next folder in the file structure that  
contains compressed audio files. The  
empty folder does not display.  
Playlists can be changed by using  
the previous and next folder buttons,  
the tune knob, or the SEEK arrows.  
An MP3 CD-R or CD-RW that was  
recorded using no file folders can  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-68  
Instrument Panel  
Order of Play  
File System and Naming  
Playing an MP3  
Tracks recorded to the CD-R or  
CD-RW are played in the following  
order:  
The song name that is displayed is  
the song name that is contained  
in the ID3 tag. If the song name is  
not present in the ID3 tag, then  
the radio displays the file name  
without the extension (such as .mp3)  
as the track name.  
Insert a CD-R or CD-RW partway  
into the slot (Single CD Player),  
or press the ^ button and wait for  
the message to insert disc  
(Six-Disc CD Player), label side up.  
The player pulls it in, and the  
CD-R or CD-RW should begin  
playing.  
Play begins from the first track in  
the first playlist and continues  
sequentially through all tracks in  
each playlist. When the last  
track of the last playlist has  
Track names longer than  
played, play continues from the  
first track of the first playlist.  
32 characters or four pages are  
shortened. Parts of words on the  
last page of text and the extension  
of the filename does not display.  
If the ignition or radio is turned off  
with a CD-R or CD-RW in the  
player, it stays in the player. When  
the ignition or radio is turned on,  
the CD-R or CD-RW starts to  
play where it stopped, if it was the  
last selected audio source.  
Play begins from the first track in  
the first folder and continues  
sequentially through all tracks in  
each folder. When the last  
Preprogrammed Playlists  
Preprogrammed playlists that  
were created by WinAmp™,  
MusicMatch™, or Real Jukebox™  
software can be accessed, however,  
they cannot be edited using the  
radio. These playlists are treated as  
special folders containing  
track of the last folder has been  
played, play continues from  
the first track of the first folder.  
As each new track starts to play,  
the track number and song title  
displays.  
When play enters a new folder, the  
display does not automatically  
show the new folder name unless  
the folder mode is chosen as  
the default display. The new track  
name displays.  
Z EJECT: Press and release to  
eject the CD-R or CD-RW that  
is playing. A beep sounds  
and Ejecting Disc displays. Once  
the disc is ejected, Remove  
compressed audio song files.  
Disc displays. The CD-R or CD-RW  
can be removed. If the CD-R or  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-69  
CD-RW is not removed, after  
several seconds, the CD-R or  
CD-RW automatically pulls back into  
the player and begins playing.  
RDM (Random): With the random  
setting, the MP3 files on the  
CD-R or CD-RW can be listened to  
in random, rather than sequential  
order, on one CD-R/CD-RW or  
all discs in a six-disc CD player. To  
use random, do one of the  
following:  
S c (Previous Folder): Press  
the pushbutton positioned under the  
Folder label to go to the first  
track in the previous folder.  
For the Six-Disc CD player, press  
and hold this button for two seconds  
to eject all discs.  
c T (Next Folder): Press the  
pushbutton positioned under  
the Folder label to go to the first  
track in the next folder.  
f (Tune): Turn to select MP3 files  
on the CD-R or CD-RW currently  
playing.  
1. To play MP3 files from the CD-R  
or CD-RW in random order,  
press the pushbutton positioned  
under the RDM label until  
s REV (Reverse): Press and  
hold to reverse playback quickly  
within an MP3 file. Sound is heard  
at a reduced volume. Release  
to resume playing the file. The  
elapsed time of the file displays.  
©SEEK ¨: Press the left arrow  
to go to the start of the current MP3  
file, if more than ten seconds  
have played. Press the right arrow  
to go to the next MP3 file. If  
either arrow is held or pressed  
multiple times, the player continues  
moving backward or forward  
Random Current Disc displays.  
Press the same pushbutton again  
to turn off random play.  
2. To play songs from all CDs  
loaded in a six-disc CD player in  
random order, press the  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press  
and hold to advance playback  
quickly within an MP3 file. Sound is  
heard at a reduced volume.  
Release to resume playing the file.  
The elapsed time of the file  
displays.  
pushbutton positioned under the  
RDM label until Randomize  
All Discs displays. Press  
the same pushbutton again to  
turn off random play.  
through MP3 files on the CD.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-70  
Instrument Panel  
arrow button. The disc goes to the  
next or previous artist in alphabetical  
order. Continue pressing either  
button until the desired artist is  
displayed.  
To exit music navigator mode, press  
the pushbutton below the Back label  
to return to normal MP3 playback.  
h (Music Navigator): Use the  
music navigator feature to play MP3  
files on the CD-R or CD-RW in order  
by artist or album. Press the  
pushbutton located below the music  
navigator label. The player scans the  
disc to sort the files by artist and  
album ID3 tag information. It can  
take several minutes to scan the disc  
depending on the number of MP3  
files recorded to the CD-R or  
CD-RW. The radio can begin playing  
while it is scanning the disc in the  
background. When the scan is  
finished, the CD-R or CD-RW begins  
playing again.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio  
while a CD is playing. The inactive  
CD remains inside the radio for  
future listening.  
To change from playback by artist to  
playback by album, press the  
pushbutton located below the Sort  
By label. From the sort screen, push  
one of the buttons below the album  
button. Press the pushbutton below  
the back label to return to the main  
music navigator screen. Now the  
album name is displayed on the  
second line between the arrows and  
songs from the current album begins  
to play. Once all songs from that  
album are played, the player moves  
to the next album in alphabetical  
order on the CD-R/CD-RW and  
begins playing MP3 files from that  
album.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to  
play a CD while listening to the  
radio. The CD icon and a message  
showing disc and/or track number  
displays while a CD is in the player.  
Press this button again and the  
system automatically searches for  
an auxiliary input device such  
as a portable audio player. If a  
portable audio player is not  
Once the disc has been scanned, the  
player defaults to playing MP3 files in  
order by artist. The current artist  
playing is shown on the second line  
of the display between the arrows.  
Once all songs by that artist are  
played, the player moves to the next  
artist in alphabetical order on the  
CD-R/CD-RW and begins playing  
MP3 files by that artist. To listen to  
MP3 files by another artist, press the  
pushbutton located below either  
connected, “No Aux Input Device”  
displays.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-71  
Channel Unauth: This channel is  
blocked or cannot be received  
with your XM Subscription package.  
CAT Not Found: There are no  
channels available for the selected  
category. The system is working  
properly.  
XM Radio Messages  
XL (Explicit Language Channels):  
These channels, or any  
others, can be blocked at a  
customer’s request, by calling  
1-800-852-XMXM (9696).  
Channel Unavail: This previously  
assigned channel is no longer  
assigned. Tune to another station. If  
this station was one of the presets,  
choose another station for that  
preset button.  
XM Theftlocked: The XM™  
receiver in your vehicle could  
have previously been in another  
vehicle. For security purposes,  
XM™ receivers cannot be swapped  
between vehicles. If this message  
is received after having your vehicle  
serviced, check with your  
XM Updating: The encryption code  
in the receiver is being updated,  
and no action is required. This  
process should take no longer than  
30 seconds.  
No Artist Info: No artist information  
is available at this time on this  
channel. The system is working  
properly.  
dealer/retailer.  
No XM Signal: The system is  
functioning correctly, but the vehicle  
is in a location that is blocking  
the XM™ signal. When the vehicle  
is moved into an open area, the  
signal should return.  
XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0,  
this message alternates with the  
XM™ Radio 8 digit radio ID  
label. This label is needed to  
activate the service.  
No Title Info: No song title  
information is available at this time  
on this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
No CAT Info: No category  
information is available at this time  
on this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
Loading XM: The audio system is  
acquiring and processing audio  
and text data. No action is needed.  
This message should disappear  
shortly.  
Unknown: If this message is  
received when tuned to channel 0,  
there could be a receiver fault.  
Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
No Information: No text or  
informational messages are  
available at this time on this  
channel. The system is working  
properly.  
Channel Off Air: This channel is  
not currently in service. Tune  
in to another channel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-72  
Instrument Panel  
Check XM Receivr: If this message  
does not clear within a short  
period of time, the receiver could  
have a fault. Consult with your  
dealer/retailer.  
in memory for later calls. To prevent  
missed calls, a minimum volume  
level is used if the volume is turned  
down too low.  
Voice Recognition  
The Bluetooth system uses voice  
recognition to interpret voice  
commands to dial phone numbers  
and name tags.  
Bluetooth Controls  
XM Not Available: If this message  
does not clear within a short  
period of time, the receiver could  
have a fault. Consult with your  
dealer/retailer.  
Noise: Keep interior noise levels to  
a minimum. The system may not  
recognize voice commands if there  
is too much background noise.  
Use the buttons located on the  
steering wheel to operate the  
in-vehicle Bluetooth system. See  
on page 3-82 for more information.  
When to Speak: A short tone  
sounds after the system responds  
indicating when it is waiting for  
a voice command. Wait until  
the tone and then speak.  
Bluetooth®  
J / 0 (Push To Talk): Press to  
answer incoming calls, confirm  
system information, and to start  
speech recognition.  
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can  
use a Bluetooth capable cell phone  
with a Hands Free Profile to make  
and receive phone calls. The system  
can be used while the key is in  
ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY  
position. The range of the Bluetooth  
system can be up to 30 ft. (9.1 m).  
Not all phones support all functions,  
and not all phones are guaranteed to  
work with the in-vehicle Bluetooth  
system. See gm.com/bluetooth for  
more information on compatible  
phones.  
How to Speak: Speak clearly in a  
calm and natural voice.  
/ K (Phone On Hook): Press  
to end a call and to cancel an  
operation.  
Audio System  
When using the in-vehicle Bluetooth  
system, sound comes through  
the vehicle’s front audio system  
speakers and overrides the audio  
system. Use the audio system  
volume knob, during a call,  
Pairing  
A Bluetooth enabled cell phone  
must be paired to the in-vehicle  
Bluetooth system first and then  
connected to the vehicle before it  
can be used. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for  
to change the volume level. The  
adjusted volume level remains  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-73  
Bluetooth functions before pairing  
the cell phone. If a Bluetooth phone  
is not connected, calls will be  
made using OnStar® Hands-Free  
Calling, if available. Refer to  
the OnStar owner’s guide for more  
information.  
To link to a different paired phone,  
see Linking to a Different Phone  
later in this section.  
Locate the device named  
“General Motors” in the list on the  
cellular phone and follow the  
instructions on the cell phone to  
enter the four digit PIN number  
that was provided in Step 3.  
Pairing a Phone  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
5. The system prompts for a name  
for the phone. Use a name that  
best describes the phone.  
This name will be used to  
indicate which phone is  
Pairing Information:  
Up to five cell phones can be  
paired to the in-vehicle  
Bluetooth system.  
2. Say “Bluetooth”. The system  
responds with “Bluetooth  
connected. The system then  
confirms the name provided.  
ready” followed by a tone.  
The pairing process is disabled  
when the vehicle is moving.  
3. Say “Pair”. The system responds  
with instructions and a four digit  
PIN number. The PIN number  
will be used in Step 4.  
6. The system responds with  
“<Phone name> has been  
successfully paired” after the  
pairing process is complete.  
The in-vehicle Bluetooth system  
automatically links with the first  
available paired cell phone in the  
order the phone was paired.  
4. Start the Pairing process on the  
cell phone that will be paired to  
the vehicle. Reference the  
cell phone manufacturers user  
guide for information on this  
process.  
7. Repeat Steps 1 through 7 for  
additional phones to be paired.  
Only one paired cell phone can  
be connected to the in-vehicle  
Bluetooth system at a time.  
Pairing should only need to be  
completed once, unless changes  
to the pairing information have  
been made or the phone is  
deleted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-74  
Instrument Panel  
Listing All Paired and Connected  
Phones  
3. Say “Delete”. The system asks  
which phone to delete followed  
by a tone.  
3. Say “Change phone”. The  
system responds with “Please  
wait while I search for other  
phones”.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
4. Say the name of the phone to be  
deleted. If the phone name is  
If another phone is found, the  
response will be “<Phone  
name> is now connected”.  
unknown, use the “List” command  
for a list of all paired phones. The  
system responds with “Would you  
like to delete <phone name>?  
Yes or No” followed by a tone.  
2. Say “Bluetooth”. The system  
responds with “Bluetooth  
If another phone is not found,  
the original phone remains  
connected.  
ready” followed by a tone.  
3. Say “List”. The system lists all  
the paired Bluetooth devices.  
If a phone is connected to  
the vehicle, the system will say  
“Is connected” after the  
5. Say “Yes” to delete the phone.  
The system responds with “OK,  
deleting <phone name>”.  
Storing Name Tags  
The system can store up to thirty  
phone numbers as name tags  
that are shared between the  
Bluetooth and OnStar systems.  
Linking to a Different Phone  
connected phone.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
Deleting a Paired Phone  
The system uses the following  
commands to store and retrieve  
phone numbers:  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
2. Say “Bluetooth”. The system  
responds with “Bluetooth  
Store  
Digit Store  
Directory  
ready” followed by a tone.  
2. Say “Bluetooth”. The system  
responds with “Bluetooth  
ready” followed by a tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-75  
Using the Store Command  
If the system is unsure it  
recognizes the phone number,  
it responds with “Store” and  
repeats the number followed  
by “Please say yes or no”. If  
the number is correct, say  
“Yes”. If the number is not  
correct, say “No”. The system  
will ask for the number to be  
re-entered.  
If the name tag sounds  
correct, say “Yes” and the  
name tag is stored. After the  
number is stored the system  
returns to the main menu.  
The store command allows a phone  
number to be stored without  
entering the digits individually.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
Using the Digit Store Command  
The digit store command allows  
a phone number to be stored  
by entering the digits individually.  
2. Say “Store”. The system  
responds with “Store, number  
please” followed by a tone.  
4. After the system stores the  
phone number, it responds  
with “Please say the name tag”  
followed by a tone.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
3. Say the complete phone number  
to be stored at once with no  
pauses.  
5. Say a name tag for the phone  
number. The name tag is  
recorded and the system  
responds with “About to  
store <name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?”.  
2. Say “Digit Store”. The system  
responds with “Please say the  
first digit to store” followed  
by a tone.  
If the system recognizes the  
number it responds with  
“OK, Storing” and repeats the  
phone number.  
If the name tag does not sound  
correct, say “No” and repeat  
Step 5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-76  
Instrument Panel  
3. Say the first digit to be stored.  
The system will repeat back  
the digit it heard followed by a  
tone. Continue entering digits  
until the number to be stored is  
complete.  
5. Say a name tag for the phone  
number. The name tag is  
recorded and the system  
responds with “About to store  
<name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?”.  
2. Say “Directory”. The system  
responds with “Directory”  
and then plays back all of the  
stored name tags. When the list  
is complete, the system  
returns to the main menu.  
If an unwanted number is  
recognized by the system,  
say “Clear” at any time  
to clear the last number.  
If the name tag does not sound  
correct, say “No” and repeat  
Step 5.  
Deleting Name Tags  
The system uses the following  
commands to delete name tags:  
If the name tag sounds  
Delete  
To hear all of the numbers  
recognized by the system,  
say “Verify” at any time  
and the system will  
correct, say “Yes” and the  
name tag is stored. After the  
number is stored the system  
returns to the main menu.  
Delete all name tags  
Using the Delete Command  
repeat them.  
The delete command allows specific  
name tags to be deleted.  
Using the Directory Command  
4. After the complete number has  
been entered, say “Store”. The  
system responds with “Please  
say the name tag” followed by  
a tone.  
The directory command lists  
all of the name tags stored by the  
system. To use the directory  
command:  
To use the delete command:  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
2. Say “Delete”. The system  
responds with “Delete, please  
say the name tag” followed by  
a tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-77  
3. Say the name tag to be deleted.  
The system responds with  
“Would you like to delete,  
<name tag>? Please say yes  
or no”.  
To use the delete all name tags  
command:  
Using the Dial Command  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
If the name tag is correct, say  
“Yes” to delete the name tag.  
The system responds with  
“OK, deleting <name tag>,  
returning to the main menu.”  
2. Say “Dial”. The system responds  
with “Dial using <phone name>.  
“Number please” followed by  
a tone.  
2. Say “Delete all name tags”. The  
system responds with “You are  
about to delete all name tags  
stored in your phone directory  
and your route destination  
3. Say the entire number without  
pausing.  
If the name tag is incorrect,  
say “No”. The system  
responds with “No. OK, let’s  
try again, please say the  
name tag.”  
directory. Are you sure you want  
to do this? Please say yes or no.”  
If the system recognizes the  
number, it responds with  
“OK, Dialing” and dials  
the number.  
Say “Yes” to delete all  
name tags.  
Using the Delete All Name Tags  
Command  
Say “No” to cancel the function  
and return to the main menu.  
If the system does not  
recognize the number,  
The delete all name tags command  
deletes all stored phone book  
name tags and route name tags for  
OnStar (if present).  
it confirms the numbers  
followed by a tone. If the  
number is correct, say “Yes”.  
The system responds with  
“OK, Dialing” and dials  
the number. If the number is  
not correct, say “No”. The  
system will ask for the number  
to be re-entered.  
Making a Call  
Calls can be made using the  
following commands:  
Dial  
Digit Dial  
Call  
Re-dial  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-78  
Instrument Panel  
Using the Digit Dial Command  
To hear all of the numbers  
recognized by the system, say  
“Verify” at any time and the  
system will repeat them.  
If the system is unsure it  
recognizes the right name tag,  
it confirms the name tag  
followed by a tone. If  
the name tag is correct, say  
“Yes”. The system responds  
with “OK, calling, <name  
tag>” and dials the number. If  
the name tag is not correct,  
say “No”. The system will ask  
for the name tag to be  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
Using the Call Command  
2. Say “Digit Dial”. The system  
responds with “Digit dial  
using <phone name>, please say  
the first digit to dial” followed  
by a tone.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
2. Say “Call”. The system responds  
with “Call using <phone name>.  
Please say the name tag”  
followed by a tone.  
re-entered.  
3. Say the digit to be dialed one at  
a time. Following each digit, the  
system will repeat back the  
Once connected, the person called  
will be heard through the audio  
speakers.  
digit it heard followed by a tone.  
3. Say the name tag of the person  
to call.  
4. Continue entering digits until the  
number to be dialed is complete.  
After the whole number has  
been entered, say “Dial”.  
Using the Re-dial Command  
If the system clearly  
recognizes the name tag it  
responds with “OK, calling,  
<name tag>” and dials  
the number.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
The system responds with “OK,  
Dialing” and dials the number.  
If an unwanted number  
is recognized by the system,  
say “Clear” at any time to  
clear the last number.  
2. After the tone, say “Re-dial”. The  
system responds with “Re-dial  
using <phone name>” and dials  
the last number called from the  
connected Bluetooth phone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-79  
Once connected, the person called  
will be heard through the audio  
speakers.  
To ignore the incoming call,  
continue with the original call with  
no action.  
Ending a Call  
Press / K to end a call.  
Muting a Call  
Press / K to disconnect the  
current call and switch to the  
call on hold.  
Receiving a Call  
During a call, all sounds from inside  
the vehicle can be muted so that  
the person on the other end of  
the call cannot hear them.  
When an incoming call is received,  
the audio system mutes and a  
ring tone is heard in the vehicle.  
Three-Way Calling  
Press J / 0 and begin speaking  
to answer the call.  
Three-Way Calling must be  
supported on the Bluetooth phone  
and enabled by the wireless service  
carrier to work.  
To Mute a call  
1. Press J / 0. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
Press / K to ignore a call.  
Call Waiting  
1. While on a call press J / 0. The  
system responds with “Ready”  
followed by a tone.  
Call waiting must be supported on  
the Bluetooth phone and enabled  
by the wireless service carrier  
to work.  
2. Say “Mute Call”. The system  
responds with “Call muted”.  
2. Say “Three-way call”. The  
system responds with “Three-way  
call, please say dial or call”.  
To Cancel Mute  
1. Press J / 0. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
Press J / 0 to answer an  
incoming call when another call  
is active. The original call is  
placed on hold.  
3. Use the dial or call command to  
dial the number of the third party  
to be called.  
2. After the tone, say “Mute Call”.  
The system responds with  
“Resuming call”.  
Press J / 0 again to return to the  
original call.  
4. Once the call is connected,  
press J / 0 to link all the callers  
together.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-80  
Instrument Panel  
During a call with the audio on the  
3. Say “Voice”. The system  
responds with “OK, accessing  
<phone name>”.  
Transferring a Call  
cell phone, press J / 0 for more  
than two seconds. The audio  
switches from the cell phone to the  
vehicle.  
Audio can be transferred between  
the in-vehicle Bluetooth system  
and the cell phone.  
The cell phone’s normal  
prompt messages will  
go through its cycle according  
to the phone’s operating  
instructions.  
To Transfer Audio to the Cell  
Phone  
Voice Pass-Thru  
During a call with the audio in the  
vehicle:  
Voice Pass-Thru allows access to  
the voice recognition commands on  
the cell phone. See the cell  
phone manufacturers user guide to  
see if the cell phone supports  
this feature. This feature can be  
used to verbally access contacts  
stored in the cell phone.  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency  
(DTMF) Tones  
1. Press J / 0. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
The in-vehicle Bluetooth system can  
send numbers and numbers stored  
as name tags during a call. This is  
used when calling a menu driven  
phone system. Account numbers can  
be programmed into the phonebook  
for retrieval during menu driven calls.  
2. Say “Transfer Call.” The system  
responds with “Transferring call”  
and the audio will switch from  
the vehicle to the cell phone.  
1. Press and hold J / 0 for  
two seconds. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
To Transfer Audio to the  
In-Vehicle Bluetooth System  
Sending a Number During a Call  
The cellular phone must be paired  
and connected with the Bluetooth  
system before a call can be  
transferred. The connection process  
can take up to two minutes after  
the key is turned to the ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY position.  
2. Say “Bluetooth”. The system  
responds with “Bluetooth  
1. Press J / 0. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
ready” followed by a tone.  
2. Say “Dial”. The system responds  
with “Say a number to send  
tones” followed by a tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
3-81  
3. Say the number to send.  
3. Say the name tag to send.  
the above sections on Deleting a  
Paired Phone and Deleting  
Name Tags.  
If the system clearly  
recognizes the number it  
responds with “OK, Sending  
Number” and the dial  
tones are sent and the call  
continues.  
If the system clearly  
recognizes the name tag it  
responds with “OK, Sending  
<name tag>” and the dial  
tones are sent and the  
call continues.  
Other Information  
The Bluetooth® word mark and  
logos are owned by the Bluetooth®  
SIG, Inc. and any use of such  
marks by General Motors is under  
license. Other trademarks and  
trade names are those of their  
respective owners.  
If the system is not sure it  
recognized the number  
If the system is not sure it  
recognized the name tag  
properly, it responds  
properly, it responds “Dial  
Number, Please say yes or  
no?” followed by a tone. If the  
number is correct, say  
“Yes”. The system responds  
with “OK, Sending Number”  
and the dial tones are  
“Dial <name tag>, Please say  
yes or no?” followed by a  
tone. If the name tag is  
correct, say “Yes”. The  
system responds with “OK,  
Sending <name tag>” and the  
dial tones are sent and the  
call continues.  
This device complies with Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. Operation is  
subject to the following two  
conditions:  
sent and the call continues.  
1. This device may not cause  
harmful interference.  
Sending a Stored Name Tag  
During a Call  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
Clearing the System  
1. Press J / 0. The system  
responds with “Ready” followed  
by a tone.  
Unless information is deleted out of  
the in-vehicle Bluetooth system,  
it will be retained indefinitely. This  
includes all saved name tags in  
the phonebook and phone pairing  
information. For information on  
how to delete this information, see  
2. Say “Send name tag.” The  
system responds with “Say  
a name tag to send tones”  
followed by a tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-82  
Instrument Panel  
This device complies with RSS-210  
of Industry Canada. Operation is  
subject to the following two  
conditions:  
For vehicles with Bluetooth®, press  
to end a call, or cancel an  
incoming call.  
Audio Steering Wheel  
Controls  
v + v (Volume): Move the  
thumbwheel up or down to increase  
or to decrease the volume.  
1. This device may not cause  
interference.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the  
device.  
J 0 (Call / Mute): Press and  
release to mute the system. Press it  
again to turn the sound back on.  
For vehicles with OnStar® or  
Changes or modifications to this  
system by other than an authorized  
service facility could void  
Bluetooth systems, press and hold  
for longer than two seconds to  
interact with those systems. See  
OnStar® System on page 2-29 and  
Bluetooth® on page 3-72 in this  
manual for more information.  
Some audio controls can be  
adjusted at the steering wheel. They  
include the following:  
authorization to use this equipment.  
+ / (Next/Previous): Press and  
release to go to the next or the  
previous preset radio station or CD  
track.  
Theft-Deterrent Feature  
THEFTLOCK® is designed to  
discourage theft of the vehicle’s  
radio by learning a portion of  
the Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN). The radio does not operate if  
it is stolen or moved to a different  
vehicle.  
K (End Call): For vehicles with  
the OnStar® system, press to end a  
Hands-Free call, an OnStar® call,  
cancel an incoming call, or end  
the Advisor Playback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Panel  
3-83  
FM Stereo  
Cellular Phone Usage  
Radio Reception  
FM signals only reach about  
10 to 40 miles (16 to 65 km).  
Cellular phone usage may cause  
interference with the vehicle’s radio.  
This interference may occur when  
making or receiving phone calls,  
charging the phone’s battery,  
or simply having the phone on. This  
interference causes an increased  
level of static while listening to  
the radio. If static is received while  
listening to the radio, unplug the  
cellular phone and turn it off.  
Frequency interference and static  
can occur during normal radio  
reception if items such as cell phone  
chargers, vehicle convenience  
accessories, and external electronic  
devices are plugged into the  
accessory power outlet. If there is  
interference or static, unplug the item  
from the accessory power outlet.  
Although the radio has a built-in  
electronic circuit that automatically  
works to reduce interference,  
some static can occur, especially  
around tall buildings or hills, causing  
the sound to fade in and out.  
XM™ Satellite Radio Service  
AM  
XM Satellite Radio Service gives  
digital radio reception from  
The range for most AM stations is  
greater than for FM, especially at  
night. The longer range can cause  
station frequencies to interfere with  
each other. For better radio  
reception, most AM radio stations  
boost the power levels during the  
day, and then reduce these levels  
during the night. Static can also  
occur when things like storms and  
power lines interfere with radio  
reception. When this happens, try  
reducing the treble on the radio.  
coast-to-coast in the 48 contiguous  
United States, and in Canada.  
Just as with FM, tall buildings or hills  
can interfere with satellite radio  
signals, causing the sound to fade  
in and out. In addition, traveling  
or standing under heavy foliage,  
bridges, garages, or tunnels  
may cause loss of the XM signal for  
a period of time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3-84  
Instrument Panel  
Fixed Mast Antenna  
Chime Level Adjustment  
The fixed mast antenna can  
The radio may be used to adjust  
the vehicle’s chime level. If the radio  
can be used to change the volume  
level of the chime, press and  
hold the sixth FAV softkey with the  
ignition on and the radio power  
off. The volume level changes  
between Normal and Loud. The  
selected volume level appears on  
the radio display.  
withstand most car washes without  
being damaged as long as it is  
securely attached to the base. If the  
mast becomes slightly bent,  
straighten it out by hand. If the mast  
is badly bent, replace it.  
Occasionally check to make sure  
the antenna is tightened to its base.  
If tightening is required, tighten  
by hand.  
Removing the radio and not  
replacing it with a factory radio or  
chime module will disable vehicle  
chimes.  
XM™ Satellite Radio  
Antenna System  
The XM Satellite Radio antenna is  
located on the roof of the vehicle.  
Keep the antenna clear of  
obstructions for clear radio  
reception.  
If the vehicle has a sunroof, the  
performance of the XM system may  
be affected if the sunroof is open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-1  
Your Driving, the  
Road, and the Vehicle  
Driving Your  
Vehicle  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Whenever we drive, we are taking  
on an important responsibility.  
This is true for any motor  
vehicle — passenger car, van,  
truck, sport utility. Driver behavior,  
the driving environment, and  
the vehicle’s design all affect how  
well a vehicle performs. But  
statistics show that the most  
important factor, by far, is how  
we drive.  
Your Driving, the Road,  
and the Vehicle  
Knowing how these three factors  
work together can help you  
understand how your vehicle  
handles and what you can do to  
avoid many types of crashes,  
including a rollover crash.  
Towing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-2  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Utility vehicles do have higher  
ground clearance and a narrower  
track or shorter wheelbase than  
passenger cars, to make them more  
capable for off-road driving.  
Specific design characteristics like  
these give the driver a better view of  
the road, but also give utility  
vehicles a higher center of gravity  
than other types of vehicles.  
This means that you should not  
expect a utility vehicle to handle the  
same way a vehicle with a lower  
center of gravity, like a car, would in  
similar situations.  
Driver Behavior  
Driving Environment  
The single most important thing is  
this: everyone in the vehicle,  
including the driver, should buckle  
for Everyone on page 1-10. In fact,  
most serious injuries and fatalities  
to unbelted occupants can be  
reduced or prevented by the use of  
safety belts. In a rollover crash,  
an unbelted person is significantly  
more likely to die than a person  
wearing a seat belt. In addition,  
avoiding excessive speed, sudden  
or abrupt turns, and drunken or  
aggressive driving can help make  
trips safer and avoid the possibility  
of a crash, especially a rollover  
crash. This section provides many  
useful tips to help you drive  
You can also help avoid a rollover  
or other type of crash by being  
prepared for driving in inclement  
weather, at night, or during  
other times where visibility or  
traction may be limited, such as on  
curves, slippery roads, or hilly  
terrain. Unfamiliar surroundings can  
also have hidden hazards.  
To help you learn more about driving  
in different conditions, this section  
contains information about city,  
freeway, and off-road driving, as well  
as other hints for driving in various  
weather conditions.  
But driver behavior factors are far  
more often the cause of a utility  
vehicle rollover than are  
environmental or vehicle factors.  
Safe driver behavior and  
understanding the environment in  
which you will be driving can help  
avoid a rollover crash in any type of  
vehicle, including utility vehicles.  
Vehicle Design  
According to the U.S. Department  
of Transportation, utility vehicles  
have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
more safely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-3  
Always follow posted speed limits  
or drive more slowly when  
conditions require.  
Driving for Better Fuel  
Economy  
Driving habits can affect fuel  
mileage. Here are some driving tips  
to get the best fuel economy  
possible.  
{ CAUTION  
Assume that other road users  
Keep vehicle tires properly  
inflated.  
(pedestrians, bicyclists, and other  
drivers) are going to be careless  
and make mistakes. Anticipate  
what they might do and be ready.  
In addition:  
Allow enough following  
distance between you and  
the driver in front of you.  
Focus on the task of driving.  
Combine several trips into a  
single trip.  
Avoid fast starts and accelerate  
smoothly.  
Replace the vehicle’s tires with  
the same TPC Spec number  
molded into the tire’s sidewall  
near the size.  
Brake gradually and avoid  
abrupt stops.  
Avoid idling the engine for long  
periods of time.  
Follow recommended scheduled  
maintenance.  
Driver distraction can cause  
collisions resulting in injury or  
possible death. These simple  
defensive driving techniques could  
save your life.  
When road and weather  
conditions are appropriate, use  
cruise control, if equipped.  
Defensive Driving  
Defensive driving means “always  
expect the unexpected.” The  
first step in driving defensively is to  
wear your safety belt — See  
on page 1-10.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-4  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Police records show that almost  
40 percent of all motor  
Medical research shows that alcohol  
in a person’s system can make  
crash injuries worse, especially  
injuries to the brain, spinal cord, or  
heart. This means that when anyone  
who has been drinking — driver or  
passenger — is in a crash, that  
person’s chance of being killed or  
permanently disabled is higher than  
if the person had not been drinking.  
Drunk Driving  
vehicle-related deaths involve  
alcohol. In most cases, these deaths  
are the result of someone who was  
drinking and driving. In recent years,  
more than 17,000 annual motor  
vehicle-related deaths have been  
associated with the use of alcohol,  
with about 250,000 people injured.  
{ CAUTION  
Drinking and then driving is very  
dangerous. Your reflexes,  
perceptions, attentiveness, and  
judgment can be affected by even  
a small amount of alcohol. You  
can have a serious — or even  
fatal — collision if you drive after  
drinking. Do not drink and drive or  
ride with a driver who has been  
drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if  
you are with a group, designate a  
driver who will not drink.  
For persons under 21, it is against  
the law in every U.S. state to  
drink alcohol. There are good  
medical, psychological, and  
developmental reasons for  
these laws.  
Control of a Vehicle  
The following three systems  
help to control the vehicle while  
driving —brakes, steering, and  
accelerator. At times, as when  
driving on snow or ice, it is easy to  
ask more of those control systems  
than the tires and road can provide.  
Meaning, you can lose control of  
the vehicle. See Traction Control  
System (TCS) on page 4-8.  
The obvious way to eliminate the  
leading highway safety problem  
is for people never to drink alcohol  
and then drive.  
Death and injury associated with  
drinking and driving is a global  
tragedy.  
Alcohol affects four things that  
anyone needs to drive a vehicle:  
judgment, muscular coordination,  
vision, and attentiveness.  
Adding non-dealer/non-retailer  
accessories can affect vehicle  
performance. See Accessories  
and Modifications on page 5-3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-5  
And, of course, actual stopping  
distances vary greatly with the  
surface of the road, whether it is  
pavement or gravel; the condition of  
the road, whether it is wet, dry, or  
icy; tire tread; the condition of  
the brakes; the weight of the vehicle;  
and the amount of brake force  
applied.  
If the engine ever stops while the  
vehicle is being driven, brake  
normally but do not pump the  
brakes. If the brakes are pumped,  
the pedal could get harder to  
push down. If the engine stops,  
there will still be some power brake  
assist but it will be used when  
the brake is applied. Once the power  
assist is used up, it can take  
longer to stop and the brake pedal  
will be harder to push.  
Braking  
page 3-27.  
Braking action involves perception  
time and reaction time. Deciding  
to push the brake pedal is  
perception time. Actually doing it is  
reaction time.  
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some  
people drive in spurts — heavy  
acceleration followed by heavy  
Average reaction time is about  
three-fourths of a second. But that  
is only an average. It might be  
less with one driver and as long as  
two or three seconds or more  
with another. Age, physical  
condition, alertness, coordination,  
and eyesight all play a part. So  
do alcohol, drugs, and frustration.  
But even in three-fourths of a  
second, a vehicle moving at 60 mph  
(100 km/h) travels 66 feet (20 m).  
That could be a lot of distance in an  
emergency, so keeping enough  
space between the vehicle  
braking — rather than keeping pace  
with traffic. This is a mistake. The  
brakes might not have time to cool  
between hard stops. The brakes will  
wear out much faster with a lot of  
heavy braking. Keeping pace with  
the traffic and allowing realistic  
following distances eliminates a lot of  
unnecessary braking. That means  
better braking and longer brake life.  
Adding non-dealer/non-retailer  
accessories can affect vehicle  
performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 5-3.  
and others is important.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-6  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Let us say the road is wet and you  
are driving safely. Suddenly, an  
animal jumps out in front of you.  
You slam on the brakes and  
continue braking. Here is what  
happens with ABS:  
Remember: ABS does not change  
the time needed to get a foot  
up to the brake pedal or always  
decrease stopping distance. If you  
get too close to the vehicle in  
front of you, there will not be enough  
time to apply the brakes if that  
vehicle suddenly slows or stops.  
Always leave enough room up  
ahead to stop, even with ABS.  
Antilock Brake  
System (ABS)  
This vehicle has the Antilock Brake  
System (ABS), an advanced  
electronic braking system that helps  
prevent a braking skid.  
A computer senses that the wheels  
are slowing down. If one of the  
wheels is about to stop rolling, the  
computer will separately work  
the brakes at each wheel.  
When the engine is started and the  
vehicle begins to drive away,  
ABS checks itself. A momentary  
motor or clicking noise might  
be heard while this test is going on,  
and it might even be noticed that  
the brake pedal moves a little. This  
is normal.  
Using ABS  
ABS can change the brake pressure  
to each wheel, as required, faster  
than any driver could. This can  
help the driver steer around  
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold  
the brake pedal down firmly and  
let antilock work. The antilock pump  
or motor operating might be  
heard and the brake pedal might be  
felt to pulsate, but this is normal.  
the obstacle while braking hard.  
As the brakes are applied, the  
computer keeps receiving updates  
on wheel speed and controls braking  
pressure accordingly.  
Braking in Emergencies  
If there is BS, this  
warning light stays on. See  
Warning Light on page 3-28.  
ABS allows the driver to steer and  
brake at the same time. In many  
emergencies, steering can help more  
than even the very best braking.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-7  
StabiliTrak® System  
The vehicle has a vehicle stability  
enhancement system called  
StabiliTrak which combines antilock  
brake, traction and stability control  
systems and helps the driver  
maintain directional control of the  
vehicle in most driving conditions.  
The system may be heard or felt  
while it is working. This is normal  
and does not mean there is a  
problem with the vehicle.  
The StabiliTrak system automatically  
comes on whenever the vehicle is  
started. To assist the driver with  
vehicle directional control, especially  
in slippery road conditions, the  
system should always be left on.  
StabiliTrak can be turned off if  
needed.  
This light
instrument panel cluster.  
StabiliTrak activates when the  
computer senses a discrepancy  
between the intended path and the  
direction the vehicle is actually  
traveling. StabiliTrak selectively  
applies braking pressure at any one  
of the vehicle’s brakes to assist  
the driver with keeping the vehicle  
on the intended path.  
It will flash when StabiliTrak is both  
on and activated.  
The Tractim  
(TCS)/StabiliTrak button is located  
on the instrument panel.  
If the system fails to turn on or  
activate, this light will be on solid.  
When the light is on solid, the  
system will not assist the driver  
maintain directional control of  
the vehicle. Adjust your driving  
accordingly.  
TCS can be turned off or turned on  
by pressing and releasing the  
TCS/StabiliTrak button. To disable  
both StabiliTrak and TCS, press and  
hold the button until the TCS/  
StabiliTrak warning light turns  
on solid.  
When the vehicle is started and  
begins to move, the system  
performs several diagnostic checks  
to insure there are no problems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-8  
Driving Your Vehicle  
It is recommended to leave the  
system on for normal driving  
conditions, but it may be necessary  
to turn the system off if the  
vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice or  
snow, and you want to “rock” the  
vehicle to attempt to free it.  
Trailer Sway Control (TSC)  
Traction Control System  
(TCS)  
The vehicle has a Traction Control  
System (TCS) that limits wheel spin.  
This is especially useful in slippery  
road conditions. The system  
operates only if it senses that one or  
both of the front wheels are spinning  
or beginning to lose traction. When  
this happens, TCS applies the  
brakes to limit wheel spin and also  
reduces engine power. The system  
may be heard or felt while it is  
The vehicle has a Trailer Sway  
Control (TSC) feature as part of the  
StabiliTrak system. If the vehicle is  
towing a trailer and the system  
detects that the trailer is swaying, the  
vehicle’s brakes are applied without  
the driver pressing the brake pedal.  
The TCS/StabiliTrak warning light  
will flash on the instrument panel  
cluster to notify the driver to reduce  
speed. If the trailer continues to  
sway, StabiliTrak will reduce engine  
torque to help slow the vehicle.  
StabiliTrak may also turn off  
automatically if it determines that a  
problem exists with the system. The  
TCS/StabiliTrak warning light will be  
on solid to warn the driver that  
StabiliTrak is disabled and requires  
service. If the problem does not clear  
itself after restarting the vehicle, see  
your dealer/retailer for service.  
working, but this is normal.  
Adding non-dealer/non-retailer  
accessories can affect the vehicle’s  
performance. See Accessories  
and Modifications on page 5-3 for  
more information.  
If cruise control is being used when  
StabiliTrak activates, the cruise  
control automatically disengages.  
The cruise control can be  
re-engaged when road conditions  
allow. See Cruise Control on  
page 3-9.  
This light CS is  
limiting wheel spin.  
It is recommended to leave the  
system on for normal driving  
conditions, but it may be necessary  
to turn the system off if the vehicle is  
stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow, and  
you want to “rock” the vehicle to  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-9  
attempt to free it. See Rocking Your  
Vehicle to Get It Out on page 4-17  
Mud, Ice, or Snow on page 4-17 for  
more information.  
TCS may not be functioning  
properly and the vehicle should be  
serviced at your dealer/retailer.  
notice a reduced amount of power  
steering assist. The normal  
amount of power steering assist  
should return shortly after a  
Adding non-dealer/non-retailer  
accessories can affect the vehicle’s  
performance. See Accessories  
and Modifications on page 5-3 for  
more information.  
few normal steering movements.  
The electric power steering system  
does not require regular  
maintenance. If you suspect  
steering system problems and/or the  
Service Vehicle Soon light comes  
on, contact your dealer/retailer  
for service repairs.  
Steering  
The TCS/Son is  
located on the instrument panel.  
Electric Power Steering  
Press and release this button to turn  
off TCS. The TCS warning light  
will be displayed on the instrument  
panel. The traction control system  
can be turned back on by pressing  
the TCS/StabiliTrak button.  
If the engine stalls while driving, the  
power steering assist system will  
continue to operate until you  
are able to stop the vehicle. If power  
steering assist is lost because the  
electric power steering system is not  
functioning, the vehicle can be  
Steering Tips  
It is important to take curves at a  
reasonable speed.  
Traction in a curve depends on the  
condition of the tires and the  
road surface, the angle at which the  
curve is banked, and vehicle  
speed. While in a curve, speed is  
the one factor you can control.  
If the system is limiting wheel spin  
when the button is pressed, the  
system will not turn off until there is  
no longer a current need to limit  
wheel spin. The system can  
be turned back on at any time by  
pressing the button again. If the  
TCS light does not come on,  
steered but it will take more effort.  
If you turn the steering wheel in  
either direction several times until it  
stops, or hold the steering wheel  
in the stopped position for an  
If there is a need to reduce speed,  
do it before entering the curve,  
while the front wheels are straight.  
extended amount of time, you may  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-10  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Try to adjust the speed so you can  
drive through the curve. Maintain  
a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to  
accelerate until out of the curve,  
and then accelerate gently into the  
straightaway.  
collision. Then steer around the  
problem, to the left or right  
depending on the space available.  
The fact that such emergency  
situations are always possible is a  
good reason to practice defensive  
driving at all times and wear  
safety belts properly.  
Off-Road Recovery  
Steering in Emergencies  
The vehicle’s right wheels can drop  
off the edge of a road onto the  
shoulder while driving.  
There are times when steering can  
be more effective than braking. For  
example, you come over a hill and  
find a truck stopped in your lane, or a  
car suddenly pulls out from nowhere,  
or a child darts out from between  
parked cars and stops right in front of  
you. These problems can be avoided  
by braking — if you can stop in time.  
But sometimes you cannot stop in  
time because there is no room.  
That is the time for evasive  
An emergency like this requires  
close attention and a quick decision.  
If holding the steering wheel at  
the recommended 9 and 3 o’clock  
positions, it can be turned a full  
180 degrees very quickly without  
removing either hand. But you have  
to act fast, steer quickly, and just  
as quickly straighten the wheel once  
you have avoided the object.  
action — steering around the  
problem.  
If the level of the shoulder is only  
slightly below the pavement,  
recovery should be fairly easy.  
The vehicle can perform very well  
in emergencies like these. First apply  
the brakes. See Braking on  
page 4-5. It is better to remove  
as much speed as possible from a  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
Skidding  
4-11  
Ease off the accelerator and then, if  
there is nothing in the way, steer so  
that the vehicle straddles the edge  
of the pavement. Turn the steering  
wheel 3 to 5 inches, 8 to 13 cm,  
(about one-eighth turn) until the right  
front tire contacts the pavement  
edge. Then turn the steering wheel  
to go straight down the roadway.  
Do not get too close to the vehicle  
you want to pass. Doing so can  
reduce your visibility.  
In a skid, a driver can lose control  
of the vehicle. Defensive drivers  
avoid most skids by taking  
reasonable care suited to existing  
conditions, and by not overdriving  
those conditions. But skids are  
always possible.  
Wait your turn to pass a slow  
vehicle.  
When you are being passed,  
ease to the right.  
The three types of skids correspond  
to the vehicle’s three control  
Loss of Control  
Passing  
Let us review what driving experts  
say about what happens when  
the three control systems — brakes,  
steering, and acceleration — do  
not have enough friction where the  
tires meet the road to do what  
the driver has asked.  
systems. In the braking skid, the  
wheels are not rolling. In the steering  
or cornering skid, too much speed or  
steering in a curve causes tires to  
slip and lose cornering force. And in  
the acceleration skid, too much  
throttle causes the driving wheels  
to spin.  
Passing another vehicle on a  
two-lane road can be dangerous.  
To reduce the risk of danger  
while passing:  
Look down the road, to the sides,  
and to crossroads for situations  
that might affect a successful  
pass. If in doubt, wait.  
In any emergency, do not give up.  
Keep trying to steer and constantly  
seek an escape route or area of  
less danger.  
Remember: Any traction control  
system helps avoid only the  
acceleration skid. If the traction  
control system is off, then an  
acceleration skid is best handled  
by easing your foot off the  
accelerator pedal.  
Watch for traffic signs, pavement  
markings, and lines that could  
indicate a turn or an intersection.  
Never cross a solid or  
double-solid line on your  
side of the lane.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-12  
Driving Your Vehicle  
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease  
your foot off the accelerator pedal  
and quickly steer the way you want  
the vehicle to go. If you start steering  
quickly enough, the vehicle may  
straighten out. Always be ready for  
a second skid if it occurs.  
vehicle is skidding. Learn to  
recognize warning clues — such as  
enough water, ice, or packed snow  
on the road to make a mirrored  
surface — and slow down when  
you have any doubt.  
Slow down and keep more space  
between you and other vehicles  
because headlamps can only  
light up so much road ahead.  
Watch for animals.  
When tired, pull off the road.  
Do not wear sunglasses.  
Remember: Any Antilock Brake  
System (ABS) helps avoid only  
the braking skid.  
Of course, traction is reduced when  
water, snow, ice, gravel, or other  
material is on the road. For safety,  
slow down and adjust your driving to  
these conditions. It is important to  
slow down on slippery surfaces  
because stopping distance will be  
longer and vehicle control more  
limited.  
Avoid staring directly into  
approaching headlamps.  
Driving at Night  
Keep the windshield and all glass  
on your vehicle clean — inside  
and out.  
Night driving is more dangerous than  
day driving because some drivers  
are likely to be impaired — by alcohol  
or drugs, with night vision problems,  
or by fatigue.  
Keep your eyes moving,  
especially during turns or curves.  
While driving on a surface with  
No one can see as well at night as  
in the daytime. But, as we get  
older, these differences increase.  
A 50-year-old driver might need  
at least twice as much light to see  
the same thing at night as a  
20-year-old.  
Night driving tips include:  
reduced traction, try your best to  
avoid sudden steering, acceleration,  
or braking, including reducing vehicle  
speed by shifting to a lower gear.  
Any sudden changes could cause  
the tires to slide. You may not realize  
the surface is slippery until the  
Drive defensively.  
Do not drink and drive.  
Reduce headlamp glare  
by adjusting the inside  
rearview mirror.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-13  
road is wet enough and you are  
going fast enough. When your  
vehicle is hydroplaning, it has little  
or no contact with the road.  
Driving in Rain and on  
Wet Roads  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Rain and wet roads can reduce  
vehicle traction and affect your  
ability to stop and accelerate.  
Always drive slower in these types  
of driving conditions and avoid  
driving through large puddles and  
deep-standing or flowing water.  
After driving through a large  
puddle of water or a car/vehicle  
wash, lightly apply the brake  
pedal until the brakes work  
normally.  
There is no hard and fast rule about  
hydroplaning. The best advice is  
to slow down when the road is wet.  
Other Rainy Weather Tips  
Flowing or rushing water creates  
strong forces. Driving through  
flowing water could cause your  
vehicle to be carried away. If this  
happens, you and other vehicle  
occupants could drown. Do not  
ignore police warnings and be  
very cautious about trying to drive  
through flowing water.  
Besides slowing down, other wet  
weather driving tips include:  
{ CAUTION  
Allow extra following distance.  
Pass with caution.  
Wet brakes can cause crashes.  
They might not work as well in a  
quick stop and could cause  
pulling to one side. You could  
lose control of the vehicle.  
Keep windshield wiping  
equipment in good shape.  
Keep the windshield washer fluid  
reservoir filled.  
(Continued)  
Hydroplaning  
Have good tires with proper tread  
depth. See Tires on page 5-38.  
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water  
can build up under your vehicle’s  
tires so they actually ride on  
Turn off cruise control.  
the water. This can happen if the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-14  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Before Leaving on a  
Long Trip  
To prepare your vehicle for a long  
trip, consider having it serviced  
by your dealer/retailer before  
departing.  
Highway Hypnosis  
Hill and Mountain Roads  
Always be alert and pay attention to  
your surroundings while driving. If  
you become tired or sleepy, find a  
safe place to park your vehicle  
and rest.  
Driving on steep hills or through  
mountains is different than driving  
on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for  
driving in these conditions include:  
Keep the vehicle serviced  
and in good shape.  
Other driving tips include:  
Things to check on your own  
include:  
Check all fluid levels and brakes,  
tires, cooling system, and  
transmission.  
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.  
Keep interior temperature cool.  
Windshield Washer Fluid:  
Reservoir full? Windows  
clean — inside and outside?  
Keep your eyes moving — scan  
the road ahead and to the sides.  
Going down steep or long hills,  
shift to a lower gear.  
Wiper Blades: In good shape?  
Check the rearview mirror and  
vehicle instruments often.  
Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids: All  
levels checked?  
{ CAUTION  
Lamps: Do they all work and are  
lenses clean?  
If you do not shift down, the  
brakes could get so hot that they  
would not work well. You would  
then have poor braking or even  
none going down a hill. You could  
crash. Shift down to let the engine  
assist the brakes on a steep  
downhill slope.  
Tires: Are treads good? Are tires  
inflated to recommended  
pressure?  
Weather and Maps: Safe to  
travel? Have up-to-date maps?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-15  
Try not to break the fragile traction.  
If you accelerate too fast, the drive  
wheels will spin and polish the  
Pay attention to special road  
signs (falling rocks area, winding  
roads, long grades, passing or  
no-passing zones) and take  
appropriate action.  
{ CAUTION  
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or  
with the ignition off is dangerous.  
The brakes will have to do all the  
work of slowing down and they  
could get so hot that they would  
not work well. You would then  
have poor braking or even none  
going down a hill. You could crash.  
Always have the engine running  
and the vehicle in gear when going  
downhill.  
surface under the tires even more.  
on page 4-6 improves vehicle  
stability during hard stops on  
slippery roads, but apply the brakes  
sooner than when on dry pavement.  
Winter Driving  
Driving on Snow or Ice  
Drive carefully when there is snow  
or ice between the tires and the  
road, creating less traction or grip.  
Wet ice can occur at about 32°F  
(0°C) when freezing rain begins to  
fall, resulting in even less traction.  
Avoid driving on wet ice or in  
freezing rain until roads can be  
treated with salt or sand.  
Allow greater following distance  
on any slippery road and watch for  
slippery spots. Icy patches can  
occur on otherwise clear roads in  
shaded areas. The surface of  
a curve or an overpass can remain  
icy when the surrounding roads  
are clear. Avoid sudden steering  
maneuvers and braking while on ice.  
Stay in your own lane. Do not  
swing wide or cut across the  
center of the road. Drive at  
speeds that let you stay in your  
own lane.  
Drive with caution, whatever the  
condition. Accelerate gently  
so traction is not lost. Accelerating  
too quickly causes the wheels  
to spin and makes the surface under  
the tires slick, so there is even  
less traction.  
Turn off cruise control, if equipped,  
on slippery surfaces.  
Top of hills: Be alert — something  
could be in your lane (stalled car,  
accident).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-16  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Blizzard Conditions  
CAUTION (Continued)  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Being stuck in snow can be a  
serious situation. Stay with the  
vehicle unless there is help nearby.  
If possible, use the Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 7-5.  
To get help and keep everyone  
in the vehicle safe:  
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:  
For more information about  
carbon monoxide, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 2-26.  
Clear away snow from  
around the base of your  
vehicle, especially any that is  
blocking the exhaust pipe.  
Check again from time to  
time to be sure snow does  
not collect there.  
Open a window about two  
inches (5 cm) on the side of  
the vehicle that is away from  
the wind to bring in fresh air.  
Fully open the air outlets on or  
under the instrument panel.  
Adjust the Climate Control  
system to a setting that  
Snow can trap exhaust gases  
under your vehicle. This can cause  
deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas  
to get inside. CO could overcome  
you and kill you. You cannot see it  
or smell it, so you might not know it  
is in your vehicle. Clear away snow  
from around the base of your  
vehicle, especially any that is  
blocking the exhaust.  
Turn on the Hazard Warning  
Flashers on page 3-5.  
Tie a red cloth to an outside  
mirror.  
{ CAUTION  
Snow can trap engine exhaust  
under the vehicle. This may cause  
exhaust gases to get inside.  
Engine exhaust contains carbon  
monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
Run the engine for short periods  
only as needed to keep warm,  
but be careful.  
circulates the air inside the  
vehicle and set the fan speed  
to the highest setting. See  
Climate Control System in  
the Index.  
To save fuel, run the engine for  
only short periods as needed to  
warm the vehicle and then shut the  
engine off and close the window  
most of the way to save heat.  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-17  
Repeat this until help arrives but only  
when you feel really uncomfortable  
from the cold. Moving about to keep  
warm also helps.  
If the vehicle has a traction system, it  
can often help to free a stuck vehicle.  
Refer to the vehicle’s traction system  
in the Index. If stuck too severely for  
the traction system to free the  
vehicle, turn the traction system off  
and use the rocking method.  
Rocking Your Vehicle to  
Get It Out  
Turn the steering wheel left and  
right to clear the area around  
the front wheels. Turn off any  
traction system. Shift back and forth  
between R (Reverse) and a  
forward gear, spinning the wheels  
as little as possible. To prevent  
transmission wear, wait until  
the wheels stop spinning before  
shifting gears. Release the  
accelerator pedal while shifting, and  
press lightly on the accelerator  
pedal when the transmission is in  
gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in  
the forward and reverse directions  
causes a rocking motion that  
could free the vehicle. If that does  
not get the vehicle out after a  
few tries, it might need to be towed  
out. If the vehicle does need to  
be towed out, see Towing Your  
Vehicle on page 4-22.  
If it takes some time for help to  
arrive, now and then when you run  
the engine, push the accelerator  
pedal slightly so the engine runs  
faster than the idle speed. This  
keeps the battery charged to restart  
the vehicle and to signal for help with  
the headlamps. Do this as little as  
possible to save fuel.  
{ CAUTION  
If you let your vehicle’s tires spin at  
high speed, they can explode, and  
you or others could be injured. The  
vehicle can overheat, causing an  
engine compartment fire or other  
damage. Spin the wheels as little  
as possible and avoid going above  
35 mph (55 km/h) as shown on the  
speedometer.  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in  
Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow  
Slowly and cautiously spin the  
wheels to free the vehicle when  
stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow.  
Get It Out on page 4-17.  
For information about using tire  
chains on the vehicle, see Tire  
Chains on page 5-57.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-18  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Tire and Loading Information  
Label  
Loading the Vehicle  
{ CAUTION  
It is very important to know how  
much weight your vehicle can  
carry. This weight is called the  
vehicle capacity weight and  
includes the weight of all  
Do not load the vehicle any  
heavier than the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR), or  
either the maximum front or  
rear Gross Axle Weight Rating  
(GAWR). If you do, parts on  
the vehicle can break, and it  
can change the way your  
vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and  
crash. Also, overloading can  
shorten the life of the vehicle.  
occupants, cargo, and all  
nonfactory-installed options.  
Two labels on your vehicle show  
how much weight it may properly  
carry, the Tire and Loading  
Information label and the  
Certification/Tire label.  
Example Label  
A vehicle specific Tire and  
Loading Information label is  
attached to the center pillar  
(B-pillar) of your vehicle. With the  
driver’s door open, you will find  
the label attached below the door  
lock post (striker). The tire and  
loading information label shows  
the number of occupant seating  
positions (A), and the maximum  
vehicle capacity weight (B) in  
kilograms and pounds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-19  
Steps for Determining Correct  
Load Limit  
The Tire and Loading Information  
label also shows the size of the  
original equipment tires (C) and  
the recommended cold tire  
inflation pressures (D). For more  
information on tires and inflation  
see Tires on page 5-38 and  
page 5-43.  
5. Determine the combined  
weight of luggage and  
cargo being loaded on the  
vehicle. That weight may not  
safely exceed the available  
cargo and luggage load  
1. Locate the statement “The  
combined weight of occupants  
and cargo should never  
exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs” on  
your vehicle’s placard.  
capacity calculated in Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a  
trailer, the load from your  
trailer will be transferred to  
your vehicle. Consult  
2. Determine the combined  
weight of the driver and  
passengers that will be riding  
in your vehicle.  
There is also important loading  
information on the vehicle  
Certification/Tire label. It tells  
you the Gross Vehicle Weight  
Rating (GVWR) and the  
Gross Axle Weight Rating  
(GAWR) for the front and rear  
axle. See “Certification/Tire  
Label” later in this section.  
this manual to determine how  
this reduces the available  
cargo and luggage load  
3. Subtract the combined weight  
of the driver and passengers  
from XXX kg or XXX lbs.  
capacity for your vehicle.  
4. The resulting figure equals  
the available amount of  
cargo and luggage load  
capacity. For example, if  
the “XXX” amount equals  
1400 lbs and there will be  
five 150 lb passengers in  
your vehicle, the amount  
of available cargo and  
luggage load capacity  
is 650 lbs (1400 750  
(5 x 150) = 650 lbs).  
page 4-26 for important  
information on towing a trailer,  
towing safety rules, and  
trailering tips.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-20  
Driving Your Vehicle  
for Example 1 = 1,000 lbs  
(453 kg).  
A
Example 2 = 1,000 lbs  
(453 kg).  
A. Vehicle Capacity Weight for  
Example 3 = 1,000 lbs  
(453 kg).  
B. Subtract Occupant Weight  
150 lbs (68 kg) × 2 = 300 lbs  
(136 kg).  
C. Available Occupant and  
Cargo Weight = 700 lbs  
(317 kg).  
B. Subtract Occupant Weight  
150 lbs (68 kg) × 5 = 750 lbs  
(340 kg).  
B. Subtract Occupant Weight  
200 lbs  
(91 kg) × 5 = 1,000 lbs  
(453 kg).  
C. Available Cargo  
Weight = 250 lbs (113 kg).  
C. Available Cargo  
Weight = 0 lbs (0 kg).  
Refer to your vehicle’s tire and  
loading information label for  
specific information about your  
vehicle’s capacity weight and  
seating positions. The combined  
weight of the driver, passengers,  
and cargo should never exceed  
your vehicle’s capacity weight.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-21  
Certification/Tire Label  
The GVWR includes the weight  
of the vehicle, all occupants,  
fuel, cargo, and trailer tongue  
weight, if the vehicle is pulling a  
trailer.  
Never exceed the GVWR for  
your vehicle or the GAWR  
for either the front or rear axle.  
{ CAUTION  
The Certification/Tire label also  
tells you the maximum  
Do not load the vehicle any  
heavier than the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR), or  
either the maximum front or  
rear Gross Axle Weight Rating  
(GAWR). If you do, parts on  
the vehicle can break, and it  
can change the way your  
vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and  
crash. Also, overloading can  
shorten the life of the vehicle.  
weights for the front and rear  
axles, called the Gross Axle  
Weight Rating (GAWR). To find  
out the actual loads on your  
front and rear axles, you need to  
go to a weigh station and  
weigh your vehicle. Your  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific  
dealer/retailer can help you with  
this. Be sure to spread out  
your load equally on both sides  
of the centerline.  
Certification/Tire label is  
attached to the lower area of  
the center pillar (B-Pillar).  
The label shows the gross  
weight capacity of your vehicle.  
This is called the Gross  
Notice: Overloading your  
vehicle may cause damage.  
Repairs would not be covered  
by your warranty. Do not  
overload your vehicle.  
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-22  
Driving Your Vehicle  
If you put things inside your  
vehicle — like suitcases, tools,  
packages, or anything else, they  
will go as fast as the vehicle  
goes. If you have to stop or turn  
quickly, or if there is a crash,  
they will keep going.  
Towing  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Towing Your Vehicle  
Do not leave an unsecured  
child restraint in your  
vehicle.  
When you carry something  
inside the vehicle, secure it  
whenever you can.  
To avoid damage, the disabled  
vehicle should be towed with all  
four wheels off the ground. Consult  
your dealer/retailer or a professional  
towing service if the disabled  
vehicle must be towed. See  
page 7-5.  
{ CAUTION  
Do not leave a seat folded  
down unless you need to.  
Things you put inside your  
vehicle can strike and injure  
people in a sudden stop or  
turn, or in a crash.  
Put things in the cargo  
area of your vehicle. Try to  
spread the weight evenly.  
Never stack heavier  
things, like suitcases,  
To tow the vehicle behind another  
vehicle for recreational purposes,  
such as behind a motorhome, see  
“Recreational Vehicle Towing”  
following.  
inside the vehicle so that  
some of them are above  
the tops of the seats.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-23  
Is the proper towing equipment  
going to be used? See your  
dealer/retailer or trailering  
professional for additional advice  
and equipment  
Recreational Vehicle  
Towing  
Recreational vehicle towing means  
towing the vehicle behind another  
vehicle – such as behind a  
motorhome. The two most common  
types of recreational vehicle towing  
are known as dinghy towing and  
dolly towing. Dinghy towing is towing  
the vehicle with all four wheels on the  
ground. Dolly towing is towing the  
vehicle with two wheels on the  
ground and two wheels up on a  
device known as a dolly.  
recommendations.  
Is the vehicle ready to be towed?  
Just as preparing the vehicle for  
a long trip, make sure the  
vehicle is prepared to be towed.  
Long Trip on page 4-14.  
To tow the vehicle from the front  
with all four wheels on the ground:  
Dinghy Towing  
1. Position the vehicle that will  
be towed and secure it to  
the towing vehicle.  
This vehicle may be dinghy towed  
from the front. This vehicle may also  
be towed by putting the front  
wheels on a dolly. See “Dolly  
Towing” later in this section.  
Here are some important things to  
consider before recreational  
vehicle towing:  
2. Turn the ignition key to  
ACC/ACCESSORY.  
What is the towing capacity of  
the towing vehicle? Be sure to  
read the tow vehicle  
manufacturer’s  
recommendations.  
For vehicles being dinghy towed,  
the vehicle should be run at the  
beginning of each day and at each  
RV fuel stop for about five minutes.  
This will ensure proper lubrication of  
transmission components.  
What is the distance that will be  
travelled? Some vehicles have  
restrictions on how far and  
how long they can tow.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4-24  
Driving Your Vehicle  
3. Shift the transmission to  
N (Neutral).  
Notice: If the vehicle has a  
four-speed automatic  
Notice: Too much or too  
little fluid can damage the  
transmission. Be sure that the  
transmission fluid is at the proper  
level before towing with all four  
wheels on the ground.  
transmission, it can be dinghy  
towed from the front for unlimited  
miles at 65 mph (105 km/h). The  
vehicle could be damaged If  
65 mph (105 km/h) is exceeded  
while towing the vehicle. The  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Never  
exceed 65 mph (105 km/h) while  
towing the vehicle.  
4. Turn fog lamps and all  
accessories off.  
5. To prevent the battery from  
draining while the vehicle is being  
towed, remove the 2 amp IGN  
SW fuse from the instrument  
panel fuse block and store it in a  
safe location. See Instrument  
Panel Fuse Block on page 5-76  
Notice: Do not tow a vehicle  
with the front drive wheels on the  
ground if one of the front tires  
is a compact spare tire. Towing  
with two different tire sizes on the  
front of the vehicle can cause  
severe damage to the  
Notice: If the vehicle is towed  
without performing each of  
the steps listed under “Dinghy  
Towing,” the automatic  
transmission could be damaged.  
Be sure to follow all steps of  
the dinghy towing procedure prior  
to and after towing the vehicle.  
Once the destination has been  
reached:  
transmission.  
1. Set the parking brake.  
2. Shift the transmission to  
P (Park).  
3. Reinstall the 2 amp IGN SW fuse  
to the instrument panel fuse  
block.  
4. Turn the ignition key to  
LOCK/OFF and remove the key  
from the ignition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-25  
4. Clamp the steering wheel in a  
straight-ahead position with a  
clamping device designed  
for towing.  
Dolly Towing  
(Front-Wheel-Drive Vehicles)  
5. Remove the key from the  
ignition.  
6. Secure the vehicle to the dolly.  
7. Release the parking brake.  
Towing the Vehicle From  
the Rear  
Notice: Towing the vehicle from  
the rear could damage it. Also,  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Never have  
the vehicle towed from the rear.  
To tow the vehicle from the front  
with the rear wheels on the ground,  
do the following:  
1. Put the front wheels on a dolly.  
2. Move the shift lever to P (Park).  
3. Set the parking brake.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-26  
Driving Your Vehicle  
Notice: Pulling a trailer  
The following information has many  
time-tested, important trailering  
tips and safety rules. Many of these  
are important for your safety and  
that of your passengers. So please  
read this section carefully before  
pulling a trailer.  
Towing a Trailer  
improperly can damage the  
vehicle and result in costly  
repairs not covered by the  
vehicle warranty. To pull a trailer  
correctly, follow the advice in  
this section and see your  
dealer/retailer for important  
information about towing a trailer  
with the vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
The driver can lose control when  
pulling a trailer if the correct  
equipment is not used or the  
vehicle is not driven properly. For  
example, if the trailer is too heavy,  
the brakes may not work well — or  
even at all. The driver and  
passengers could be seriously  
injured. The vehicle may also be  
damaged; the resulting repairs  
would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer only  
if all the steps in this section have  
been followed. Ask your dealer/  
retailer for advice and information  
about towing a trailer with the  
vehicle.  
Load-pulling components such as  
the engine, transmission, rear  
axle, wheel assemblies and tires are  
forced to work harder against the  
drag of the added weight. The  
engine is required to operate  
at relatively higher speeds and  
under greater loads, generating  
extra heat. The trailer also  
The vehicle can tow a trailer if it is  
equipped with the proper trailer  
towing equipment.  
To identify the trailering capacity of  
the vehicle, read the information  
in “Weight of the Trailer” that  
appears later in this section.  
adds considerably to wind  
resistance, increasing the pulling  
requirements.  
Trailering is different than just  
driving the vehicle by itself.  
Trailering means changes in  
handling, acceleration, braking,  
durability and fuel economy.  
Successful, safe trailering takes  
correct equipment, and it has to be  
used properly.  
The vehicle has Trailer Sway  
Control (TSC). See “Trailer Sway  
Control (TSC)” in StabiliTrak®  
System on page 4-7 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving Your Vehicle  
Weight of the Trailer  
4-27  
Pulling A Trailer  
Vehicles can tow in D (Drive).  
Shift the transmission to a  
lower gear if the transmission  
shifts too often under heavy loads  
and/or hilly conditions.  
Here are some important points:  
How heavy can a trailer safely be?  
There are many different  
laws, including speed limit  
restrictions, having to do with  
trailering. Make sure the rig will  
be legal, not only where you  
live but also where you will be  
driving. A good source for  
this information can be state or  
provincial police.  
It should never weigh more than  
1,500 lbs (680 kg). But even  
that can be too heavy.  
Obey speed limit restrictions  
when towing a trailer. Do not  
drive faster than the maximum  
posted speed for trailers, or  
no more than 55 mph (90 km/h),  
to save wear on the vehicle’s  
parts.  
It depends on how the rig is used.  
For example, speed, altitude,  
road grades, outside temperature  
and how much the vehicle is used to  
pull a trailer are all important. It  
can depend on any special  
Do not tow a trailer at all during  
the first 500 miles (800 km) the  
new vehicle is driven. The  
engine, axle or other parts could  
be damaged.  
equipment on the vehicle, and the  
amount of tongue weight the vehicle  
can carry. See “Weight of the  
Trailer Tongue” later in this section  
for more information.  
Do not tow a trailer when the  
outside temperature is above  
100°F (38°C).  
Three important considerations have  
to do with weight:  
Then, during the first 500 miles  
(800 km) that a trailer is towed,  
do not drive over 50 mph  
(80 km/h) and do not make starts  
at full throttle. This helps the  
engine and other parts of  
the vehicle wear in at the heavier  
loads.  
Maximum trailer weight is calculated  
assuming only the driver is in the  
tow vehicle and it has all the  
required trailering equipment. The  
weight of additional optional  
equipment, passengers and cargo in  
the tow vehicle must be subtracted  
from the maximum trailer weight.  
The weight of the trailer  
The weight of the trailer tongue  
The total weight on the vehicle’s  
tires  
Ask your dealer/retailer for trailering  
information or advice.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-28  
Driving Your Vehicle  
The effect of additional weight  
may reduce the trailering capacity  
more than the total of the additional  
weight.  
Weight of the Trailer Tongue  
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is  
an important weight to measure  
because it affects the total gross  
weight of the vehicle. The Gross  
Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes the  
curb weight of the vehicle, any  
cargo carried in it, and the people  
who will be riding in the vehicle.  
If there are a lot of options,  
equipment, passengers or cargo in  
the vehicle, it will reduce the  
tongue weight the vehicle can carry,  
which will also reduce the trailer  
weight the vehicle can tow. If towing  
a trailer, the tongue load must be  
added to the GVW because  
Consider the following example:  
A vehicle model base weight  
is 5,500 lbs (2 495 kg); 2,800 lbs  
(1 270 kg) at the front axle and  
2,700 lbs (1 225 kg) at the rear  
axle. It has a GVWR of 7,200 lbs  
(3 266 kg), a RGAWR of 4,000 lbs  
(1 814 kg) and a GCWR (Gross  
Combination Weight Rating)  
of 14,000 lbs (6 350 kg). The  
trailer rating should be:  
For a weight-carrying hitch, the  
trailer tongue (A) should weigh  
10 percent of the total loaded  
trailer weight (B).  
After loading the trailer, weigh the  
trailer and then the tongue,  
separately, to see if the weights are  
proper. If they are not, adjustments  
might be made by moving some  
items around in the trailer.  
the vehicle will be carrying that  
weight, too. See Loading the Vehicle  
on page 4-18 for more information  
about the vehicle’s maximum  
load capacity.  
10 percent of trailer weight (850 lbs  
(386 kg)) and because the weight  
is applied well behind the rear axle,  
the effect on the rear axle is greater  
than just the weight itself, as  
Trailering may be limited by the  
vehicle’s ability to carry tongue  
weight. Tongue weight cannot  
cause the vehicle to exceed the  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight  
Rating) or the RGAWR (Rear  
Gross Axle Weight Rating).  
much as 1.5 times as much.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-29  
The weight at the rear axle could be  
850 lbs (386 kg) X 1.5 = 1,275 lbs  
(578 kg). Since the rear axle already  
weighs 2,700 lbs (1 225 kg), adding  
1,275 lbs (578 kg) brings the total to  
3,975 lbs (1 803 kg). This is very  
close to, but within the limit for  
The maximum trailer would only be  
7,800 lbs (3 538 kg). You may go  
further and think the tongue weight  
should be limited to less than  
Total Weight on the Vehicle’s  
Tires  
Be sure the vehicle’s tires are  
inflated to the upper limit for cold  
tires. These numbers can be found  
on the Certification label or see  
Loading the Vehicle on page 4-18  
for more information. Make sure not  
to go over the GVW limit for the  
vehicle, or the GAWR, including the  
weight of the trailer tongue.  
1,000 lbs (454 kg) to avoid  
exceeding GVWR. But the effect on  
the rear axle must still be considered.  
Because the rear axle now weighs  
3,100 lbs (1 406 kg), 900 lbs  
RGAWR as well. The vehicle is set to  
trailer up to 8,500 lbs (3 856 kg).  
(408 kg) can be put on the rear axle  
without exceeding RGAWR. The  
effect of tongue weight is about  
1.5 times the actual weight. Dividing  
the 900 lbs (408 kg) by 1.5 leaves  
only 600 lbs (272 kg) of tongue  
weight that can be handled. Since  
tongue weight is usually at least  
10 percent of total loaded trailer  
weight, expect that the largest trailer  
the vehicle can properly handle is  
6,000 lbs (2 721 kg).  
If the vehicle has many options and  
there is a front seat passenger  
and two rear seat passengers with  
some luggage and gear in the  
vehicle as well, 300 lbs (136 kg)  
could be added to the front  
axle weight and 400 lbs (181 kg) to  
the rear axle weight. The vehicle  
now weighs:  
Hitches  
It is important to have the correct  
hitch equipment. Crosswinds,  
large trucks going by and rough  
roads are a few reasons why  
the right hitch is needed.  
The rear bumper on the vehicle is  
not intended for hitches. Do not  
attach rental hitches or other  
bumper-type hitches to it. Use  
only a frame-mounted hitch that  
does not attach to the bumper.  
It is important that the vehicle  
does not exceed any of its  
ratings — GCWR, GVWR, RGAWR,  
Maximum Trailer Rating or Tongue  
Weight. The only way to be sure it is  
not exceeding any of these ratings is  
to weigh the vehicle and trailer.  
(3 266 kg) and you might think 700  
additional pounds (318 kg) should  
be subtracted from the trailering  
capacity to stay within GCWR limits.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-30  
Driving Your Vehicle  
manufacturer. Follow the  
Will any holes be made in the  
body of the vehicle when the  
trailer hitch is installed? If so, be  
sure to seal the holes when the  
hitch is removed. If they are not  
sealed, deadly carbon  
monoxide (CO) from the engine’s  
exhaust can get into the vehicle.  
Driving with a Trailer  
manufacturer’s recommendation  
for attaching safety chains and do  
not attach them to the bumper.  
Always leave just enough slack so  
the rig can turn. Never allow safety  
chains to drag on the ground.  
{ CAUTION  
When towing a trailer, exhaust  
gases may collect at the rear of  
the vehicle and enter if the liftgate,  
trunk/hatch, or rear-most window  
is open.  
Trailer Brakes  
page 2-26. Sealing the holes will  
also prevent dirt and water from  
entering the vehicle.  
A loaded trailer that weighs more  
than 1,000 lbs (900 kg) needs  
to have its own brake system that is  
adequate for the weight of the  
trailer. Be sure to read and follow  
the instructions for the trailer brakes  
so they are installed, adjusted  
and maintained properly. Because  
the vehicle has StabiliTrak®, do  
not try to tap into the vehicle’s  
hydraulic brake system. If you do,  
both brake systems will not  
Engine exhaust contains carbon  
monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
Safety Chains  
To maximize safety when towing  
a trailer:  
Have the exhaust system  
inspected for leaks and make  
necessary repairs before  
starting a trip.  
Never drive with the liftgate,  
trunk/hatch, or rear-most  
window open.  
Always attach chains between the  
vehicle and the trailer. Cross the  
safety chains under the tongue of  
the trailer to help prevent the tongue  
from contacting the road if it  
becomes separated from the hitch.  
Instructions about safety chains  
may be provided by the hitch  
work well, or at all.  
manufacturer or by the trailer  
Fully open the air outlets on or  
under the instrument panel.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-31  
If the trailer has electric brakes,  
start the vehicle and trailer moving  
and then apply the trailer brake  
controller by hand to be sure  
the brakes are working. This checks  
the electrical connection at the  
same time.  
Backing Up  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Hold the bottom of the steering  
wheel with one hand. Then, to move  
the trailer to the left, move that  
hand to the left. To move the trailer  
to the right, move your hand to  
the right. Always back up slowly  
and, if possible, have someone  
guide you.  
Adjust the Climate Control  
system to a setting that  
brings in only outside air and  
set the fan speed to the  
highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
During the trip, check occasionally  
to be sure that the load is secure,  
and that the lamps and any  
For more information about  
carbon monoxide, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 2-26.  
Making Turns  
trailer brakes are still working.  
Notice: Making very sharp turns  
while trailering could cause  
Following Distance  
Towing a trailer requires a certain  
amount of experience. Get to know  
the rig before setting out for the open  
road. Get acquainted with the feel of  
handling and braking with the added  
weight of the trailer. And always keep  
in mind that the vehicle you are  
Stay at least twice as far behind  
the vehicle ahead as you would  
when driving the vehicle without  
a trailer. This can help to avoid  
situations that require heavy  
braking and sudden turns.  
the trailer to come in contact with  
the vehicle. The vehicle could  
be damaged. Avoid making very  
sharp turns while trailering.  
When turning with a trailer, make  
wider turns than normal. Do this  
so the trailer will not strike soft  
shoulders, curbs, road signs, trees  
or other objects. Avoid jerky or  
sudden maneuvers. Signal well in  
advance.  
Passing  
driving is now longer and not as  
responsive as the vehicle is by itself.  
More passing distance is needed  
when towing a trailer. Because  
the rig is longer, it is necessary  
to go much farther beyond the  
passed vehicle before returning  
to the lane.  
Before starting, check all trailer  
hitch parts and attachments, safety  
chains, electrical connectors,  
lamps, tires and mirror adjustments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-32  
Driving Your Vehicle  
On a long uphill grade, shift down  
and reduce the vehicle’s speed  
to around 45 mph (70 km/h)  
to reduce the possibility of the  
engine and the transmission  
overheating.  
Turn Signals When Towing a  
Trailer  
Driving on Grades  
Notice: Do not tow on steep  
continuous grades exceeding 6  
miles (9.6 km). Extended,  
higher than normal engine and  
transmission temperatures  
may result and damage the  
vehicle. Frequent stops are very  
important to allow the engine  
and transmission to cool.  
The arrows on the instrument panel  
flash whenever signaling a turn  
or lane change. Properly hooked up,  
the trailer lamps also flash, telling  
other drivers the vehicle is turning,  
changing lanes or stopping.  
When towing at high altitude on  
steep uphill grades, consider  
the following: Engine coolant will  
boil at a lower temperature than at  
normal altitudes. If the engine is  
turned off immediately after towing  
at high altitude on steep uphill  
grades, the vehicle may show signs  
similar to engine overheating. To  
avoid this, let the engine run  
while parked, preferably on level  
ground, with the automatic  
transmission in P (Park) for a few  
minutes before turning the  
engine off. If the overheat warning  
comes on, see Engine Overheating  
on page 5-23.  
When towing a trailer, the arrows on  
the instrument panel flash for  
turns even if the bulbs on the trailer  
are burned out. For this reason  
you may think other drivers  
are seeing the signal when they are  
not. It is important to check  
Vehicles can tow in D (Drive). Shift  
the transmission to a lower gear  
if the transmission shifts too  
often under heavy loads and/or hilly  
conditions. Reduce speed and  
shift to a lower gear before starting  
down a long or steep downgrade.  
If the transmission is not shifted  
down, the brakes might have to be  
used so much that they would  
get hot and no longer work well.  
occasionally to be sure the trailer  
bulbs are still working.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Your Vehicle  
4-33  
3. When the wheel chocks are in  
place, release the regular  
brakes until the chocks absorb  
the load.  
Parking on Hills  
{ CAUTION  
Maintenance When Trailer  
Towing  
The vehicle needs service more  
often when pulling a trailer.  
Parking the vehicle on a hill with  
the trailer attached can be  
4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then  
apply the parking brake and  
shift into P (Park).  
page 6-3 for more information.  
Things that are especially important  
in trailer operation are automatic  
transmission fluid, engine oil,  
axle lubricant, belts, cooling system  
and brake system. It is a good  
idea to inspect these before and  
during the trip.  
dangerous. If something goes  
wrong, the rig could start to move.  
People can be injured, and both  
the vehicle and the trailer can be  
damaged. When possible, always  
park the rig on a flat surface.  
5. Release the brake pedal.  
Leaving After Parking on  
a Hill  
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal  
while you:  
If parking the rig on a hill:  
Check periodically to see that all  
hitch nuts and bolts are tight.  
Start the engine  
1. Press the brake pedal, but do  
not shift into P (Park) yet.  
Turn the wheels into the curb if  
facing downhill or into traffic  
if facing uphill.  
Shift into a gear  
Engine Cooling When Trailer  
Towing  
Release the parking brake  
2. Let up on the brake pedal.  
The cooling system may temporarily  
overheat during severe operating  
conditions. See Engine Overheating  
on page 5-23.  
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is  
clear of the chocks.  
2. Have someone place chocks  
under the trailer wheels.  
4. Stop and have someone pick up  
and store the chocks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-34  
Driving Your Vehicle  
NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-1  
Service and  
Appearance Care  
Headlamp Aiming  
Checking Things Under  
the Hood  
Service  
Bulb Replacement  
Windshield Wiper Blade  
Replacement  
Fuel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-2  
Service and Appearance Care  
Tires  
Vehicle Identification  
Appearance Care  
Electrical System  
Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-3  
Your GM dealer/retailer can  
accessorize the vehicle using  
Accessories and  
Modifications  
Service  
For service and parts needs, visit  
your dealer/retailer. You will receive  
genuine Saturn parts and  
Saturn-trained and supported  
service people.  
genuine GM Accessories. When you  
go to your GM dealer/retailer and  
ask for GM Accessories, you  
will know that GM-trained and  
supported service technicians will  
perform the work using genuine GM  
Accessories.  
When non-dealer/non-retailer  
accessories are added to the vehicle,  
they can affect vehicle performance  
and safety, including such things as  
airbags, braking, stability, ride and  
handling, emissions systems,  
aerodynamics, durability, and  
electronic systems like antilock  
brakes, traction control, and stability  
control. Some of these accessories  
could even cause malfunction or  
damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
Genuine Saturn parts have one of  
these marks.  
page 1-55.  
California Proposition 65  
Warning  
Most motor vehicles, including this  
one, contain and/or emit chemicals  
known to the State of California  
to cause cancer and birth defects or  
other reproductive harm. Engine  
exhaust, many parts and systems  
(including some inside the vehicle),  
many fluids, and some component  
wear by-products contain and/or  
emit these chemicals.  
Damage to vehicle components  
resulting from the installation or use  
of non-GM certified parts, including  
control module modifications, are not  
covered under the terms of the  
vehicle warranty and may affect  
remaining warranty coverage for  
affected parts.  
GM Accessories are designed to  
complement and function with  
other systems on the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-4  
Service and Appearance Care  
This vehicle has an airbag system.  
Before attempting to do your  
own service work, see Servicing  
on page 1-54.  
California Perchlorate  
{ CAUTION  
Materials Requirements  
Certain types of automotive  
applications, such as airbag  
initiators, seat belt pretensioners,  
and lithium batteries contained in  
remote keyless transmitters,  
may contain perchlorate materials.  
Special handling may be necessary.  
For additional information, see  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/  
perchlorate.  
You can be injured and the  
vehicle could be damaged if you  
try to do service work on a vehicle  
without knowing enough about it.  
Be sure you have sufficient  
knowledge, experience, the  
proper replacement parts, and  
tools before attempting any  
vehicle maintenance task.  
Be sure to use the proper  
nuts, bolts, and other  
Keep a record with all parts receipts  
and list the mileage and the date  
of any service work performed. See  
Maintenance Record on page 6-14.  
Adding Equipment to  
the Outside of the  
Vehicle  
Things added to the outside of the  
vehicle can affect the airflow  
around it. This can cause wind  
noise and can affect fuel economy  
and windshield washer performance.  
Check with your dealer/retailer  
before adding equipment to  
Doing Your Own  
Service Work  
fasteners. English and  
metric fasteners can be  
easily confused. If the wrong  
fasteners are used, parts can  
later break or fall off. You  
could be hurt.  
{ CAUTION  
Never try to do your own service  
on hybrid components. You can  
be injured and the vehicle can be  
damaged if you try to do your own  
service work. Service and repair  
of these hybrid components  
should only be performed by a  
trained service technician with the  
proper knowledge and tools.  
If doing some of your own service  
work, use the proper service manual.  
It tells you much more about how to  
service the vehicle than this manual  
can. To order the proper service  
Ordering Information on page 7-13.  
the outside of the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-5  
might fail a smog-check test. See  
Gasoline Specifications  
Fuel  
At a minimum, gasoline should  
meet ASTM specification D 4814 in  
the United States or CAN/CGSB-3.5  
or 3.511 in Canada. Some  
Use of the recommended fuel is an  
important part of the proper  
maintenance of this vehicle. To help  
keep the engine clean and  
page 3-30. If this occurs, return to  
your authorized dealer/retailer for  
diagnosis. If it is determined that the  
condition is caused by the type of  
fuel used, repairs might not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
gasolines contain an  
maintain optimum vehicle  
octane-enhancing additive called  
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese  
tricarbonyl (MMT). We recommend  
against the use of gasolines  
performance, we recommend the  
use of gasoline advertised as  
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.  
Additives  
containing MMT. See Additives on  
page 5-5 for additional information.  
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines  
in the United States are now  
required to contain additives that  
help prevent engine and fuel system  
deposits from forming, allowing  
the emission control system to work  
properly. In most cases, you  
should not have to add anything to  
the fuel. However, some gasolines  
contain only the minimum amount of  
additive required to meet U.S.  
Environmental Protection Agency  
regulations. To help keep fuel  
Gasoline Octane  
Use regular unleaded gasoline with  
a posted octane rating of 87 or  
higher. If the octane rating is less  
than 87, you might notice an audible  
knocking noise when you drive,  
commonly referred to as spark  
knock. If this occurs, use a gasoline  
rated at 87 octane or higher as  
soon as possible. If you are using  
gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher  
and you hear heavy knocking, the  
engine needs service.  
California Fuel  
If the vehicle is certified to meet  
California Emissions Standards, it is  
designed to operate on fuels that  
meet California specifications. See  
the underhood emission control  
label. If this fuel is not available in  
states adopting California emissions  
standards, the vehicle will operate  
satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  
specifications, but emission control  
system performance might be  
injectors and intake valves clean, or  
if the vehicle experiences problems  
due to dirty injectors or valves,  
look for gasoline that is advertised  
as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.  
affected. The malfunction indicator  
lamp could turn on and the vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-6  
Service and Appearance Care  
For customers who do not use TOP  
TIER Detergent Gasoline regularly,  
one bottle of GM Fuel System  
Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel  
tank at every engine oil change,  
can help clean deposits from  
fuel injectors and intake valves. GM  
Fuel System Treatment PLUS is  
the only gasoline additive  
Notice: This vehicle was not  
designed for fuel that contains  
methanol. Do not use fuel  
containing methanol. It can  
corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic  
and rubber parts. That damage  
would not be covered under  
the vehicle warranty.  
Fuels in Foreign  
Countries  
If you plan on driving in another  
country outside the United States or  
Canada, the proper fuel might be  
hard to find. Never use leaded  
gasoline or any other fuel not  
recommended in the previous text  
on fuel. Costly repairs caused  
by use of improper fuel would not  
be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
recommended by General Motors.  
Some gasolines that are not  
reformulated for low emissions  
can contain an octane-enhancing  
additive called  
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese  
tricarbonyl (MMT); ask the  
attendant where you buy gasoline  
whether the fuel contains MMT. We  
recommend against the use of  
such gasolines. Fuels containing  
MMT can reduce the life of  
spark plugs and the performance of  
the emission control system  
could be affected. The malfunction  
indicator lamp might turn on. If  
this occurs, return to your  
Also, your dealer/retailer has  
additives that will help correct and  
prevent most deposit-related  
problems.  
To check the fuel availability, ask  
an auto club, or contact a major oil  
company that does business in  
the country where you will be  
driving.  
Gasolines containing oxygenates,  
such as ethers and ethanol,  
and reformulated gasolines might be  
available in your area. We  
recommend that you use these  
gasolines, if they comply with the  
specifications described earlier.  
However, E85 (85% ethanol) and  
other fuels containing more  
than 10% ethanol must not be used  
in vehicles that were not designed  
for those fuels.  
dealer/retailer for service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-7  
Filling the Tank  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Fuel can spray out on you if you  
open the fuel cap too quickly. If  
you spill fuel and then something  
ignites it, you could be badly  
burned. This spray can happen if  
the tank is nearly full, and is more  
likely in hot weather. Open the  
fuel cap slowly and wait for any  
hiss noise to stop. Then unscrew  
the cap all the way.  
Fuel vapor burns violently and a  
fuel fire can cause bad injuries.  
To help avoid injuries to you and  
others, read and follow all the  
instructions on the pump island.  
Turn off the engine when you are  
refueling. Do not smoke if you are  
near fuel or refueling the vehicle.  
Do not use cellular phones. Keep  
sparks, flames, and smoking  
materials away from fuel. Do not  
leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling the vehicle. This is  
against the law in some places.  
Do not re-enter the vehicle while  
pumping fuel. Keep children away  
from the fuel pump; never let  
children pump fuel.  
Unlock the gas cap door by pressing  
the door lock switch located on  
the driver door trim.  
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not  
top off or overfill the tank and wait a  
few seconds after you have  
finished pumping before removing  
the nozzle. Clean fuel from  
painted surfaces as soon as  
on page 5-69.  
The tethered fuel cap is located  
behind a hinged fuel door on  
the driver side of the vehicle.  
To remove the fuel cap, turn it  
slowly counterclockwise. The fuel  
cap has a spring in it; if the cap  
is released too soon, it will spring  
back to the right. To avoid fuel  
contact on the painted surface of  
the vehicle when filling the fuel tank,  
place the tethered cap on the fuel  
filler door.  
When replacing the fuel cap, turn  
it clockwise until it clicks. Make  
sure the cap is fully installed.  
The diagnostic system can  
determine if the fuel cap has been  
left off or improperly installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-8  
Service and Appearance Care  
This would allow fuel to evaporate  
into the atmosphere. See  
page 3-30.  
Filling a Portable Fuel  
Container  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Bring the fill nozzle in contact  
with the inside of the fill  
opening before operating the  
nozzle. Contact should be  
maintained until the filling is  
complete.  
Do not smoke while  
pumping fuel.  
Do not use a cellular phone  
while pumping fuel.  
{ CAUTION  
Never fill a portable fuel container  
while it is in the vehicle. Static  
electricity discharge from the  
container can ignite the fuel vapor.  
You can be badly burned and the  
vehicle damaged if this occurs. To  
help avoid injury to you and others:  
Dispense fuel only into  
approved containers.  
{ CAUTION  
If a fire starts while you are  
refueling, do not remove the  
nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by  
shutting off the pump or by  
notifying the station attendant.  
Leave the area immediately.  
Notice: If you need a new fuel  
cap, be sure to get the right type.  
Your dealer/ retailer can get one  
for you. If you get the wrong type,  
it might not fit properly. This can  
cause the malfunction indicator  
lamp to light and can damage the  
fuel tank and emissions system.  
on page 3-30.  
Do not fill a container while  
it is inside a vehicle, in a  
vehicle’s trunk, pickup bed,  
or on any surface other than  
the ground.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-9  
Hood Release  
To open the hood, do the following:  
Checking Things  
Under the Hood  
{ CAUTION  
An electric fan under the hood can  
start up and injure you even when  
the engine is not running. Keep  
hands, clothing, and tools away  
from any underhood electric fan.  
1. Pull the handle with this symbol  
on it. It is located under the  
instrument panel on the driver  
side of the vehicle.  
2. Then go to the front of the  
vehicle and lift up on the  
{ CAUTION  
secondary hood release lever.  
Things that burn can get on hot  
engine parts and start a fire.  
These include liquids like fuel, oil,  
coolant, brake fluid, windshield  
washer and other fluids, and  
plastic or rubber. You or others  
could be burned. Be careful not to  
drop or spill things that will burn  
onto a hot engine.  
3. Lift the hood.  
Before closing the hood, be sure  
all the filler caps are on properly.  
Then pull the hood down and close  
it firmly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-10  
Service and Appearance Care  
Engine Compartment Overview  
When you open the hood, you will see the following:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-11  
H. Windshield Washer Fluid  
Reservoir. See Windshield  
Washer Fluid on page 5-24.  
The engine oil dipstick handle is a  
yellow loop. See Engine  
page 5-10 for the location of the  
engine oil dipstick.  
page 5-15.  
B. Remote Negative () Terminal.  
See Jump Starting on page 5-28.  
I. Engine Oil Dipstick (out of view).  
See Engine Oil on page 5-11.  
C. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See Engine  
1. Turn off the engine and give the  
oil several minutes to drain back  
into the oil pan. If this is not  
done, the oil dipstick might not  
show the actual level.  
Oil on page 5-11.  
D. Engine Coolant Surge Tank. See  
Engine Oil  
Cooling System on page 5-17.  
Checking Engine Oil  
E. Engine Coolant Surge Tank  
Protection Cap. See Coolant  
on page 5-22.  
It is a good idea to check the  
engine oil level at each fuel fill. In  
order to get an accurate reading, the  
oil must be warm and the vehicle  
must be on level ground.  
2. Pull the dipstick and clean it with  
a paper towel or cloth, then push  
it back in all the way. Remove  
it again, keeping the tip down and  
check the level.  
page 5-77.  
G. Remote Positive (+) Terminal.  
See Jump Starting on page 5-28.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-12  
Service and Appearance Care  
Notice: Do not add too much oil.  
If the engine has so much oil  
that the oil level gets above the  
upper mark that shows the proper  
operating range, the engine  
could be damaged.  
When to Add Engine Oil  
What Kind of Engine Oil to Use  
Look for three things:  
If the oil is below the MIN (minimum)  
mark, add at least one quart/liter  
of the recommended oil. This  
section explains what kind of oil to  
use. For engine oil crankcase  
capacity, see Capacities and  
Specifications on page 5-81.  
on page 5-10 for the location of  
the engine oil fill cap.  
Add enough oil to put the level  
somewhere in the proper operating  
range. Push the dipstick all the  
way back in when through.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-13  
Notice: Use only engine oil  
identified as meeting GM  
GM6094M  
Engine Oil Additives / Engine  
Oil Flushes  
Use only an oil that meets GM  
Standard GM6094M.  
Standard GM6094M and showing  
the American Petroleum  
Institute Certified For Gasoline  
Engines starburst symbol. Failure  
to use the recommended oil  
can result in engine damage not  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Do not add anything to the oil.  
The recommended oils with  
the starburst symbol that meet  
GM Standard GM6094M are all that  
is needed for good performance  
and engine protection.  
SAE 5W-30  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the  
vehicle. These numbers on an oil  
container show its viscosity, or  
thickness. Do not use other  
viscosity oils such as  
Engine oil system flushes are not  
recommended and could cause  
engine damage not covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
Cold Temperature Operation  
SAE 20W-50.  
If in an area of extreme cold, where  
the temperature falls below 20°F  
(29°C), use either an SAE 5W-30  
synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30  
engine oil. Both provide easier cold  
starting for the engine at extremely  
low temperatures. Always use  
an oil that meets the required  
specification, GM6094M. See “What  
Kind of Engine Oil to Use” for  
more information.  
American Petroleum Institute  
(API) starburst symbol  
Oils meeting these requirements  
should have the starburst  
symbol on the container. This  
symbol indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-14  
Service and Appearance Care  
600 miles (1 000 km). It is possible  
that, if driving under the best  
How to Reset the Engine Oil  
Life System  
Engine Oil Life System  
When to Change Engine Oil  
conditions, the oil life system might  
not indicate that an oil change is  
necessary for over a year. However,  
the engine oil and filter must be  
changed at least once a year and at  
this time the system must be reset.  
Your dealer/retailer has trained  
service people who will perform this  
work using genuine parts and reset  
the system. It is also important to  
check the oil regularly and keep it at  
the proper level.  
The Engine Oil Life System  
This vehicle has a computer system  
that indicates when to change the  
engine oil and filter. This is based on  
engine revolutions and engine  
temperature, and not on mileage.  
Based on driving conditions,  
the mileage at which an oil change  
is indicated can vary considerably.  
For the oil life system to work  
calculates when to change the  
engine oil and filter based on vehicle  
use. Whenever the oil is changed,  
reset the system so it can calculate  
when the next oil change is  
required. If a situation occurs where  
the oil is changed prior to a  
change engine oil light being turned  
on, reset the system.  
properly, the system must be reset  
every time the oil is changed.  
After changing the engine oil, reset  
the system:  
If the system is ever reset  
When the system has calculated that  
oil life has been diminished, it  
indicates that an oil change is  
necessary. A change engine oil light  
comes on. See Change Engine Oil  
Light on page 3-33. Change the oil  
as soon as possible within the next  
accidentally, the oil must be changed  
at 3,000 miles (5 000 km) since the  
last oil change. Remember to reset  
the oil life system whenever the oil is  
changed.  
1. Turn the ignition key to ON/RUN  
with the engine off.  
2. Fully press and release the  
accelerator pedal three times  
within five seconds.  
If the change engine oil light is  
not on, the system is reset.  
If the light comes on again and  
stays on for 30 seconds at the next  
ignition cycle, it did not reset.  
The system needs to be reset again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-15  
Used oil can be a threat to the  
What to Do with Used Oil  
When to Inspect the Engine  
Air Cleaner/Filter  
environment. If you change your own  
oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the  
filter before disposal. Never dispose  
of oil by putting it in the trash, pouring  
it on the ground, into sewers, or into  
streams or bodies of water. Recycle  
it by taking it to a place that collects  
used oil.  
Used engine oil contains certain  
elements that can be unhealthy for  
your skin and could even cause  
cancer. Do not let used oil stay on  
your skin for very long. Clean  
your skin and nails with soap and  
water, or a good hand cleaner.  
Wash or properly dispose of clothing  
or rags containing used engine  
oil. See the manufacturer’s warnings  
about the use and disposal of oil  
products.  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the  
Maintenance II intervals and replace  
it at the first oil change after each  
50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval.  
on page 6-3 for more information.  
If you are driving in dusty/dirty  
conditions, inspect the filter at each  
engine oil change.  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
Overview on page 5-10 for the  
location of the engine air  
cleaner/filter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-16  
Service and Appearance Care  
3. Remove the four bolts on the  
side of the air cleaner assembly.  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
{ CAUTION  
4. Turn the cover upward to  
disengage the cover hinges.  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter  
remove the filter from the vehicle  
and lightly shake the filter to release  
loose dust and dirt. If the filter  
remains caked with dirt, a new filter  
is required.  
Operating the engine with the air  
cleaner/filter off can cause you or  
others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it  
helps to stop flames if the engine  
backfires. If it is not there and the  
engine backfires, you could be  
burned. Do not drive with it off, and  
be careful working on the engine  
with the air cleaner/filter off.  
5. Remove the air cleaner cover  
assembly and air filter element.  
6. Inspect or replace the air filter  
element.  
To inspect or replace the engine air  
cleaner/filter, do the following:  
If the air filter element is dirty,  
you should replace it. If it is only  
dusty, it may be cleaned by  
blowing compressed air through  
it from the clean side.  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is  
off, a backfire can cause a  
damaging engine fire. And, dirt  
can easily get into the engine,  
which will damage it. Always have  
the air cleaner/filter in place  
when you are driving.  
Make sure you are away from  
the engine compartment  
when cleaning the air filter with  
compressed air.  
Wipe all dust from inside of the  
housing and inspect the air  
cleaner and air outlet duct for  
cracks, cuts and deterioration.  
The air outlet duct must be  
replaced if damaged.  
1. Remove the clamp on the air  
duct hose.  
7. Reverse Steps 1 through 5 to  
reinstall the engine air cleaner/  
filter cover and air duct hose.  
2. Disconnect the hose.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-17  
Automatic Transmission  
Fluid  
Cooling System  
When you decide it is safe to lift the  
hood, here is what you will see:  
{ CAUTION  
An electric engine cooling fan  
It is not necessary to check the  
transmission fluid level. A transaxle  
fluid leak is the only reason for  
fluid loss. If a leak occurs, take the  
vehicle to your dealer/retailer  
service department and have it  
repaired as soon as possible.  
under the hood can start up even  
when the engine is not running  
and can cause injury. Keep  
hands, clothing, and tools away  
from any underhood electric fan.  
If the coolant inside the coolant  
surge tank is boiling, do not  
do anything else until it cools down.  
The vehicle should be parked on  
a level surface.  
Change the fluid and filter at the  
intervals listed in Additional  
Required Services on page 6-5, and  
be sure to use the transaxle fluid  
and Lubricants on page 6-11.  
The coolant level should be between  
the MIN and MAX lines. If it is  
not, you may have a leak at the  
radiator hoses, heater hoses,  
radiator, water pump, or somewhere  
else in the cooling system.  
A. Coolant Surge Tank  
B. Pressure Cap  
Notice: Use of the incorrect  
automatic transaxle fluid may  
damage your vehicle, and  
the damages may not be covered  
by your warranty. Always use  
the automatic transaxle fluid  
and Lubricants on page 6-11.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-18  
Service and Appearance Care  
Notice: Using coolant other than  
drinkable water and DEX-COOL®  
coolant at the coolant surge  
tank, but be sure the cooling system,  
including the coolant surge tank  
pressure cap, is cool before you do  
it. See Engine Coolant on  
DEX-COOL® can cause premature  
engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine  
coolant could require changing  
sooner, at 30,000 miles  
{ CAUTION  
Heater and radiator hoses, and  
other engine parts, can be very  
hot. Do not touch them. If you do,  
you can be burned.  
(50 000 km) or 24 months,  
page 5-20 for more information.  
whichever occurs first. Any  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Always  
use DEX-COOL® (silicate-free)  
coolant in the vehicle.  
Do not run the engine if there is a  
leak. If you run the engine, it  
could lose all coolant. That could  
cause an engine fire, and you  
could be burned. Get any leak  
fixed before you drive the vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
Steam and scalding liquids from a  
hot cooling system can blow out  
and burn you badly. They are  
under pressure, and if you turn  
the coolant surge tank pressure  
cap — even a little — they can  
come out at high speed. Never  
turn the cap when the cooling  
system, including the coolant  
surge tank pressure cap, is hot.  
Wait for the cooling system and  
coolant surge tank pressure cap  
to cool if you ever have to turn  
the pressure cap.  
How to Add Coolant to the  
Coolant Surge Tank  
If there seems to be no leak, with  
the engine on, check to see if  
the electric engine cooling fan is  
running. If the engine is overheating,  
the fan should be running. If it is  
not, your vehicle needs service.  
Turn off the engine.  
Notice: This vehicle has a  
specific coolant fill procedure.  
Failure to follow this procedure  
could cause the engine to  
overheat and be severely  
damaged.  
If you have not found a problem yet,  
check to see if coolant is visible  
in the surge tank. If coolant is visible  
but the coolant level is not at  
between the MIN and MAX lines,  
add a 50/50 mixture of clean,  
Notice: Engine damage from  
running the engine without  
coolant is not covered by the  
warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-19  
Notice: In cold weather, water  
{ CAUTION  
can freeze and crack the engine,  
radiator, heater core and other  
parts. Use the recommended  
coolant and the proper coolant  
mixture.  
Adding only plain water to the  
cooling system can be dangerous.  
Plain water, or some other liquid  
such as alcohol, can boil before  
the proper coolant mixture will.  
The vehicle’s coolant warning  
system is set for the proper  
coolant mixture. With plain water  
or the wrong mixture, the engine  
could get too hot but you would  
not get the overheat warning. The  
engine could catch fire and you or  
others could be burned. Use a  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
water and DEX-COOL® coolant.  
1. You can remove the coolant  
{ CAUTION  
surge tank pressure cap  
when the cooling system,  
including the coolant surge tank  
pressure cap and upper  
You can be burned if you spill  
coolant on hot engine parts.  
Coolant contains ethylene glycol  
and it will burn if the engine parts  
are hot enough. Do not spill  
coolant on a hot engine.  
radiator hose, is no longer hot.  
Turn the pressure cap slowly  
counterclockwise about  
one-quarter of a turn. If you hear  
a hiss, wait for that to stop.  
This will allow any pressure still  
left to be vented out the  
discharge hose.  
2. Then keep turning the pressure  
cap slowly, and remove it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-20  
Service and Appearance Care  
By this time, the coolant level  
inside the coolant surge  
Engine Coolant  
The cooling system in your vehicle  
is filled with DEX-COOL® engine  
coolant. This coolant is designed to  
remain in your vehicle for five years  
or 150,000 miles (240 000 km),  
whichever occurs first, if you add  
only DEX-COOL® extended life  
coolant.  
tank may be lower. If the level is  
lower, add more of the proper  
DEX-COOL® coolant mixture to  
the coolant surge tank until  
the level reaches between the  
MIN and MAX lines.  
5. Then replace the pressure cap.  
Be sure the pressure cap is  
hand-tight.  
The following explains your cooling  
system and how to add coolant  
when it is low. If you have a problem  
with engine overheating, see  
Check the level in the surge  
tank when the cooling system  
has cooled down. If the coolant  
is not at the proper level, repeat  
Steps 1 through 3 and reinstall the  
pressure cap. If the coolant still  
is not at the proper level when the  
system cools down again, see  
your dealer/retailer.  
3. Fill the coolant surge tank with  
the proper DEX-COOL® coolant  
mixture, to between the MIN  
and MAX lines.  
Engine Overheating on page 5-23.  
A 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
water and DEX-COOL® coolant will:  
4. With the coolant surge tank  
pressure cap off, start the engine  
and let it run until you can feel  
the upper radiator hose  
Give freezing protection down  
to 34°F (37°C).  
Give boiling protection up to  
265°F (129°C).  
getting hot. Watch out for the  
engine cooling fan.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-21  
Notice: If an improper coolant  
mixture is used, the engine could  
overheat and be badly damaged.  
The repair cost would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Too much water in the mixture  
can freeze and crack the engine,  
radiator, heater core, and  
Protect against rust and  
corrosion.  
What to Use  
Use a mixture of one-half clean,  
drinkable water and one-half  
Help keep the proper engine  
temperature.  
DEX-COOL® coolant which will not  
damage aluminum parts. If you  
use this coolant mixture, you do not  
need to add anything else.  
Let the warning lights and gages  
work as they should.  
Notice: Using coolant other than  
DEX-COOL® can cause premature  
engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine  
coolant may require changing  
sooner, at the first maintenance  
service after each 30,000 miles  
(50 000 km) or 24 months,  
whichever occurs first. Any  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Always  
use DEX-COOL® (silicate-free)  
coolant in the vehicle.  
other parts.  
{ CAUTION  
If you have to add coolant more  
than four times a year, have  
your dealer/retailer check your  
cooling system.  
Adding only plain water to the  
cooling system can be dangerous.  
Plain water, or some other liquid  
such as alcohol, can boil before  
the proper coolant mixture will.  
The vehicle’s coolant warning  
system is set for the proper  
coolant mixture. With plain water  
or the wrong mixture, the engine  
could get too hot but you would  
not get the overheat warning. The  
engine could catch fire and you or  
others could be burned. Use a  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
water and DEX-COOL® coolant.  
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or  
additives are used in the  
vehicle’s cooling system, the  
vehicle could be damaged. Use  
only the proper mixture of  
the engine coolant listed in this  
manual for the cooling system.  
and Lubricants on page 6-11 for  
more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-22  
Service and Appearance Care  
Checking Coolant  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Turning the surge tank pressure  
cap when the engine and radiator  
are hot can allow steam and  
scalding liquids to blow out and  
burn you badly. Never turn the  
surge tank pressure cap — even  
a little — when the engine and  
radiator are hot.  
You can be burned if you spill  
coolant on hot engine parts.  
Coolant contains ethylene glycol,  
and it will burn if the engine parts  
are hot enough. Do not spill  
coolant on a hot engine.  
When replacing the pressure cap,  
make sure it is hand-tight and  
fully seated.  
The vehicle must be on a level  
surface. When your engine is cold,  
the coolant level should be  
Coolant Surge Tank  
Pressure Cap  
The surge tank is located on  
the driver side of the engine  
compartment. See Engine  
page 5-10 for more information  
on location.  
between the MIN and MAX lines.  
Adding Coolant  
Notice: If the pressure cap is not  
tightly installed, coolant loss  
and possible engine damage may  
occur. Be sure the cap is  
If you need more coolant, add the  
proper DEX-COOL® coolant mixture  
at the surge tank, but only when  
the engine is cool. See Cooling  
System on page 5-17 for instructions  
on “How to Add Coolant to the  
Coolant Surge Tank”.  
properly and tightly secured.  
If you need to replace your coolant  
surge tank pressure cap, see  
your retailer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-23  
If No Steam Is Coming From  
Your Engine  
Engine Overheating  
CAUTION (Continued)  
There is a coolant temperature  
warning light on your vehicle’s  
instrument panel. See Engine  
on page 3-29.  
If you get an engine overheat  
warning, but see or hear no steam,  
the problem may not be too serious.  
Sometimes the engine can get a little  
too hot when you:  
If you keep driving when your  
engine is overheated, the liquids  
in it can catch fire. You or others  
could be badly burned. Stop your  
engine if it overheats, and get  
out of the vehicle until the engine  
is cool.  
If Steam Is Coming From Your  
Engine  
Climb a long hill on a hot day.  
Stop after high-speed driving.  
Idle for long periods in traffic.  
Tow a trailer.  
{ CAUTION  
Notice: If the engine catches fire  
because of being driven with  
no coolant, your vehicle can be  
badly damaged. The costly  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty.  
Steam from an overheated engine  
can burn you badly, even if you  
just open the hood. Stay away  
from the engine if you see or hear  
steam coming from it. Just turn it  
off and get everyone away from  
the vehicle until it cools down.  
Wait until there is no sign of  
steam or coolant before you  
open the hood.  
If you get the overheat warning with  
no sign of steam, try this for a  
minute or so:  
1. If you have an air conditioner  
and it is on, turn it off.  
2. Turn on your heater to full hot at  
the highest fan speed and open  
the windows as necessary.  
3. Try to minimize engine load.  
If you are in a traffic jam,  
shift to N (Neutral); otherwise,  
shift to the highest gear possible  
while driving.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-24  
Service and Appearance Care  
If you no longer have the overheat  
warning, you can drive. Just to  
be safe, drive slower for about  
ten minutes. If the warning does  
not come back on, you can drive  
normally.  
Notice:  
Windshield Washer Fluid  
When using concentrated  
What to Use  
washer fluid, follow the  
manufacturer’s instructions  
for adding water.  
When you need windshield or rear  
window washer fluid, be sure to  
read the manufacturer’s instructions  
before use. If you will be operating  
your vehicle in an area where  
the temperature may fall below  
freezing, use a fluid that has  
Do not mix water with  
If the warning continues and you  
have not stopped, pull over, stop,  
and park your vehicle right away.  
ready-to-use washer fluid.  
Water can cause the solution  
to freeze and damage your  
washer fluid tank and other  
parts of the washer system.  
Also, water does not clean as  
well as washer fluid.  
If there is still no sign of steam, idle  
the engine for three minutes  
while you are parked. If the warning  
continues, turn off the engine and  
get everyone out of the vehicle until  
it cools down.  
sufficient protection against freezing.  
Adding Windshield Washer  
Fluid  
Fill the washer fluid tank only  
three-quarters full when it is  
very cold. This allows for fluid  
expansion if freezing occurs,  
which could damage the tank if  
it is completely full.  
You may decide not to lift the hood  
but to get service help right away.  
Do not use engine coolant  
(antifreeze) in your windshield  
washer. It can damage the  
vehicle’s windshield washer  
system and paint.  
Open the cap with the washer  
symbol on it. Add washer fluid until  
the tank is full. See Engine  
page 5-10 for reservoir location.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-25  
When the brake fluid falls to a low  
level, the brake warning light comes  
Light on page 3-27.  
A fluid leak in the brake hydraulic  
system can also cause a low fluid  
level. Have the brake hydraulic  
system fixed, since a leak means  
that sooner or later the brakes will  
not work well.  
Brakes  
Brake Fluid  
What to Add  
If the vehicle has DOT-3 brake fluid,  
as indicated on the reservoir cap,  
use only new DOT-3 brake fluid from  
a sealed container. See  
Lubricants on page 6-11.  
Do not top off the brake fluid. Adding  
fluid does not correct a leak. If fluid is  
added when the linings are worn,  
there will be too much fluid when new  
brake linings are installed. Add or  
remove brake fluid, as necessary,  
only when work is done on the brake  
hydraulic system.  
The brake eservoir  
is filled with either DOT-3 or DOT-4  
brake fluid as indicated on the  
reservoir cap. See Engine  
page 5-10 for the location of the  
reservoir.  
If the vehicle has DOT-4 brake fluid,  
as indicated on the reservoir cap,  
use only new DOT-4 brake fluid from  
a sealed container. See  
There are only two reasons why the  
brake fluid level in the reservoir  
might go down:  
{ CAUTION  
Lubricants on page 6-11. DOT-4  
brake fluid requires the brake  
hydraulic system to be flushed and  
refilled with new DOT-4 brake  
fluid at a regular maintenance  
service every two years. See  
page 6-5.  
If too much brake fluid is added, it  
can spill on the engine and burn,  
if the engine is hot enough. You  
or others could be burned, and  
the vehicle could be damaged.  
Add brake fluid only when work is  
done on the brake hydraulic  
system.  
The brake fluid level goes down  
because of normal brake lining  
wear. When new linings are  
installed, the fluid level goes  
back up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-26  
Service and Appearance Care  
Always clean the brake fluid  
reservoir cap and the area around  
the cap before removing it. This  
helps keep dirt from entering  
the reservoir.  
Notice: Continuing to drive with  
worn-out brake pads could  
result in costly brake repair.  
If brake fluid is spilled on the  
vehicle’s painted surfaces,  
the paint finish can be  
damaged. Be careful not to  
spill brake fluid on the vehicle.  
If you do, wash it off  
Some driving conditions or climates  
can cause a brake squeal when  
the brakes are first applied or lightly  
applied. This does not mean  
immediately. See Washing  
Your Vehicle on page 5-69.  
{ CAUTION  
something is wrong with the brakes.  
With the wrong kind of fluid in the  
brake hydraulic system, the  
brakes might not work well. This  
could cause a crash. Always use  
the proper brake fluid.  
Properly torqued wheel nuts are  
necessary to help prevent  
Brake Wear  
This vehicle has disc brakes. Disc  
brake pads have built-in wear  
indicators that make a high-pitched  
warning sound when the brake  
pads are worn and new pads are  
needed. The sound can come  
and go or be heard all the time the  
vehicle is moving, except when  
applying the brake pedal firmly.  
brake pulsation. When tires are  
rotated, inspect brake pads for wear  
and evenly tighten wheel nuts in  
the proper sequence to torque  
specifications in Capacities and  
Specifications on page 5-81.  
Notice:  
Using the wrong fluid can  
badly damage brake hydraulic  
system parts. For example,  
just a few drops of  
mineral-based oil, such as  
engine oil, in the brake  
hydraulic system can damage  
brake hydraulic system  
parts so badly that they will  
have to be replaced. Do not let  
someone put in the wrong  
kind of fluid.  
Brake linings should always be  
replaced as complete axle sets.  
Brake Pedal Travel  
{ CAUTION  
See your dealer/retailer if the brake  
pedal does not return to normal  
height, or if there is a rapid increase  
in pedal travel. This could be a  
sign that brake service might  
be required.  
The brake wear warning sound  
means that soon the brakes will  
not work well. That could lead to  
an accident. When the brake wear  
warning sound is heard, have the  
vehicle serviced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-27  
rear brakes can change — for the  
This vehicle has a standard 12-volt  
battery and a 36-volt hybrid  
battery system.  
Brake Adjustment  
worse. The braking performance  
expected can change in many other  
ways if the wrong replacement  
brake parts are installed.  
Every time the brakes are applied,  
with or without the vehicle  
moving, the brakes adjust for wear.  
12-Volt Battery  
Replacing Brake System  
Parts  
When a new standard 12-volt  
battery is needed, see your  
dealer/retailer for one that has the  
replacement number shown on  
the original battery’s label.  
Battery  
The braking system on a vehicle is  
complex. Its many parts have to  
be of top quality and work well  
together if the vehicle is to have  
really good braking. The vehicle was  
designed and tested with top-quality  
brake parts. When parts of the  
braking system are replaced — for  
example, when the brake linings  
wear down and new ones are  
installed — be sure to get new  
approved replacement parts. If  
this is not done, the brakes might  
not work properly. For example,  
if someone puts in brake linings  
that are wrong for the vehicle, the  
balance between the front and  
{ CAUTION  
Batteries have acid that can burn  
you and gas that can explode.  
You can be badly hurt if you are  
not careful. See Jump Starting  
on page 5-28 for tips on working  
around a battery without  
36-Volt Battery System  
If a new 36-volt hybrid battery  
system is needed, see your  
dealer/retailer.  
Vehicle Storage  
getting hurt.  
Infrequent Usage: If the vehicle is  
driven infrequently, remove the  
12-volt battery black, negative ()  
cable from the battery, the one that  
is exposed. This helps keep the  
battery from running down.  
Warning: Battery posts, terminals,  
and related accessories contain  
lead and lead compounds,  
chemicals known to the State of  
California to cause cancer and  
reproductive harm. Wash hands  
after handling.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-28  
Service and Appearance Care  
Extended Storage: For extended  
storage of the vehicle, remove the  
12-volt battery black, negative ()  
cable from the battery or use a  
battery trickle charger. This helps  
maintain the charge of the battery  
over an extended period of time.  
The 36-volt battery is located behind  
the rear seat, under the cargo  
floor. If the vehicle is stored for an  
extended period of time, drive  
the vehicle every two months for  
about half an hour to keep the  
36-volt hybrid battery charged and  
in good working condition.  
If your vehicle’s standard 12-volt  
battery has run down, you may want  
to use another vehicle and some  
jumper cables to start your vehicle.  
Be sure to use the following  
steps to do it safely.  
Remember to reconnect the battery  
when ready to drive the vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
Jump Starting  
Batteries can hurt you. They can  
be dangerous because:  
They contain acid that can  
burn you.  
They contain gas that can  
explode or ignite.  
Notice: The 36-volt hybrid  
battery system should be  
serviced only by a qualified  
facility to avoid battery system  
damage. See your dealer/retailer if  
service is needed.  
The hybrid vehicle has a standard  
12-volt battery in the engine  
compartment, and a 36-volt battery  
under the rear load floor.  
They contain enough  
electricity to burn you.  
{ CAUTION  
Notice: If the vehicle is not  
driven for over two months, the  
36-volt hybrid battery can be  
permanently damaged.  
Personal injury or damage to the  
vehicle can result if you try jump  
starting or using a battery charger  
on the 36-volt battery. Use only  
the 12-volt battery for jump  
If you do not follow these steps  
exactly, some or all of these  
things can hurt you.  
starting and charging.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-29  
Notice: Ignoring these steps  
could result in costly damage to  
the vehicle that would not be  
covered by the warranty.  
To avoid the possibility of the  
vehicles rolling, set the parking  
brake firmly on both vehicles  
involved in the jump start  
procedure. Put an automatic  
transmission in P (Park) or  
a manual transmission in  
N (Neutral) before setting the  
parking brake.  
4. Open each vehicle’s hood and  
locate the positive (+) and  
negative () terminal locations of  
the other vehicle. Your vehicle  
has a remote positive (+) 12-volt  
jump starting terminal (B) and  
a remote negative () jump  
starting terminal (A). You should  
always use these remote  
terminals instead of the terminals  
on the battery. The remote  
positive (+) terminal is located  
inside the junction box located  
above the engine cover. To  
access the remote positive (+)  
terminal, unlatch the box cover.  
Trying to start the vehicle by  
pushing or pulling it will not work,  
and it could damage the vehicle.  
1. Check the other vehicle. It  
must have a 12-volt battery with  
a negative ground system.  
Notice: If you leave the radio or  
other accessories on during  
the jump starting procedure, they  
could be damaged. The repairs  
would not be covered by the  
warranty. Always turn off  
Notice: If the other vehicle’s  
system is not a 12-volt system  
with a negative ground, both  
vehicles can be damaged. Only  
use vehicles with 12-volt systems  
with negative grounds to jump  
start your vehicle.  
the radio and other accessories  
when jump starting the vehicle.  
3. Turn off the ignition on both  
vehicles. Unplug unnecessary  
accessories plugged into the  
cigarette lighter or the accessory  
power outlet. Turn off the radio  
and all lamps that are not needed.  
This will avoid sparks and help  
save both batteries. And it could  
save the radio!  
2. Get the vehicles close enough so  
the jumper cables can reach, but  
be sure the vehicles are not  
touching each other. If they are, it  
could cause a ground connection  
you do not want. You would not  
be able to start your vehicle, and  
the bad grounding could damage  
the electrical systems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-30  
Service and Appearance Care  
A. Remote Negative (-)  
B. Remote Positive (+)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-31  
5. The remote negative () terminal  
is a stud on the driver side near  
the underhood fuse block.  
6. Check that the jumper cables  
do not have loose or missing  
insulation. If they do, you could  
get a shock. The vehicles could  
be damaged too. Before you  
connect the cables to the other  
vehicle, here are some basic  
things you should know.  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Battery fluid contains acid that  
can burn you. Do not get it on  
you. If you accidentally get it in  
your eyes or on your skin, flush  
the place with water and get  
medical help immediately.  
{ CAUTION  
Using a match near a battery can  
cause battery gas to explode.  
People have been hurt doing this,  
and some have been blinded. Use  
a flashlight if you need more light.  
Positive (+) will go to positive (+)  
or to a remote positive  
terminal (+) if the vehicle has one.  
Negative () will go to a heavy,  
unpainted metal engine part or to  
a remote negative () terminal, if  
the vehicle has one. Do not  
connect positive (+) to  
negative () or you will get a short  
that would damage the battery  
and maybe other parts too.  
{ CAUTION  
Be sure the battery has enough  
water. You do not need to add  
water to the battery installed in  
your new vehicle. But if a battery  
has filler caps, be sure the right  
amount of fluid is there. If it is  
low, add water to take care of that  
first. If you do not, explosive gas  
could be present.  
An electric fan can start up even  
when the engine is not running  
and can injure you. Keep hands,  
clothing and tools away from any  
underhood electric fan.  
7. Connect the red positive (+)  
cable to the remote positive (+)  
terminal of your hybrid vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
(Continued)  
8. Do not let the other end touch  
metal. Connect it to the  
Fans or other moving engine  
parts can injure you badly. Keep  
your hands away from moving  
parts once the engine is running.  
positive (+) terminal of the good  
battery. Use a remote  
positive (+) terminal if the other  
vehicle has one.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-32  
Service and Appearance Care  
9. Now connect the black  
To disconnect the jumper cables  
from both vehicles, do the following:  
negative () cable to the  
negative () terminal of the good  
battery. Use a remote negative ()  
terminal if the vehicle has one. Do  
not let the other end touch  
anything until the next step. The  
other end of the negative ()  
cable does not go to the dead  
battery. It goes to your vehicle’s  
remote negative () terminal. The  
electrical connection is just as  
good there, and the chance of  
sparks getting back to the battery  
is much less.  
1. Disconnect the black negative ()  
cable from the vehicle that had  
the dead battery.  
2. Disconnect the black negative ()  
cable from the vehicle with the  
good battery.  
3. Disconnect the red positive (+)  
cable from the vehicle with the  
good battery.  
Jumper Cable Removal  
4. Disconnect the red positive (+)  
cable from the other vehicle.  
A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine  
Part or Remote Negative ()  
Terminal  
5. Close the remote positive  
junction box cover.  
10. Try to start the hybrid vehicle.  
Notice: If the jumper cables are  
connected or removed in the  
wrong order, electrical shorting  
may occur and damage the  
vehicle. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always connect and remove the  
jumper cables in the correct order,  
making sure that the cables do not  
touch each other or other metal.  
B. Good Battery or Remote  
Positive (+) and Remote  
Negative () Terminals  
C. Dead Battery or Remote  
Positive (+) Terminal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-33  
To adjust the vertical aim, do the  
following:  
The vehicle should be placed so  
it is perpendicular to the wall or  
other flat surface.  
Headlamp Aiming  
The headlamp aiming system has  
been preset at the factory.  
1. Open the hood. See Hood  
Release on page 5-9 for  
more information.  
The vehicle should not have any  
snow, ice, or mud on it.  
If the vehicle is damaged in an  
accident, the aim of the headlamps  
may be affected and adjustment  
may be necessary.  
The vehicle should be fully  
assembled and all other  
work stopped while headlamp  
aiming is being performed.  
It is recommended that a  
dealer/retailer adjust the headlamps.  
To re-aim the headlamps yourself,  
use the following procedure.  
The vehicle should be  
normally loaded with a full  
tank of fuel and one person or  
160 lbs (75 kg) sitting on the  
driver’s seat.  
The vehicle should be properly  
prepared as follows:  
Tires should be properly inflated.  
The vehicle should be placed so  
the headlamps are 25 ft. (7.6 m)  
from a light colored wall.  
Headlamp aiming is done with  
the vehicle’s low-beam headlamps.  
The high-beam headlamps will  
be correctly aimed if the low-beam  
headlamps are aimed properly.  
2. Locate the aim dot on the lens of  
the low-beam headlamp.  
The vehicle must have all four  
tires on a level surface which  
is level all the way to the wall.  
3. Measure the distance from the  
ground to the aim dot on the  
low-beam headlamp. Record the  
distance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-34  
Service and Appearance Care  
6. Turn on the low-beam headlamps  
8. Turn the vertical aiming screw  
until the headlamp beam is  
aimed to the horizontal tape line.  
Turn it clockwise or  
and place a piece of cardboard  
or equivalent in front of the  
headlamp not being adjusted.  
This allows only the beam of light  
from the headlamp being  
adjusted to be seen on the flat  
surface.  
counterclockwise to raise or  
lower the angle of the beam.  
4. At the wall measure from the  
ground upward (A) to the  
recorded distance from Step 3  
and mark it.  
5. Draw or tape a horizontal line (B)  
on the wall the width of the  
vehicle at the height of the mark  
in Step 4.  
9. Make sure that the light from the  
headlamp is positioned at the  
bottom edge of the horizontal  
tape line. The lamp on the left (A)  
shows the correct headlamp aim.  
The lamp on the right (B) shows  
the incorrect headlamp aim.  
7. Locate the vertical headlamp  
aiming screws, which are  
under the hood near each  
headlamp assembly.  
Notice: Do not cover a headlamp  
to improve beam cut-off when  
aiming. Covering a headlamp may  
cause excessive heat build-up  
which may cause damage to the  
headlamp.  
The adjustment screw can be  
turned with a E8 Torx® socket.  
10. Repeat Steps 7 through 9 for  
the opposite headlamp.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-35  
6. Pull back on the front fascia and  
then pull the headlamp assembly  
out from the vehicle. Another  
person might be needed to assist  
with this step.  
Headlamps  
Bulb Replacement  
For the proper type of replacement  
on page 5-37.  
To replace one of the headlamp  
bulbs, use the following procedure.  
To replace the parking/turn signal  
lamp bulb, see Front Turn Signal  
and Parking Lamps on page 5-36.  
For any bulb changing procedure  
not listed in this section, contact  
your dealer/retailer.  
1. Open the hood. See Hood  
Release on page 5-9 for  
more information.  
Halogen Bulbs  
2. Remove the two screws from the  
top of the front fascia and grille.  
They are inboard of the  
{ CAUTION  
headlamp assembly.  
Halogen bulbs have pressurized  
gas inside and can burst if you  
drop or scratch the bulb. You or  
others could be injured. Be sure  
to read and follow the instructions  
on the bulb package.  
3. Remove the three screws  
retaining the headlamp assembly.  
4. Insert a flat blade tool through the  
opening in the top. Make sure the  
tool fits through the opening in the  
headlamp bracket lower arm.  
7. Disconnect the electrical  
connector from the bulb  
assembly.  
8. Turn the bulb assembly  
counterclockwise to remove it  
from the housing.  
9. Replace the old bulb with a  
new one.  
5. Push the locking tab toward  
the rear of the vehicle with the  
tool to lift the headlamp bracket  
lower arm.  
10. Reverse Steps 1 through 8 to  
reinstall.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-36  
Service and Appearance Care  
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb  
socket assembly.  
Front Turn Signal and  
Parking Lamps  
To replace a front turn signal or  
parking lamp bulb:  
Taillamps, Turn Signal,  
Stoplamps and Back-up  
Lamps  
4. Push the new bulb into the bulb  
socket assembly.  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
5. Insert the bulb assembly into the  
headlamp assembly.  
1. Follow Steps 1 through 6 under  
Headlamps on page 5-35 to  
access the front turn signal or  
parking lamp.  
6. Turn the bulb assembly  
clockwise until seated.  
7. Reverse the steps to reinstall the  
headlamp assembly.  
A. Taillamp/Stoplamp  
B. Turn Signal Lamp  
C. Back-up Lamp  
2. Turn the bulb to be replaced  
counterclockwise to remove  
it from the headlamp assembly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-37  
1. Open the liftgate.  
4. Push the new bulb into the bulb  
License Plate Lamp  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
socket and turn it clockwise to  
lock it into place.  
1. Remove the two screws holding  
each of the license plate lamps  
to the fascia.  
5. Push and turn the license plate  
back through the fascia opening.  
6. Reinstall the two screws holding  
the license plate lamps to the  
fascia.  
Replacement Bulbs  
Exterior Lamp  
Bulb  
Number  
2. Remove the two screws holding  
in the taillamp assembly.  
Back-up Lamp  
Front Turn  
Signal/Parking  
3156  
3. Slide the taillamp assembly  
rearward and away from the  
vehicle.  
3157K  
Headlamps  
4. Turn the bulb socket being  
replaced counterclockwise  
to disconnect it.  
9005 or  
HB3  
9006 or  
HB4  
High-beam  
2. Turn and pull the license plate  
lamp forward through the  
fascia opening.  
Low-beam/DRL  
5. Pull the bulb out of the bulb  
socket.  
3. Turn the bulb socket  
Rear Turn Signal,  
Stoplamp and  
Taillamp  
counterclockwise and pull the  
bulb straight out of the socket.  
3057  
6. Push the new bulb into the  
bulb socket.  
7. Reverse Steps 2 through 4 to  
reinstall the taillamp assembly.  
For replacement bulbs not listed  
here, contact your dealer/retailer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-38  
Service and Appearance Care  
Windshield Wiper  
Blade Replacement  
Windshield wiper blades should be  
inspected for wear and cracking.  
Tires  
Your new vehicle comes with  
high-quality tires made by a  
leading tire manufacturer. If you  
ever have questions about your  
tire warranty and where to obtain  
service, see your vehicle  
Warranty booklet for details.  
For additional information refer  
to the tire manufacturer.  
on page 6-3 for more information.  
Replacement blades come in  
different types and are removed in  
different ways. For proper type  
and length, see Maintenance  
Replacement Parts on page 6-12.  
{ CAUTION  
2. Push the release lever (B) to  
disengage the hook and push the  
wiper arm (A) out of the blade (C).  
To replace the windshield wiper  
blade:  
Poorly maintained and  
improperly used tires are  
dangerous.  
3. Push the new wiper blade  
securely on the wiper arm until  
you hear the release lever click  
into place.  
Overloading your  
vehicle’s tires can cause  
overheating as a result  
of too much flexing. You  
could have an air-out and  
a serious accident. See  
page 4-18.  
To replace the rear wiper blade, lift  
the rear wiper arm from the  
window and pull the blade.  
(Continued)  
1. Lift the wiper arm away from the  
windshield.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-39  
See the “Tire Size” illustration  
later in this section for more  
detail.  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
CAUTION (Continued)  
Useful information about a tire is  
molded into its sidewall. The  
example below shows a typical  
passenger (p-metric) tire  
sidewall.  
Underinflated tires pose  
the same danger as  
overloaded tires. The  
resulting accident could  
cause serious injury.  
(B) TPC Spec (Tire  
Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original  
equipment tires designed to  
GM’s specific tire performance  
criteria have a TPC specification  
code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM’s TPC specifications meet or  
exceed all federal safety  
guidelines.  
Check all tires frequently to  
maintain the recommended  
pressure. Tire pressure  
should be checked when  
your vehicle’s tires are  
Pressure on page 5-43.  
Overinflated tires are more  
likely to be cut, punctured,  
or broken by a sudden  
impact — such as when  
you hit a pothole. Keep  
tires at the recommended  
pressure.  
(C) DOT (Department of  
Transportation): The  
Department of Transportation  
(DOT) code indicates that the tire  
is in compliance with the U.S.  
Department of Transportation  
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire  
Example  
(D) Tire Identification Number  
(TIN): The letters and numbers  
following DOT code are the  
Tire Identification Number (TIN).  
The TIN shows the manufacturer  
and plant code, tire size, and  
date the tire was manufactured.  
Worn, old tires can cause  
accidents. If the tire’s tread  
is badly worn, or if your  
vehicle’s tires have been  
damaged, replace them.  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size is a  
combination of letters and  
numbers used to define a  
particular tire’s width, height,  
aspect ratio, construction  
type, and service description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-40  
Service and Appearance Care  
The TIN is molded onto both  
sides of the tire, although  
only one side may have the date  
of manufacture.  
Tire Size  
For example, if the tire size  
aspect ratio is 60, as shown in  
item C of the illustration, it would  
mean that the tire’s sidewall is  
60 percent as high as it is wide.  
The following illustration  
shows an example of a typical  
passenger (p-metric) vehicle  
tire size.  
(E) Tire Ply Material: The type  
of cord and number of plies  
in the sidewall and under  
the tread.  
(D) Construction Code: A letter  
code is used to indicate the type  
of ply construction in the tire.  
The letter R means radial ply  
construction; the letter D means  
diagonal or bias ply construction;  
and the letter B means  
(F) Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading (UTQG): Tire  
manufacturers are required to  
grade tires based on three  
performance factors: treadwear,  
traction and temperature  
resistance. For more information  
Grading on page 5-54.  
belted-bias ply construction.  
(A) Passenger (P-Metric)  
Tire: The United States version  
of a metric tire sizing system. The  
letter P as the first character in  
the tire size means a passenger  
vehicle tire engineered to  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of  
the wheel in inches.  
(F) Service Description: These  
characters represent the load  
range and speed rating of the  
tire. The load index represents  
the load carry capacity a tire is  
certified to carry. The load index  
can range from 1 to 279. The  
speed rating is the maximum  
speed a tire is certified to carry  
a load. Speed ratings range  
from A to Z.  
standards set by the U. S. Tire  
and Rim Association.  
(G) Maximum Cold Inflation  
Load Limit: Maximum load that  
can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to  
support that load.  
(B) Tire Width: The three-digit  
number indicates the tire  
section width in millimeters from  
sidewall to sidewall.  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A two-digit  
number that indicates the tire  
height-to-width measurements.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-41  
Bead: The tire bead contains  
steel wires wrapped by steel  
cords that hold the tire onto  
the rim.  
DOT Markings: A code molded  
into the sidewall of a tire  
Tire Terminology and  
Definitions  
signifying that the tire is in  
compliance with the U.S.  
Air Pressure: The amount of  
air inside the tire pressing  
Department of Transportation  
(DOT) motor vehicle safety  
standards. The DOT code  
includes the Tire Identification  
Number (TIN), an alphanumeric  
designator which can also  
identify the tire manufacturer,  
production plant, brand, and date  
of production.  
Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire  
in which the plies are laid at  
alternate angles less than  
90 degrees to the centerline of  
the tread.  
outward on each square inch of  
the tire. Air pressure is  
expressed in pounds per square  
inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).  
Accessory Weight: This means  
the combined weight of  
optional accessories. Some  
examples of optional  
Cold Tire Pressure: The  
amount of air pressure in a tire,  
measured in pounds per  
square inch (psi) or kilopascals  
(kPa) before a tire has built  
up heat from driving. See  
page 5-43.  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight  
on page 4-18.  
accessories are, automatic  
transmission, power steering,  
power brakes, power windows,  
power seats, and air  
GAWR FRT: Gross Axle Weight  
Rating for the front axle. See  
page 4-18.  
conditioning.  
Curb Weight: The weight of a  
motor vehicle with standard  
and optional equipment including  
the maximum capacity of fuel,  
oil, and coolant, but without  
passengers and cargo.  
Aspect Ratio: The relationship  
of a tire’s height to its width.  
GAWR RR: Gross Axle Weight  
Rating for the rear axle. See  
page 4-18.  
Belt: A rubber coated layer of  
cords that is located between the  
plies and the tread. Cords  
may be made from steel or other  
reinforcing materials.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-42  
Service and Appearance Care  
Intended Outboard  
Maximum Loaded Vehicle  
Weight: The sum of curb  
weight, accessory weight,  
vehicle capacity weight, and  
production options weight.  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A  
tire used on passenger cars and  
some light duty trucks and  
multipurpose vehicles.  
Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire, that must  
always face outward when  
mounted on a vehicle.  
Recommended Inflation  
Pressure: Vehicle  
Kilopascal (kPa): The metric  
unit for air pressure.  
Normal Occupant Weight: The  
number of occupants a vehicle  
is designed to seat multiplied by  
150 lbs (68 kg). See Loading  
the Vehicle on page 4-18.  
manufacturer’s recommended  
tire inflation pressure as  
shown on the tire placard. See  
page 5-43 and Loading  
the Vehicle on page 4-18.  
Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire: A  
tire used on light duty trucks  
and some multipurpose  
passenger vehicles.  
Occupant  
Distribution: Designated  
seating positions.  
Load Index: An assigned  
number ranging from 1 to 279  
that corresponds to the load  
carrying capacity of a tire.  
Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatic  
tire in which the ply cords  
that extend to the beads are laid  
at 90 degrees to the centerline  
of the tread.  
Outward Facing Sidewall: The  
side of an asymmetrical tire  
that has a particular side  
that faces outward when  
mounted on a vehicle. The side  
of the tire that contains a  
Maximum Inflation  
Pressure: The maximum air  
pressure to which a cold tire can  
be inflated. The maximum air  
pressure is molded onto the  
sidewall.  
Rim: A metal support for a tire  
and upon which the tire  
beads are seated.  
whitewall, bears white lettering,  
or bears manufacturer, brand,  
and/or model name molding that  
is higher or deeper than the  
same moldings on the  
Sidewall: The portion of a tire  
between the tread and the bead.  
Maximum Load Rating: The  
load rating for a tire at the  
maximum permissible inflation  
pressure for that tire.  
Speed Rating: An alphanumeric  
code assigned to a tire  
indicating the maximum speed  
at which a tire can operate.  
other sidewall of the tire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-43  
Traction: The friction between  
the tire and the road surface.  
The amount of grip provided.  
Vehicle Capacity Weight: The  
number of designated seating  
positions multiplied by 150 lbs  
(68 kg) plus the rated cargo load.  
page 4-18.  
Notice: Do not let anyone tell  
you that under-inflation or  
over-inflation is all right. It is  
not. If your tires do not have  
enough air (under-inflation),  
you can get the following:  
Tread: The portion of a tire that  
comes into contact with the road.  
Treadwear Indicators: Narrow  
bands, sometimes called wear  
bars, that show across the tread  
of a tire when only 1/16 inch  
(1.6 mm) of tread remains. See  
page 5-51.  
• Too much flexing  
• Too much heat  
• Tire overloading  
• Premature or irregular wear  
• Poor handling  
• Reduced fuel economy  
Vehicle Maximum Load on the  
Tire: Load on an individual  
tire due to curb weight,  
accessory weight, occupant  
weight, and cargo weight.  
Vehicle Placard: A label  
permanently attached to a  
vehicle showing the vehicle’s  
capacity weight and the original  
equipment tire size and  
recommended inflation pressure.  
See “Tire and Loading  
Information Label” under  
page 4-18.  
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading Standards): A tire  
information system that provides  
consumers with ratings for a tire’s  
traction, temperature, and  
treadwear. Ratings are  
determined by tire manufacturers  
using government testing  
procedures. The ratings are  
molded into the sidewall of the  
Grading on page 5-54.  
If your tires have too much air  
(over-inflation), you can get  
the following:  
• Unusual wear  
• Poor handling  
• Rough ride  
• Needless damage from road  
hazards  
Inflation - Tire Pressure  
Tires need the correct amount  
of air pressure to operate  
effectively.  
A vehicle specific Tire and  
Loading Information label is  
attached to your vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-44  
Service and Appearance Care  
This label shows your vehicle’s  
original equipment tires and  
the correct inflation pressures for  
your tires when they are cold.  
The recommended cold tire  
inflation pressure, shown on the  
label, is the minimum amount  
of air pressure needed to  
When to Check  
If the cold tire inflation pressure  
matches the recommended  
pressure on the Tire and  
Loading Information label, no  
further adjustment is necessary.  
If the inflation pressure is  
low, add air until you reach the  
recommended amount.  
Check your tires once a month  
or more.  
How to Check  
Use a good quality pocket-type  
gage to check tire pressure.  
You cannot tell if your tires are  
properly inflated simply by  
looking at them. Radial tires may  
look properly inflated even when  
they are under-inflated. Check  
the tire’s inflation pressure when  
the tires are cold. Cold means  
your vehicle has been sitting for  
at least three hours or driven no  
more than 1 mile (1.6 km).  
support your vehicle’s maximum  
load carrying capacity.  
If you overfill the tire, release air  
by pushing on the metal stem in  
the center of the tire valve.  
Re-check the tire pressure with  
the tire gage.  
For additional information  
regarding how much weight  
your vehicle can carry, and an  
example of the Tire and Loading  
Information label, see Loading  
the Vehicle on page 4-18. How  
you load your vehicle affects  
vehicle handling and ride  
Be sure to put the valve caps  
back on the valve stems.  
They help prevent leaks by  
keeping out dirt and moisture.  
Remove the valve cap from  
the tire valve stem. Press the tire  
gage firmly onto the valve to  
get a pressure measurement.  
comfort. Never load your vehicle  
with more weight than it was  
designed to carry.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-45  
Accordingly, when the low tire  
pressure telltale illuminates, you  
should stop and check your tires as  
soon as possible, and inflate them to  
the proper pressure. Driving on a  
significantly under-inflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can  
lead to tire failure. Under-inflation  
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  
tread life, and may affect the  
vehicle’s handling and stopping  
ability.  
system detects a malfunction, the  
telltale will flash for approximately  
one minute and then remain  
continuously illuminated. This  
sequence will continue upon  
subsequent vehicle start-ups as  
long as the malfunction exists.  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
System  
The Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS) uses radio and sensor  
technology to check tire pressure  
levels. The TPMS sensors monitor  
the air pressure in your vehicle’s tires  
and transmit tire pressure readings to  
a receiver located in the vehicle.  
When the malfunction indicator is  
illuminated, the system may  
not be able to detect or signal low  
tire pressure as intended. TPMS  
malfunctions may occur for a variety  
of reasons, including the installation  
of replacement or alternate tires  
or wheels on the vehicle that prevent  
the TPMS from functioning  
properly. Always check the TPMS  
malfunction telltale after replacing  
one or more tires or wheels on your  
vehicle to ensure that the  
Each tire, including the spare  
(if provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to the  
inflation pressure recommended by  
the vehicle manufacturer on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation  
pressure label. (If your vehicle has  
tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or  
tire inflation pressure label, you  
should determine the proper tire  
inflation pressure for those tires.)  
Please note that the TPMS is not  
a substitute for proper tire  
maintenance, and it is the driver’s  
responsibility to maintain correct  
tire pressure, even if under-inflation  
has not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire  
pressure telltale.  
replacement or alternate tires and  
wheels allow the TPMS to continue  
to function properly.  
Your vehicle has also been  
equipped with a TPMS malfunction  
indicator to indicate when the  
system is not operating properly.  
The TPMS malfunction indicator  
is combined with the low tire  
pressure telltale. When the  
As an added safety feature, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)  
that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your  
tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Operation on page 5-46 for  
additional information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-46  
Service and Appearance Care  
The TPMS operates on a radio  
frequency and complies with  
RSS-210 of Industry and Science  
Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions:  
Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and  
Industry and Science Canada  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
Operation  
This vehicle may have a Tire  
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS).  
The TPMS is designed to warn  
the driver when a low tire pressure  
condition exists. TPMS sensors  
are mounted onto each tire  
and wheel assembly. The TPMS  
sensors monitor the air pressure in  
the vehicle’s tires and transmits  
the tire pressure readings to  
The Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS) operates on a radio  
frequency and complies with  
Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions:  
1. This device may not cause  
interference.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the  
device.  
1. This device may not cause  
harmful interference.  
2. This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
a receiver located in the vehicle.  
Changes or modifications to this  
system by other than an authorized  
service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
When a loondition is  
detected, the TPMS turns on the low  
tire pressure warning light located on  
the instrument panel cluster.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-47  
At the same time a message to  
check the pressure in a specific tire  
appears on the Driver Information  
Center (DIC) display. The low tire  
pressure warning light and the DIC  
warning message come on at each  
ignition cycle until the tires are  
inflated to the correct inflation  
pressure. Using the DIC, tire  
pressure levels can be viewed by the  
driver. For additional information and  
details about the DIC operation and  
Displays on page 3-36 and DIC  
A Tire and Loading Information label  
shows the size of your vehicle’s  
original equipment tires and  
Notice: Using non-approved tire  
sealants could damage the  
Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS) sensors. TPMS sensor  
damage caused by using an  
incorrect tire sealant is not  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always use the GM approved  
tire sealant available through your  
dealer/retailer.  
the correct inflation pressure for  
your vehicle’s tires when they  
on page 4-18, for an example of the  
Tire and Loading Information  
label and its location on your  
vehicle. Also see Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 5-43.  
Your vehicle, when new, included a  
factory-installed Tire Inflator Kit.  
This kit uses a GM approved liquid  
tire sealant. Using non-approved  
tire sealants could damage the  
TPMS sensors. See Tire Sealant  
and Compressor Kit for information  
regarding the inflator kit materials  
and instructions.  
Your vehicle’s TPMS system can  
warn you about a low tire pressure  
condition but it does not replace  
normal tire maintenance. See Tire  
page 3-42.  
The low tire pressure warning light  
may come on in cool weather  
when the vehicle is first started, and  
then turn off as you start to drive.  
This could be an early indicator that  
the air pressure in the tire(s) are  
getting low and need to be inflated  
to the proper pressure.  
page 5-50 and Tires on page 5-38.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-48  
Service and Appearance Care  
TPMS Malfunction Light and  
Message  
One or more TPMS sensors are  
missing or damaged. The DIC  
message and the TPMS  
malfunction light should go  
off when the TPMS sensors  
are installed and the sensor  
matching process is performed  
successfully. See your dealer/  
retailer for service.  
Replacement tires or wheels do  
not match your vehicle’s original  
equipment tires or wheels. Tires  
and wheels other than those  
recommended for your vehicle  
could prevent the TPMS from  
functioning properly. See Buying  
New Tires on page 5-51.  
Operating electronic devices or  
being near facilities using radio  
wave frequencies similar to the  
TPMS could cause the TPMS  
sensors to malfunction.  
TPMS Sensor Matching  
Process  
The TPMS will not function properly if  
one or more of the TPMS sensors  
are missing or inoperable. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the  
low tire warning light flashes for  
about one minute and then stays on  
for the remainder of the ignition  
cycle. A DIC warning message is  
also displayed. The low tire warning  
light and DIC warning message  
come on at each ignition cycle until  
the problem is corrected. Some of  
the conditions that can cause the  
malfunction light and DIC message  
to come on are:  
Each TPMS sensor has a unique  
identification code. Any time  
you replace one or more of the  
TPMS sensors or rotate the  
vehicle’s tires, the identification  
codes need to be matched to the  
new tire/wheel location. The sensors  
are matched, to the tire/wheel  
locations, in the following order:  
driver side front tire, passenger side  
front tire, passenger side rear  
tire, and driver side rear tire using a  
TPMS diagnostic tool. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
The TPMS sensors can also be  
matched to each tire/wheel position  
by increasing or decreasing the  
tire’s air pressure. When increasing  
the tire’s pressure, do not exceed  
the maximum inflation pressure  
indicated on the tire’s sidewall. To  
decrease the tire’s air-pressure  
use the pointed end of the valve  
cap, a pencil-style air pressure  
gage, or a key.  
The TPMS sensor matching  
process was started but not  
completed or not completed  
successfully after rotating the  
vehicle’s tires. The DIC message  
and TPMS malfunction light  
should go off once the TPMS  
sensor matching process is  
performed successfully. See  
“TPMS Sensor Matching Process”  
later in this section.  
If the TPMS is not functioning it  
cannot detect or signal a low tire  
condition. See your dealer/retailer for  
service if the TPMS malfunction light  
and DIC message comes on and  
stays on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-49  
You have two minutes to match  
each tire and wheel position.  
If it takes longer than two minutes to  
match any tire and wheel position,  
the matching process stops and you  
need to start over.  
5. Remove the valve cap from the  
tire’s valve stem. Activate the  
TPMS sensor by increasing  
or decreasing the tire’s air  
learned. Proceed to the driver  
side rear tire, and repeat  
the procedure in Step 5.  
9. After hearing the single horn  
chirp for the driver side rear  
tire, two additional horn chirps  
sound to indicate the tire learning  
process is done. Turn the  
pressure for about eight seconds.  
The horn chirp, can take up to  
30 seconds to sound. It  
chirps one time and then all the  
turn signals flash one time to  
confirm the sensor identification  
code has been matched to  
the tire/wheel position.  
The TPMS matching process is  
outlined below:  
ignition switch to LOCK/OFF.  
1. Set the parking brake.  
If no tires are learned after  
entering the TPMS learn mode,  
or if communication with the  
receiver stops, or if the time limit  
has expired, turn the ignition  
switch to LOCK/OFF and  
2. Turn the ignition switch to  
ON/RUN with the engine off.  
6. The passenger side front turn  
signal comes on to indicate  
that corner sensor is ready to be  
learned. Proceed to the  
3. Press and hold the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter’s  
LOCK and UNLOCK buttons,  
at the same time, for about  
five seconds to start the TPMS  
learn mode. The horn sounds  
twice indicating the TPMS  
receiver is ready and in  
start over beginning with Step 2.  
passenger side front tire and  
repeat the procedure in Step 5.  
10. Set all four tires to the  
recommended air pressure level  
as indicated on the Tire and  
Loading Information label.  
7. The passenger side rear  
turn signal comes on to indicate  
that corner sensor is ready to  
be learned. Proceed to the  
passenger side rear tire and  
repeat the procedure in Step 5.  
learn mode.  
11. Put the valve caps back on the  
valve stems.  
4. Start with the driver side front  
tire. The driver side front turn  
signal also comes on to indicate  
that corner’s sensor is ready  
to be learned.  
8. The driver side rear turn signal  
comes on to indicate that  
corner sensor is ready to be  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-50  
Service and Appearance Care  
Tires on page 5-51 and  
page 5-55.  
Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor  
System. See Tire Pressure  
Tire Inspection and  
Rotation  
Monitor Operation on page 5-46.  
We recommend that you  
regularly inspect the vehicle’s  
tires, including the spare tire, for  
signs of wear or damage.  
Tires on page 5-51 for more  
information.  
Make certain that all wheel  
nuts are properly tightened. See  
“Wheel Nut Torque” under  
page 5-81.  
{ CAUTION  
Tires should be rotated every  
5,000 to 8,000 miles (8 000 to  
13 000 km). See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 6-3.  
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on  
the parts to which it is  
fastened, can make wheel  
nuts become loose after a  
time. The wheel could come  
off and cause a crash. When  
you change a wheel, remove  
any rust or dirt from places  
where the wheel attaches to  
the vehicle. In an emergency,  
you can use a cloth or a paper  
towel to do this; but be sure to  
use a scraper or wire brush  
later, if you need to, to get all  
the rust or dirt off.  
The purpose of a regular tire  
rotation is to achieve a uniform  
wear for all tires on the  
vehicle. This will ensure that the  
vehicle continues to perform  
most like it did when the  
tires were new.  
When rotating the vehicle’s tires,  
always use the correct rotation  
pattern shown here.  
After the tires have been rotated,  
adjust the front and rear inflation  
pressures as shown on the Tire  
and Loading Information label.  
page 5-43 and Loading the  
Vehicle on page 4-18.  
Any time you notice unusual  
wear, rotate the tires as soon  
as possible and check wheel  
alignment. Also check for  
damaged tires or wheels.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-51  
You need new tires if any of the  
following statements are true:  
With proper care and maintenance  
tires typically wear out before  
they degrade due to age. If you are  
unsure about the need to replace  
the tires as they get older, consult  
the tire manufacturer for more  
information.  
When It Is Time for New  
Tires  
You can see the indicators at  
three or more places around  
the tire.  
Various factors, such as  
maintenance, temperatures, driving  
speeds, vehicle loading, and  
road conditions influence when you  
need new tires.  
You can see cord or fabric  
showing through the tire’s rubber.  
The tread or sidewall is cracked,  
cut, or snagged deep enough to  
show cord or fabric.  
Buying New Tires  
GM has developed and matched  
specific tires for your vehicle.  
The original equipment tires installed  
on your vehicle, when it was new,  
were designed to meet General  
Motors Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification (TPC spec) system  
rating. If you need replacement tires,  
GM strongly recommends that  
you get tires with the same TPC  
Spec rating. This way, your vehicle  
will continue to have tires that  
are designed to give the same  
performance and vehicle safety,  
during normal use, as the original  
tires.  
The tire has a bump, bulge,  
or split.  
The tire has a puncture, cut, or  
other damage that cannot be  
repaired well because of the size  
or location of the damage.  
The rubber in tires degrades over  
time, even if they are not being  
used. This is also true for the spare  
tire, if the vehicle has one. Multiple  
conditions affect how fast this  
aging takes place, including  
temperatures, loading conditions,  
and inflation pressure maintenance.  
One way to tell when it is time for  
new tires is to check the treadwear  
indicators, which will appear  
when the tires have only 1/16 inch  
(1.6 mm) or less of tread remaining.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-52  
Service and Appearance Care  
GM’s exclusive TPC Spec system  
considers over a dozen critical  
specifications that impact the overall  
performance of your vehicle,  
including brake system performance,  
ride and handling, traction control,  
and tire pressure monitoring  
performance. GM’s TPC Spec  
number is molded onto the tire’s  
sidewall near the tire size. If the tires  
have an all-season tread design,  
the TPC spec number will be  
followed by a MS, for mud and  
page 5-39 for additional information.  
and handling performance of your  
vehicle. See Tire Inspection  
and Rotation on page 5-50 for  
information on proper tire rotation.  
{ CAUTION  
If you use bias-ply tires on the  
vehicle, the wheel rim flanges  
could develop cracks after  
many miles of driving. A tire  
and/or wheel could fail  
suddenly, causing a crash.  
Use only radial-ply tires with  
the wheels on the vehicle.  
{ CAUTION  
Mixing tires could cause you  
to lose control while driving. If  
you mix tires of different sizes,  
brands, or types (radial and  
bias-belted tires) the vehicle  
may not handle properly, and  
you could have a crash. Using  
tires of different sizes, brands,  
or types may also cause  
damage to your vehicle. Be  
sure to use the correct size,  
brand, and type of tires on  
your vehicle’s wheels.  
If you must replace your vehicle’s  
tires with those that do not have a  
TPC Spec number, make sure they  
are the same size, load range, speed  
rating, and construction type (radial  
and bias-belted tires) as your  
GM recommends replacing tires  
in sets of four. This is because  
uniform tread depth on all tires will  
help keep your vehicle performing  
most like it did when the tires  
vehicle’s original tires.  
were new. Replacing less than a full  
set of tires can affect the braking  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
Different Size Tires and  
5-53  
Vehicles that have a tire pressure  
monitoring system could give an  
inaccurate low-pressure warning if  
non-TPC Spec rated tires are  
installed on your vehicle. Non-TPC  
Spec rated tires may give a  
low-pressure warning that is higher  
or lower than the proper warning  
level you would get with TPC Spec  
rated tires. See Tire Pressure  
Monitor System on page 5-45.  
{ CAUTION  
Wheels  
If you add wheels or tires that are a  
different size than your original  
equipment wheels and tires,  
this may affect the way your vehicle  
performs, including its braking,  
ride and handling characteristics,  
stability, and resistance to rollover.  
Additionally, if your vehicle has  
electronic systems such as, anti-lock  
brakes, rollover airbags, traction  
control, and stability control,  
If you add different sized wheels,  
your vehicle may not provide an  
acceptable level of performance  
and safety if tires not  
recommended for those wheels  
are selected. You may increase  
the chance that you will crash and  
suffer serious injury. Only use  
Saturn specific wheel and tire  
systems developed for your  
vehicle, and have them properly  
installed by a Saturn certified  
technician.  
Your vehicle’s original equipment  
tires are listed on the Tire and  
Loading Information label. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 4-18,  
for more information about the  
Tire and Loading Information label  
and its location on your vehicle.  
the performance of these systems  
can be affected.  
See Buying New Tires on page 5-51  
on page 5-3 for additional  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-54  
Service and Appearance Care  
rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches  
(25 to 30 cm), or to some  
limited-production tires.  
due to variations in driving habits,  
service practices, and differences  
in road characteristics and  
climate.  
Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading  
Quality grades can be found  
where applicable on the  
tire sidewall between tread  
shoulder and maximum section  
width. For example:  
While the tires available on  
General Motors passenger cars  
and light trucks may vary with  
respect to these grades, they  
must also conform to federal  
safety requirements and  
additional General Motors Tire  
Performance Criteria (TPC)  
standards.  
Traction – AA, A, B, C  
The traction grades, from highest  
to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.  
Those grades represent the tire’s  
ability to stop on wet pavement  
as measured under controlled  
conditions on specified  
government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire  
marked C may have poor traction  
performance.  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
The following information relates  
to the system developed by the  
United States National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA), which grades tires by  
treadwear, traction, and  
temperature performance. This  
applies only to vehicles sold in  
the United States. The grades  
are molded on the sidewalls of  
most passenger car tires. The  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
(UTQG) system does not apply to  
deep tread, winter-type snow  
tires, space-saver, or temporary  
use spare tires, tires with nominal  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a  
comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test  
{ WARNING  
The traction grade assigned to  
this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction  
tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering,  
hydroplaning, or peak traction  
characteristics.  
course. For example, a tire  
graded 150 would wear one and  
a half (1.5) times as well on the  
government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative  
performance of tires depends  
upon the actual conditions of  
their use, however, and may  
depart significantly from the norm  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-55  
basis. However, if you notice  
Temperature – A, B, C  
{ WARNING  
unusual tire wear or your vehicle  
pulling to one side or the other, the  
alignment might need to be  
checked. If you notice your vehicle  
vibrating when driving on a  
smooth road, the tires and wheels  
might need to be rebalanced.  
See your dealer/retailer for proper  
diagnosis.  
The temperature grades are  
A (the highest), B, and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance  
to the generation of heat and  
its ability to dissipate heat when  
tested under controlled  
conditions on a specified indoor  
laboratory test wheel. Sustained  
high temperature can cause  
the material of the tire to  
degenerate and reduce tire life,  
and excessive temperature  
can lead to sudden tire failure.  
The grade C corresponds to  
a level of performance which all  
passenger car tires must  
meet under the Federal Motor  
Vehicle Safety Standard  
No. 109. Grades B and A  
represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory  
test wheel than the minimum  
required by law.  
The temperature grade for this  
tire is established for a tire  
that is properly inflated and  
not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or  
excessive loading, either  
separately or in combination,  
can cause heat buildup and  
possible tire failure.  
Wheel Replacement  
Replace any wheel that is bent,  
cracked, or badly rusted or  
corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming  
loose, the wheel, wheel bolts, and  
wheel nuts should be replaced. If the  
wheel leaks air, replace it (except  
some aluminum wheels, which  
can sometimes be repaired). See  
your dealer/retailer if any of  
Wheel Alignment and  
Tire Balance  
The tires and wheels on your  
vehicle were aligned and balanced  
carefully at the factory to give  
you the longest tire life and best  
overall performance. Adjustments to  
wheel alignment and tire balancing  
will not be necessary on a regular  
these conditions exist.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-56  
Service and Appearance Care  
Your dealer/retailer will know the  
kind of wheel you need.  
If you need to replace any of your  
wheels, wheel bolts, or wheel  
nuts, replace them only with new  
Saturn original equipment parts.  
This way, you will be sure to have  
the right wheel, wheel bolts,  
{ CAUTION  
Each new wheel should have the  
same load-carrying capacity,  
diameter, width, offset and be  
mounted the same way as the  
one it replaces.  
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on  
the parts to which it is  
fastened, can make wheel  
nuts become loose after a  
time. The wheel could come  
off and cause a crash. When  
you change a wheel, remove  
any rust or dirt from places  
where the wheel attaches to  
the vehicle. In an emergency,  
you can use a cloth or a paper  
towel to do this; but be sure to  
use a scraper or wire brush  
later, if you need to, to get all  
the rust or dirt off.  
and wheel nuts for your vehicle.  
Notice: The wrong wheel  
can also cause problems with  
bearing life, brake cooling,  
speedometer or odometer  
calibration, headlamp aim,  
bumper height, vehicle ground  
clearance, and tire clearance  
to the body and chassis.  
{ CAUTION  
Using the wrong replacement  
wheels, wheel bolts, or wheel nuts  
on your vehicle can be  
dangerous. It could affect the  
braking and handling of your  
vehicle, make your tires lose air  
and make you lose control. You  
could have a collision in which  
you or others could be injured.  
Always use the correct wheel,  
wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for  
replacement.  
{ CAUTION  
Never use oil or grease on studs  
or the threads of the wheel nuts.  
If you do, the wheel nuts might  
come loose and the wheel could  
fall off, causing a crash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-57  
Used Replacement Wheels  
{ CAUTION  
CAUTION (Continued)  
{ CAUTION  
Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly  
tightened wheel nuts can cause  
the wheel to become loose and  
even come off. This could lead to a  
crash. Be sure to use the correct  
wheel nuts. If you have to replace  
them, be sure to get new Saturn  
original equipment wheel nuts.  
The area damaged by the tire  
chains could cause you to lose  
control of the vehicle and you or  
others may be injured in a crash.  
Putting a used wheel on your  
vehicle is dangerous. You cannot  
know how it has been used or  
how far it has been driven. It  
could fail suddenly and cause a  
crash. If you have to replace a  
wheel, use a new Saturn original  
equipment wheel.  
Use another type of traction  
device only if its manufacturer  
recommends it for use on the  
vehicle and tire size combination  
and road conditions. Follow that  
manufacturer’s instructions. To  
help avoid damage to the vehicle,  
drive slowly, readjust or remove  
the device if it is contacting the  
vehicle, and do not spin the  
vehicle’s wheels. If you do find  
traction devices that will fit, install  
them on the front tires.  
Notice: Improperly tightened  
wheel nuts can lead to brake  
pulsation and rotor damage. To  
avoid expensive brake repairs,  
evenly tighten the wheel nuts in  
the proper sequence and to  
the proper torque specification.  
Tire Chains  
{ CAUTION  
Do not use tire chains. There is  
not enough clearance. Tire chains  
used on a vehicle without the  
proper amount of clearance can  
cause damage to the brakes,  
suspension or other vehicle parts.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-58  
Service and Appearance Care  
A rear blow out, particularly on a  
curve, acts much like a skid  
3. Turn off the engine.  
4. Inspect the flat tire.  
If a Tire Goes Flat  
This vehicle has a tire sealant and  
compressor kit. See Tire Sealant  
and Compressor Kit on page 5-59.  
There is no spare tire, no tire  
changing equipment, and no place  
to store a tire.  
and may require the same correction  
you would use in a skid. In any  
rear blow out, remove your foot from  
the accelerator pedal. Get the  
vehicle under control by steering the  
way you want the vehicle to go. It  
may be very bumpy and noisy,  
but you can still steer. Gently brake  
to a stop, well off the road if  
possible.  
If the tire has been separated from  
the wheel, has damaged sidewalls,  
or has a puncture larger than a  
1
4  
inch (6 mm), the tire is too  
severely damaged for the tire  
sealant and compressor kit to be  
effective. See Roadside Assistance  
Program on page 7-5.  
It is unusual for a tire to blow out  
while you are driving, especially  
if you maintain your tires properly.  
See Tires on page 5-38. If air  
goes out of a tire, it is much more  
likely to leak out slowly. But, if  
you should ever have a blow out,  
here are a few tips about what  
to expect and what to do:  
If the tire has a puncture less than a  
1
4  
inch (6 mm) in the tread area  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire  
and wheel damage by driving slowly  
to a level place and stopping.  
of the tire, see Tire Sealant  
and Compressor Kit on page 5-59.  
1. Turn on the hazard warning  
flashers. See Hazard Warning  
Flashers on page 3-5.  
If a front tire fails, the flat tire will  
create a drag that pulls the vehicle  
toward that side. Take your foot  
off the accelerator pedal and grip the  
steering wheel firmly. Steer to  
maintain lane position, and then  
gently brake to a stop well out of the  
traffic lane.  
2. Park the vehicle. Set the parking  
brake firmly and put the shift  
lever in P (Park). See Shifting  
Into Park on page 2-23.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-59  
Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
Over-inflating a tire could cause  
the tire to rupture and you or  
others could be injured. Be sure  
to read and follow the tire sealant  
and compressor kit instructions  
and inflate the tire to its  
recommended pressure. Do not  
exceed the recommended  
pressure.  
Storing the tire sealant and  
compressor kit or other equipment  
in the passenger compartment of  
the vehicle could cause injury. In  
a sudden stop or collision, loose  
equipment could strike someone.  
Store the tire sealant and  
{ CAUTION  
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed  
area with poor ventilation is  
dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust  
contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled.  
It can cause unconsciousness  
and even death. Never run the  
engine in an enclosed area that  
has no fresh air ventilation. For  
more information, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 2-26.  
compressor kit in its original  
location.  
If this vehicle has a tire sealant and  
compressor kit, there may not be a  
spare tire, tire changing equipment,  
and on some vehicles there may not  
be a place to store a tire.  
The tire sealant and compressor  
can be used to temporarily seal  
punctures up to 14 inch (6 mm) in the  
tread area of the tire. It can also be  
used to inflate an under inflated tire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-60  
Service and Appearance Care  
If the tire has been separated from  
the wheel, has damaged sidewalls,  
or has a large puncture, the tire  
is too severely damaged for the tire  
sealant and compressor kit to be  
effective. See Roadside Assistance  
Program on page 7-5.  
The kit includes:  
Tire Sealant  
Read and follow the safe handling  
instructions on the label adhered  
to the sealant canister.  
Check the tire sealant expiration  
date on the sealant canister.  
The sealant canister should be  
replaced before its expiration date.  
Replacement sealant canisters  
are available at your local  
Read and follow all of the tire  
sealant and compressor kit  
instructions.  
dealer/retailer. See “Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canister”  
following.  
A. Air Compressor  
There is only enough sealant to seal  
one tire. After usage, the sealant  
canister and sealant/air hose  
assembly must be replaced. See  
“Removal and Installation of  
B. Tire Sealant Canister  
C. Power Plug  
D. On/Off Button  
E. Pressure Gage  
the Sealant Canister” following.  
F. Air Only Hose (Black)  
G. Sealant/Air Hose (Clear)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-61  
Always do a safety check first. See  
If a Tire Goes Flat on page 5-58.  
5. Attach the sealant/air hose (F)  
onto the tire valve stem. Turn  
it clockwise until it is tight.  
Using the Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit to  
Temporarily Seal and Inflate a  
Punctured Tire  
1. Remove the tire sealant and  
compressor kit from its storage  
location. See Tire Sealant  
page 5-66.  
6. Plug the power plug (C) into the  
accessory power outlet in the  
vehicle. Unplug all items  
from other accessory power  
outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 3-16.  
Make sure the on/off button (D)  
is in the off (O) position.  
If the vehicle has an accessory  
power outlet, do not use the  
cigarette lighter.  
2. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (F)  
and the power plug (C).  
3. Place the kit on the ground.  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette  
lighter, use the cigarette lighter.  
Make sure the tire valve  
stem is positioned close to the  
ground so the hose will reach it.  
Do not pinch the power plug  
cord in the door or window.  
4. Remove the valve stem cap from  
the flat tire by turning it  
When using the tire sealant and  
compressor kit during cold  
temperatures, warm the kit in a  
heated environment for 5 minutes.  
This will help to inflate the tire faster.  
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle  
must be running while using  
the air compressor.  
counterclockwise.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-62  
Service and Appearance Care  
8. Press the on/off (D) button to  
turn the tire sealant and  
compressor kit on.  
The pressure gage (E) may read  
higher than the actual tire  
pressure while the compressor is  
on. Turn the compressor off to  
get an accurate pressure  
reading. The compressor may be  
turned on/off until the correct  
pressure is reached.  
10. Press the on/off button (D) to  
turn the tire sealant and  
compressor kit off.  
The compressor will inject  
sealant and air into the tire.  
The tire is not sealed and will  
continue to leak air until  
the vehicle is driven and the  
sealant is distributed in the tire,  
therefore, Steps 11 through 17  
must be done immediately  
after Step 10.  
The pressure gage (E) will initially  
show a high pressure while the  
compressor pushes the sealant  
into the tire. Once the sealant is  
completely dispersed into the tire,  
the pressure will quickly drop and  
start to rise again as the tire  
inflates with air only.  
Notice: If the recommended  
pressure cannot be reached after  
approximately 25 minutes, the  
vehicle should not be driven  
farther. The tire is too severely  
damaged and the tire sealant and  
compressor kit cannot inflate the  
tire. Remove the power plug from  
the accessory power outlet and  
unscrew the inflating hose from  
the tire valve. See Roadside  
Be careful while handling the tire  
sealant and compressor kit as it  
could be warm after usage.  
9. Inflate the tire to the  
11. Unplug the power plug (C) from  
the accessory power outlet in  
the vehicle.  
recommended inflation pressure  
using the pressure gage (E).  
The recommended inflation  
pressure can be found on the  
Tire and Loading Information  
Pressure on page 5-43.  
12. Turn the sealant/air hose (F)  
counterclockwise to remove it  
from the tire valve stem.  
Assistance Program on page 7-5.  
13. Replace the tire valve  
stem cap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-63  
14. Replace the sealant/air hose (F),  
and the power plug (C) back in  
their original location.  
17. Immediately drive the vehicle  
5 miles (8 km) to distribute the  
sealant in the tire.  
19. Wipe off any sealant from the  
wheel, tire or vehicle.  
20. Dispose of the used sealant  
canister (B) and sealant/air  
hose (F) assembly at a  
18. Stop at a safe location and  
check the tire pressure.  
Refer to Steps 1 through 11  
under “Using the Tire Sealant  
and Compressor Kit without  
Sealant to Inflate a Tire  
(Not Punctured).”  
local dealer/retailer or in  
accordance with local state  
codes and practices.  
21. Replace it with a new canister  
available from your  
15. If the flat tire was able to inflate  
to the recommended inflation  
pressure, remove the maximum  
speed label from the sealant  
canister (B) and place it  
If the tire pressure has fallen  
more than 10 psi (68 kPa) below  
the recommended inflation  
pressure, stop driving the  
vehicle. The tire is too severely  
damaged and the tire sealant  
cannot seal the tire. See  
on page 7-5.  
dealer/retailer.  
22. After temporarily sealing a tire  
using the tire sealant and  
compressor kit, take the vehicle  
to an authorized dealer/retailer  
within a 100 miles (161 km)  
of driving to have the tire  
in a highly visible location.  
The label is a reminder not to  
exceed 55 mph (90 km/h)  
until the damaged tire is  
repaired or replaced.  
repaired or replaced.  
If the tire pressure has not  
dropped more than 10 psi  
(68 kPa) from the recommended  
inflation pressure, inflate the  
tire to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
16. Return the equipment to its  
original storage location in  
the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-64  
Service and Appearance Care  
2. Unlock the air only hose (F) from  
the sealant canister (B) by  
pulling up on the lever.  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette  
lighter, use the cigarette lighter.  
Using the Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit without  
Sealant to Inflate a Tire (Not  
Punctured)  
Do not pinch the power plug  
cord in the door or window.  
9. Start the vehicle. The vehicle  
must be running while using  
the air compressor.  
3. Pull the air only hose (F) from  
the sealant canister (B).  
To use the air compressor to inflate  
a tire with air only and not sealant:  
4. Remove the power plug (C) from  
the air compressor (A).  
10. Press the on/off (D) button to  
turn the compressor on.  
5. Place the kit on the ground.  
Make sure the tire valve  
stem is positioned close to the  
ground so the hose will reach it.  
The compressor will inflate the  
tire with air only.  
11. Inflate the tire to the  
6. Remove the tire valve stem cap  
by turning it counterclockwise.  
recommended inflation pressure  
using the pressure gage (E).  
The recommended inflation  
pressure can be found on the  
Tire and Loading Information  
7. Attach the air only hose (F) onto  
the tire valve stem and press the  
lever down to secure it.  
8. Plug the power plug (C) into the  
accessory power outlet in the  
vehicle. Unplug all items  
Pressure on page 5-43.  
Always do a safety check first. See  
If a Tire Goes Flat on page 5-58.  
The pressure gage (E) may  
read higher than the actual tire  
pressure while the compressor  
is on. Turn the compressor  
off to get an accurate reading.  
The compressor may be  
from other accessory power  
outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 3-16.  
1. Remove the tire sealant and  
compressor kit from its storage  
location. See Tire Sealant and  
page 5-66.  
If the vehicle has an accessory  
power outlet, do not use the  
cigarette lighter.  
turned on/off until the correct  
pressure is reached.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-65  
12. Press the on/off button (D) to  
turn the tire sealant and  
compressor kit off.  
5. Lift the sealant canister (B) from  
the compressor and replace with  
a new sealant canister. See  
your dealer/retailer for more  
information.  
Removal and Installation of  
the Sealant Canister  
To remove the sealant canister:  
Be careful while handling the tire  
sealant and compressor kit as it  
could be warm after usage.  
To install a new sealant canister:  
13. Unplug the power plug (C) from  
the accessory power outlet in  
the vehicle.  
1. Align the sealant/air hose (F) with  
the slot in the air compressor.  
2. Push the sealant canister (B)  
down and turn it clockwise.  
14. Disconnect the air only hose (F)  
from the tire valve stem, by  
1. Unlock the air only hose (F) from  
the sealant canister (B) by  
pulling up on the lever.  
2. Pull the air only hose (F) from  
the sealant canister (B).  
3. Wrap the sealant/air hose (F)  
around the air compressor  
channel to stow it in its original  
location.  
turning it counterclockwise, and  
replace the tire valve stem cap.  
15. Replace the air only hose (F)  
and the power plug (C) back in  
its original location.  
4. Push the air compressor inflator  
hose (F) onto the sealant  
canister inlet and push the  
lever down.  
3. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (F)  
from the compressor (A).  
16. Place the equipment in the  
original storage location in  
the vehicle.  
4. Turn the sealant canister (B) so  
the inflator filling hose is aligned  
with the slot in the compressor.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-66  
Service and Appearance Care  
2. Push in the levers and lift the  
load floor up.  
Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage  
To access the tire sealant and  
compressor kit:  
Appearance Care  
Interior Cleaning  
The vehicle’s interior will continue to  
look its best if it is cleaned often.  
Although not always visible,  
dust and dirt can accumulate on the  
upholstery. Dirt can damage  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on  
page 2-8.  
carpet, fabric, leather, and plastic  
surfaces. Regular vacuuming  
is recommended to remove particles  
from the upholstery. It is important  
to keep the upholstery from  
becoming and remaining heavily  
soiled. Soils should be removed as  
quickly as possible. The vehicle’s  
interior may experience extremes of  
heat that could cause stains to  
set rapidly.  
3. Turn the retainer  
counterclockwise and  
remove the tire sealant  
and compressor kit.  
To store the tire sealant and  
compressor kit, reverse the steps.  
Lighter colored interiors may require  
more frequent cleaning. Use care  
because newspapers and garments  
that transfer color to home  
furnishings may also transfer color  
to the vehicle’s interior.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-67  
When cleaning the vehicle’s interior,  
only use cleaners specifically  
designed for the surfaces being  
cleaned. Permanent damage may  
result from using cleaners on  
surfaces for which they were not  
intended. Use glass cleaner only on  
glass. Remove any accidental  
over-spray from other surfaces  
immediately. To prevent over-spray,  
apply cleaner directly to the  
cleaning cloth.  
Many cleaners contain solvents that  
may become concentrated in the  
vehicle’s breathing space. Before  
using cleaners, read and adhere to  
all safety instructions on the  
label. While cleaning the vehicle’s  
interior, maintain adequate  
Heavy pressure or aggressive  
rubbing with a cleaning cloth.  
Use of heavy pressure can  
damage the interior and does not  
improve the effectiveness of  
soil removal.  
Laundry detergents or  
dishwashing soaps with  
ventilation by opening the vehicle’s  
doors and windows.  
degreasers can leave residue  
that streaks and attracts dirt. For  
liquid cleaners, about 20 drops  
per gallon (3.78 L) of water  
is a good guide. Use only mild,  
neutral-pH soaps.  
Dust may be removed from small  
buttons and knobs using a small  
brush with soft bristles.  
Notice: Using abrasive cleaners  
when cleaning glass surfaces on  
the vehicle, could scratch the  
glass and/or cause damage to the  
rear window defogger. When  
cleaning the glass on the vehicle,  
use only a soft cloth and glass  
cleaner.  
Products that remove odors from  
the vehicle’s upholstery and  
clean the vehicle’s glass can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Too much cleaner that saturates  
the upholstery.  
Organic solvents such as naptha,  
alcohol, etc. that can damage the  
vehicle’s interior.  
Do not clean the vehicle using:  
A knife or any other sharp object  
to remove a soil from any interior  
surface.  
A stiff brush. It can cause  
damage to the vehicle’s interior  
surfaces.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-68  
Service and Appearance Care  
3. Start on the outside edge of the  
soil and gently rub toward the  
center. Continue cleaning, using  
a clean area of the cloth each  
time it becomes soiled.  
Fabric/Carpet  
Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft  
brush attachment frequently to  
remove dust and loose dirt.  
A canister vacuum with a beater bar  
in the nozzle may only be used  
on floor carpet and carpeted floor  
mats. For any soil, always try  
to remove it first with plain water or  
club soda. Before cleaning,  
gently remove as much of the soil  
as possible using one of the  
following techniques:  
Leather  
A soft cloth dampened with water  
can be used to remove dust. If  
a more thorough cleaning is  
necessary, a soft cloth dampened  
with a mild soap solution can  
be used. Allow the leather to dry  
naturally. Do not use heat to  
dry. Never use steam to clean  
leather. Never use spot lifters or  
spot removers on leather. Many  
commercial leather cleaners  
and coatings that are sold to  
preserve and protect leather may  
permanently change the appearance  
and feel of the leather and are not  
recommended. Do not use  
silicone or wax-based products, or  
those containing organic solvents to  
clean the vehicle’s interior because  
they can alter the appearance  
by increasing the gloss in a  
non-uniform manner. Never use  
shoe polish on leather.  
4. Continue to gently rub the soiled  
area until the cleaning cloth  
remains clean.  
5. If the soil is not completely  
removed, use a mild soap  
solution and repeat the cleaning  
process that was used with  
plain water.  
For liquids: gently blot the  
remaining soil with a paper towel.  
Allow the soil to absorb into  
the paper towel until no more can  
be removed.  
If any of the soil remains, a  
commercial fabric cleaner or spot  
lifter may be necessary. When a  
commercial upholstery cleaner or  
spot lifter is to be used, test a small  
hidden area for colorfastness first. If  
the locally cleaned area gives any  
impression that a ring formation may  
result, clean the entire surface.  
For solid dry soils: remove as  
much as possible and then  
vacuum.  
To clean:  
After the cleaning process has been  
completed, a paper towel can be  
used to blot excess moisture  
from the fabric or carpet.  
1. Saturate a lint-free, clean white  
cloth with water or club soda.  
2. Wring the cloth to remove excess  
moisture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-69  
Some commercial products may  
increase gloss on the instrument  
panel. The increase in gloss  
may cause annoying reflections in  
the windshield and even make  
it difficult to see through the  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl,  
and Other Plastic  
Surfaces  
A soft cloth dampened with water  
may be used to remove dust.  
If a more thorough cleaning is  
necessary, a clean soft cloth  
dampened with a mild soap solution  
can be used to gently remove  
dust and dirt. Never use spot lifters  
or removers on plastic surfaces.  
Many commercial cleaners  
Weatherstrips  
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will  
make them last longer, seal  
better, and not stick or squeak.  
Apply silicone grease with a clean  
cloth. During very cold, damp  
weather frequent application may be  
required. See Recommended  
windshield under certain conditions.  
Care of Safety Belts  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
Fluids and Lubricants on page 6-11.  
Washing Your Vehicle  
The best way to preserve the  
vehicle’s finish is to keep it clean by  
washing it often.  
{ CAUTION  
and coatings that are sold to  
Do not bleach or dye safety belts.  
It may severely weaken them. In  
a crash, they might not be able to  
provide adequate protection.  
Clean safety belts only with mild  
soap and lukewarm water.  
preserve and protect soft plastic  
surfaces may permanently change  
the appearance and feel of the  
interior and are not recommended.  
Do not use silicone or wax-based  
products, or those containing  
organic solvents to clean the  
vehicle’s interior because they can  
alter the appearance by increasing  
the gloss in a non-uniform manner.  
Notice: Certain cleaners contain  
chemicals that can damage  
the emblems or nameplates on  
the vehicle. Check the cleaning  
product label. If it states that  
it should not be used on plastic  
parts, do not use it on the vehicle  
or damage may occur and it  
would not be covered by  
the warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-70  
Service and Appearance Care  
Do not wash the vehicle in direct  
sunlight. Use a car washing  
soap. Do not use cleaning agents  
that are petroleum based or  
that contain acid or abrasives, as  
they can damage the paint, metal or  
plastic on the vehicle. Approved  
cleaning products can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer. Follow  
all manufacturers’ directions  
regarding correct product usage,  
necessary safety precautions  
and appropriate disposal of any  
vehicle care product.  
Dry the finish with a soft, clean  
chamois or an all-cotton towel to  
avoid surface scratches and  
water spotting.  
Finish Care  
Occasional waxing or mild polishing  
of the vehicle by hand may be  
necessary to remove residue from  
the paint finish. Approved cleaning  
products can be obtained from  
your dealer/retailer.  
High pressure car washes may  
cause water to enter the vehicle.  
Avoid using high pressure washes  
closer than 12 inches (30 cm)  
to the surface of the vehicle. Use  
of power washers exceeding  
1,200 psi (8 274 kPa) can result in  
damage or removal of paint and  
decals.  
If the vehicle has a  
basecoat/clearcoat paint finish, the  
clearcoat gives more depth and  
gloss to the colored basecoat.  
Always use waxes and polishes that  
are non-abrasive and made for a  
basecoat/clearcoat paint finish.  
Rinse the vehicle well, before  
washing and after to remove all  
cleaning agents completely. If they  
are allowed to dry on the surface,  
they could stain.  
Cleaning Exterior  
Lamps/Lenses  
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a  
soft cloth and a car washing  
soap to clean exterior lamps and  
lenses. Follow instructions  
page 5-69.  
Notice: Machine compounding  
or aggressive polishing on a  
basecoat/clearcoat paint finish  
may damage it. Use only  
non-abrasive waxes and polishes  
that are made for a  
basecoat/clearcoat paint finish on  
the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-71  
Foreign materials such as calcium  
chloride and other salts, ice  
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal  
Parts  
Windshield and Wiper  
Blades  
Clean the outside of the windshield  
with glass cleaner.  
melting agents, road oil and tar, tree  
sap, bird droppings, chemicals  
from industrial chimneys, etc., can  
damage the vehicle’s finish if  
they remain on painted surfaces.  
Wash the vehicle as soon as  
possible. If necessary, use  
non-abrasive cleaners that are  
marked safe for painted surfaces to  
remove foreign matter.  
Bright metal parts should be  
cleaned regularly to keep their  
luster. Washing with water is all that  
is usually needed. However,  
chrome polish may be used on  
chrome or stainless steel trim, if  
necessary.  
Clean the rubber blades using a lint  
free cloth or paper towel soaked  
with windshield washer fluid  
or a mild detergent. Wash the  
windshield thoroughly when cleaning  
the blades. Bugs, road grime,  
sap, and a buildup of vehicle  
wash/wax treatments may cause  
wiper streaking. Replace the  
wiper blades if they are worn or  
damaged.  
Use special care with aluminum  
trim. To avoid damaging protective  
trim, never use auto or chrome  
polish, steam or caustic soap  
to clean aluminum. A coating of  
wax, rubbed to high polish, is  
recommended for all bright metal  
parts.  
Exterior painted surfaces are  
subject to aging, weather and  
chemical fallout that can take their  
toll over a period of years. To  
help keep the paint finish looking  
new, keep the vehicle garaged  
or covered whenever possible.  
Wipers can be damaged by:  
Extreme dusty conditions  
Sand and salt  
Heat and sun  
Snow and ice, without proper  
removal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-72  
Service and Appearance Care  
Keep the wheels clean using a soft  
clean cloth with mild soap and  
water. Rinse with clean water. After  
rinsing thoroughly, dry with a soft  
clean towel. A wax may then  
be applied.  
Notice: Driving the vehicle  
through an automatic car wash  
that has silicone carbide tire  
cleaning brushes, could damage  
the aluminum or chrome-plated  
wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the warranty. Never  
drive a vehicle equipped with  
aluminum or chrome-plated  
wheels through an automatic car  
wash that uses silicone carbide  
tire cleaning brushes.  
Aluminum Wheels  
Notice: Chrome wheels and  
other chrome trim may be  
damaged if the vehicle is not  
washed after driving on roads  
that have been sprayed with  
magnesium, calcium or sodium  
chloride. These chlorides are  
used on roads for conditions  
such as ice and dust. Always  
wash the vehicle’s chrome with  
soap and water after exposure.  
Notice: Using chrome polish on  
aluminum wheels could damage  
the wheels. The repairs would not  
be covered by the warranty.  
Use chrome polish on chrome  
wheels only.  
The surface of these wheels is  
similar to the painted surface of the  
vehicle. Do not use strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes,  
abrasive cleaners, cleaners with  
acid, or abrasive cleaning brushes  
on them because the surface  
Tires  
Notice: Using strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes,  
cleaners, brushes, or cleaners that  
contain acid on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels, could  
damage the surface of the  
wheel(s). The repairs would not be  
covered by the warranty. Use only  
approved cleaners on aluminum  
or chrome-plated wheels.  
To clean the tires, use a stiff brush  
with tire cleaner.  
Notice: Using petroleum-based  
tire dressing products on the  
vehicle may damage the paint  
finish and/or tires. When applying  
a tire dressing, always wipe off  
any overspray from all painted  
surfaces on the vehicle.  
could be damaged. Do not use  
chrome polish on aluminum wheels.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-73  
Sheet Metal Damage  
Underbody Maintenance  
Chemical Paint Spotting  
If the vehicle is damaged and  
requires sheet metal repair or  
replacement, make sure the body  
repair shop applies anti-corrosion  
material to parts repaired or  
replaced to restore corrosion  
protection.  
Chemicals used for ice and  
snow removal and dust control can  
collect on the underbody. If these  
are not removed, corrosion and rust  
can develop on the underbody  
parts such as fuel lines, frame, floor  
pan, and exhaust system even  
though they have corrosion  
protection.  
Some weather and atmospheric  
conditions can create a chemical  
fallout. Airborne pollutants can  
fall upon and attack painted surfaces  
on the vehicle. This damage can  
take two forms: blotchy, ring-shaped  
discolorations, and small, irregular  
dark spots etched into the paint  
surface.  
Original manufacturer replacement  
parts will provide the corrosion  
protection while maintaining  
the vehicle warranty.  
At least every spring, flush these  
materials from the underbody  
with plain water. Clean any areas  
where mud and debris can collect.  
Dirt packed in close areas of  
the frame should be loosened before  
being flushed. Your dealer/retailer  
or an underbody car washing  
system can do this.  
Although no defect in the paint job  
causes this, we will repair, at no  
charge to the owner, the surfaces of  
new vehicles damaged by this  
fallout condition within 12 months or  
12,000 miles (20 000 km) of  
Finish Damage  
Any stone chips, fractures or deep  
scratches in the finish should  
be repaired right away. Bare metal  
will corrode quickly and may  
develop into major repair expense.  
purchase, whichever occurs first.  
Minor chips and scratches can be  
repaired with touch-up materials  
available from your dealer/retailer.  
Larger areas of finish damage can be  
corrected in your dealer’s/retailer’s  
body and paint shop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-74  
Service and Appearance Care  
Service Parts  
Identification Label  
This label is on the inside of the  
glove box. It is very helpful if parts  
need to be ordered. The label  
has the following information:  
Vehicle Identification  
Electrical System  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN)  
Intermediate Voltage  
Devices and Wiring  
{ CAUTION  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN)  
Exposure to intermediate voltage  
can cause shock and burns. The  
intermediate voltage systems in  
the vehicle can only be serviced by  
technicians with special training.  
This is the legal identifier for the  
vehicle. It appears on a plate in  
the front corner of the instrument  
panel, on the driver side. It can  
be seen through the windshield from  
outside the vehicle. The VIN also  
appears on the Vehicle Certification  
and Service Parts labels and the  
certificates of title and registration.  
Model designation  
Paint information  
Production options and special  
equipment  
Intermediate voltage devices are  
identified by labels. Do not  
Do not remove this label from the  
vehicle.  
remove, open, take apart, or  
modify these devices. Intermediate  
voltage cable or wiring has blue  
covering. Do not probe, tamper  
with, cut, or modify intermediate  
voltage cable or wiring.  
Engine Identification  
The eighth character in the VIN is  
the engine code. This code  
helps identify the vehicle’s engine,  
specifications, and replacement  
parts. See “Engine Specifications”  
on page 5-81 for the vehicle’s  
engine code.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-75  
Add-On Electrical  
Equipment  
Notice: Do not add anything  
electrical to the vehicle unless  
you check with your  
Windshield Wiper Fuses  
Fuses and Circuit  
Breakers  
The wiring circuits in your vehicle  
are protected from short circuits by  
fuses. This greatly reduces the  
chance of circuit overload and fire  
caused by electrical problems.  
The windshield wiper motor is  
protected by a circuit breaker and a  
fuse. If the motor overheats due  
to heavy snow or ice, the wiper will  
stop until the motor cools. If the  
overload is caused by some  
dealer/retailer first. Some  
electrical equipment can damage  
the vehicle and the damage  
would not be covered by the  
vehicle’s warranty. Some add-on  
electrical equipment can keep  
other components from working  
as they should.  
electrical problem, have it fixed.  
There are three fuse blocks - the  
main underhood fuse block,  
the auxiliary hybrid underhood fuse  
block and the instrument panel  
fuse block.  
Power Windows and  
Other Power Options  
Circuit breakers in the fuse block  
protect the power windows and  
other power accessories. When the  
current load is too heavy, the  
circuit breaker opens and closes,  
protecting the circuit until the  
problem is fixed or goes away.  
To identify and check fuses and  
relays, refer to the Fuse Usage  
Chart on the inside surface of the  
fuse panel door.  
Add-on equipment can drain the  
vehicle’s battery, even if the vehicle  
is not operating.  
The vehicle has an airbag system.  
Before attempting to add anything  
electrical to the vehicle, see  
Vehicle on page 1-54.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-76  
Service and Appearance Care  
Instrument Panel Fuse  
Block  
The instrument panel fuse block is  
located on the passenger side  
of the lower console.  
Pull the latch of the fuse box cover  
straight back to access the  
fuses.  
Fuses  
PWR SEAT Power Seat  
Usage  
Fuses  
Usage  
Engine Control  
Module  
PASS  
P/WIN  
DRIV  
P/WIN  
S/ROOF  
CIGAR  
Passenger Side  
Power Window  
Driver Side Power  
Window  
Sunroof Module  
Cigarette Lighter  
ECM/TCM (ECM)/Transmission  
Control Module  
(TCM)  
Fuel Storage Control  
Module  
FSCM  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Service and Appearance Care  
5-77  
Fuses  
Usage  
Inside Rearview  
Mirror  
Instrument Panel  
Cluster  
Fuses  
BCM (VB5)  
TRL  
Usage  
Body Control  
Module (VB5)  
Relays  
Usage  
Accessory, Retained  
Accessory Power  
(RAP) Relay  
ISRVM  
RELAY  
ACC/RAP  
Trailer  
CLUSTER  
RELAY  
RUN/C  
RANK  
AIRCON Air Conditioner  
Run/Crank Relay  
AIR BAG Airbag System  
AUDIO  
BCM (VB7)  
IGN SW  
AIR BAG Air Bag System  
WASHER Washer Pump  
Audio  
Outside Rearview  
Body Control  
Module (VB7)  
Ignition Switch  
OSRVM  
Mirror  
Underhood Fuse Block  
The underhood fuse block is located  
on the driver side of the engine  
compartment, near the battery.  
Key Capture  
Solenoid  
Steering Wheel  
KEY CAP  
WHL S/W  
Switch  
Accessory Power  
Outlet 1  
Fuel Storage Control  
Module  
Rear Closure  
Body Control  
Module (VB2)  
Front Driver Door  
APO1  
F/DR LCK  
Lock  
Notice: Spilling liquid on  
any electrical components on the  
vehicle may damage it. Always  
keep the covers on any electrical  
component.  
Accessory Power  
Outlet 2  
FSCM  
APO2  
RR CLR  
Body Control  
BCM (VB3) Module (BCM)  
(VB3)  
BCM (VB2)  
DR LCK  
Door Lock  
Body Control  
Module (VB6)  
Body Control  
Module (VB4)  
Daytime Running  
Light  
DRL  
BCM (VB6)  
Body Control  
Module (VB1)  
BCM (VB1)  
BCM (VB4)  
ONSTAR OnStar®  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-78  
Service and Appearance Care  
Fuses  
Usage  
Engine Control  
Module  
ECM  
ENG-3  
ENG-2  
ENG-1  
Engine 3  
Engine 2  
Engine 1  
HYBRID  
BEC  
Hybrid BEC  
RUN  
Run  
S/ROOF  
Sunroof Module  
Heated Seat Control  
Module  
Body Control  
Module  
HTD/SEAT  
BCM  
STRTR  
WPR  
Starter Motor  
Windshield Wiper  
All-Wheel Drive  
System  
Antilock Brake  
System Module  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
Usage  
4WD/ESCM  
ABS  
FAN MAIN Cooling Fan Main  
REAR/WPR Rear Wiper Motor  
Engine Control  
Module/Transmission  
Control  
Module/Serial Data  
Gateway  
Communication  
Module  
ECM/TCM/  
SGCM  
Cooling Fan  
Auxiliary  
FAN AUX  
Air Conditioning  
Compressor  
A/C CLTCH  
BLWR MTR Blower Motor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-79  
Fuses  
AMP  
HORN  
Usage  
Amplifier  
Horn  
Antilock Brake  
System Module  
Instrument Panel  
Bussed Electrical  
Center  
Fuses  
Usage  
Relays  
STRTR  
RLY  
Usage  
Starter Relay  
Driver Side  
Low-Beam  
Headlamp  
Passenger Side  
Low-Beam  
Headlamp  
Driver Side  
High-Beam  
Headlamp  
Outside Rearview  
Mirror Heating  
HDLP  
LO RT  
RUN RLY Run Relay  
ABS  
A/C CLTCH Air Conditioning  
HDLP  
LO LT  
RLY  
Compressor Relay  
I/P BEC  
WPR SPD Windshield Wiper  
RLY Speed Relay  
HORN RLY Horn Relay  
WPR  
CNTRL  
RLY  
HDLP  
HI RT  
FRT FOG Front Fog Lamps  
Instrument Panel  
I/P BEC  
OSRVM  
HTR  
Windshield Wiper  
Control Relay  
Bussed Electrical  
Center  
Daytime Running  
Light  
Right Turn and  
Parking Lamps  
Left Turn and  
Parking Lamps  
Trailer Parking  
Lamps  
Passenger Side  
T/LAMP  
RLY  
HDLP  
HI RLY  
HDLP  
LO RLY  
DRL  
Parking Lamp Relay  
Relays  
Usage  
High-Beam  
Headlamp Relay  
Low-Beam  
Headlamp Relay  
T/LAMP RT  
T/LAMP LT  
FAN MAIN Cooling Fan Main  
RLY Relay  
FAN CTRL Cooling Fan Control  
RLY Relay  
TRLR  
T/LAMP  
FRT FOG Front Foglamp  
FAN AUX Cooling Fan  
RLY  
STOP  
LP RLY  
DEFOG  
RLY  
Relay  
RLY  
Auxiliary Relay  
Engine Control  
Module/CAM,  
Canister, Injectors,  
Electronic Throttle  
Control Relay  
Stoplamp Relay  
HDLP HI LT High-Beam  
Headlamp  
STOP LP Stoplamps  
PWR/TRN  
RLY  
Defogger Relay  
DEFOG  
Defroster Fog  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-80  
Service and Appearance Care  
Fuses  
Usage  
Relays  
Usage  
HYBRID  
PUMPS  
HILL HOLD  
VLVS  
Hybrid Pumps  
Hill Hold Valves  
HILL HOLD  
VLVS  
Auxiliary  
Transmission  
Pump  
Hill Hold Valves  
AUX  
TRANSPUMP  
Auxiliary  
Transmission  
Pump  
AUX  
TRANSPUMP  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Appearance Care  
5-81  
Capacities and Specifications  
Capacities  
Application  
English  
Metric  
For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge  
amount, see the refrigerant caution label located  
under the hood. See your retailer for more  
information.  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a  
Cooling System  
Engine Oil with Filter  
Fuel Tank  
Transmission (Bottom Pan Removal)  
Wheel Nut Torque  
9.5 qt  
5.0 qt  
18.0 gal  
6.9 qt  
9.0 L  
4.7 L  
68.1 L  
6.5 L  
100 ft lb  
140 Y  
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this  
manual. Recheck fluid level after filling.  
Engine Specifications  
Engine  
2.4L L4 Engine  
VIN Code  
Transmission  
Spark Plug Gap  
Z
Automatic  
0.040 in (1.01 mm)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5-82  
Service and Appearance Care  
NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Schedule  
6-1  
Maintenance  
Schedule  
Maintenance  
Schedule  
Introduction  
Important: Keep engine oil at the  
proper level and change as  
recommended.  
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance  
Requirements  
Notice: Maintenance intervals,  
checks, inspections, replacement  
parts, and recommended fluids  
and lubricants as prescribed  
in this manual are necessary to  
keep this vehicle in good working  
condition. Any damage caused  
by failure to follow scheduled  
maintenance might not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-2  
Maintenance Schedule  
the vehicle in making deliveries. Or  
you might drive it to work, to do  
errands, or in many other ways.  
on page 6-5 and Maintenance  
Footnotes on page 6-7 for further  
information.  
Your Vehicle and the  
Environment  
Proper vehicle maintenance not only  
helps to keep the vehicle in good  
working condition, but also helps the  
environment. All recommended  
maintenance is important. Improper  
vehicle maintenance can even  
affect the quality of the air we  
breathe. Improper fluid levels or the  
wrong tire inflation can increase  
the level of emissions from the  
vehicle. To help protect the  
Because of all the different  
ways people use their vehicles,  
maintenance needs vary. You might  
need more frequent checks and  
replacements. So please read the  
following and note how you  
drive. If you have any questions on  
how to keep the vehicle in good  
condition, see your dealer/retailer.  
{ CAUTION  
Performing maintenance work on  
a vehicle can be dangerous. In  
trying to do some jobs, you can  
be seriously injured. Do your own  
maintenance work only if you  
have the required know-how and  
the proper tools and equipment  
for the job. If you have any doubt,  
see your dealer/retailer to have a  
qualified technician do the work.  
Work on page 5-4.  
This schedule is for vehicles that:  
environment, and to keep the  
vehicle in good condition, be sure to  
maintain the vehicle properly.  
carry passengers and cargo  
within recommended limits on the  
Tire and Loading Information  
label. See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 4-18.  
Using the Maintenance  
Schedule  
We want to help keep this vehicle in  
good working condition. But we  
do not know exactly how you  
will drive it. You might drive very  
short distances only a few times a  
week. Or you might drive long  
distances all the time in very hot,  
dusty weather. You might use  
are driven on reasonable road  
surfaces within legal driving limits.  
Some maintenance services can be  
complex. So, unless you are  
technically qualified and have the  
necessary equipment, have  
use the recommended fuel. See  
Gasoline Octane on page 5-5.  
your dealer/retailer do these jobs.  
The services in Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 6-3 should be  
performed when indicated. See  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance Schedule  
6-3  
When you go to your dealer/retailer  
for service, trained and supported  
service technicians will perform  
the work using genuine parts.  
If the engine oil life system is ever  
reset accidentally, service the  
vehicle within 3,000 miles  
(5 000 km) since the last service.  
Remember to reset the oil life  
system whenever the oil is changed.  
page 5-14 for information on  
the Engine Oil Life System and  
resetting the system.  
Scheduled Maintenance  
When the Change Engine Oil  
light displays, service is required for  
the vehicle. Have the vehicle  
serviced as soon as possible within  
the next 600 miles (1 000 km). It  
is possible that, if driving under the  
best conditions, the engine oil  
life system may not indicate that  
vehicle service is necessary for over  
a year. However, the engine oil  
and filter must be changed at least  
once a year and at this time the  
system must be reset. Your  
To purchase service information,  
Information on page 7-13.  
page 6-8 tells what should be  
checked, when to check it, and what  
can easily be done to help keep  
the vehicle in good condition.  
When the Change Engine Oil light  
appears, certain services, checks,  
and inspections are required.  
Required services are described in  
the following for “Maintenance I”  
and “Maintenance II.” Generally, it is  
recommended that the first service  
be Maintenance I, the second  
service be Maintenance II, and then  
alternate Maintenance I and  
The proper replacement parts,  
fluids, and lubricants to use  
dealer/retailer has trained service  
technicians who will perform  
this work using genuine parts and  
reset the system.  
are listed in Recommended Fluids  
and Lubricants on page 6-11  
Parts on page 6-12. When the  
vehicle is serviced, make sure these  
are used. All parts should be  
replaced and all necessary repairs  
done before you or anyone else  
drives the vehicle. We recommend  
the use of genuine parts from  
your dealer/retailer.  
Maintenance II thereafter. However,  
in some cases, Maintenance II  
may be required more often.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-4  
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance I — Use  
Maintenance II — Use  
Maintenance II if the previous  
service performed was  
Maintenance II whenever the light  
displays 10 months or more since  
the last service or if the light has not  
come on at all for one year.  
Maintenance I if the Change Engine  
Oil light displays within 10 months  
since the vehicle was purchased or  
Maintenance II was performed.  
Maintenance I. Always use  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Service  
Maintenance I Maintenance II  
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on page 5-11. Reset oil life  
system. See Engine Oil Life System on page 5-14. An Emission Control  
Service.  
Visually check for any leaks or damage. See footnote (j).  
Inspect engine air cleaner filter. If necessary, replace filter. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 5-15. See footnote (l).  
Rotate tires and check inflation pressures and wear. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 5-50 and “Tire Wear Inspection” in At Least Once a Month  
on page 6-9.  
Inspect brake system. See footnote (a).  
Check engine coolant and windshield washer fluid levels and add fluid as  
needed.  
Perform any needed additional services. See “Additional Required Services”  
in this section.  
Inspect suspension and steering components. See footnote (b).  
Inspect engine cooling system. See footnote (c).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Schedule  
6-5  
Scheduled Maintenance (cont’d)  
Service  
Maintenance I Maintenance II  
Inspect wiper blades. See footnote (d).  
Inspect restraint system components. See footnote (e).  
Lubricate body components. See footnote (f).  
Replace passenger compartment air filter. See footnote (k).  
Inspect throttle system. See footnote (g).  
Additional Required Services  
The following services should be performed at the first maintenance service (I or II) after the indicated miles  
(kilometers) shown for each item.  
Additional Required Services  
25,000  
(40 000)  
50,000  
75,000  
100,000  
125,000  
150,000  
Service and Miles (Kilometers)  
(80 000) (120 000) (160 000) (200 000) (240 000)  
Inspect fuel system for damage or  
leaks.  
Inspect exhaust system for loose or  
damaged components.  
Replace engine air cleaner filter. See  
Change automatic transmission fluid  
(severe service). See footnote (h).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-6  
Maintenance Schedule  
Additional Required Services (cont’d)  
25,000  
(40 000)  
50,000  
75,000  
100,000  
125,000  
150,000  
Service and Miles (Kilometers)  
(80 000) (120 000) (160 000) (200 000) (240 000)  
Change automatic transmission fluid  
(normal service).  
Replace spark plugs. An Emission  
Control Service.  
Engine cooling system service  
(or every five years, whichever occurs  
first). An Emission Control Service.  
See footnote (i).  
Inspect engine accessory drive belt.  
An Emission Control Service. See  
footnote (m).  
Vehicles with DOT-4 brake fluid  
only: Change brake hydraulic fluid at  
a regular maintenance service every  
two years. See footnote (n).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Schedule  
6-7  
(d) Inspect wiper blades for wear,  
cracking, or contamination.  
Clean the windshield and wiper  
blades, if contaminated. Replace  
wiper blades that are worn or  
damaged. See Windshield Wiper  
Blade Replacement on page 5-38  
Blades on page 5-71 for more  
information.  
environment. Applying silicone  
Maintenance Footnotes  
grease on weatherstrips with a clean  
cloth will make them last longer,  
seal better, and not stick or squeak.  
(a) Visually inspect brake lines  
and hoses for proper hook-up,  
binding, leaks, cracks, chafing, etc.  
Inspect disc brake pads for wear  
and rotors for surface condition.  
Inspect other brake parts, including  
calipers, parking brake, etc.  
(g) Check system for interference  
or binding and for damaged or  
missing parts. Replace parts  
as needed. Replace any  
components that have high effort or  
excessive wear.  
(b) Visually inspect front and rear  
suspension and steering system for  
damaged, loose, or missing parts  
or signs of wear.  
(e) Make sure the safety belt  
reminder light and safety belt  
assemblies are working properly.  
Look for any other loose or  
damaged safety belt system parts.  
If you see anything that might  
keep a safety belt system from doing  
its job, have it repaired. Have any  
torn or frayed safety belts replaced.  
Systems on page 1-56.  
(h) Severe service is when the  
vehicle is mainly driven under one  
or more of these conditions:  
(c) Visually inspect hoses and have  
them replaced if they are cracked,  
swollen, or deteriorated. Inspect  
all pipes, fittings, and clamps;  
replace with genuine parts as  
needed. To help ensure proper  
operation, a pressure test of  
the cooling system and pressure  
cap and cleaning the outside of the  
radiator and air conditioning  
condenser is recommended at least  
once a year.  
In heavy city traffic where the  
outside temperature regularly  
reaches 90°F (32°C) or higher.  
In hilly or mountainous terrain.  
When doing frequent trailer  
towing.  
Uses such as found in taxi,  
(f) Lubricate all key lock cylinders,  
door hinges and latches, hood  
hinges and latches, glove box  
hinges, sunroof (if equipped), and  
any folding seat hardware. More  
frequent lubrication may be required  
when exposed to a corrosive  
police, or delivery service.  
(i) Drain, flush, and refill cooling  
system. This service can be  
complex; you should have your  
dealer/retailer perform this service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-8  
Maintenance Schedule  
See Engine Coolant on page 5-20  
for what to use. Inspect hoses. Clean  
radiator, condenser, pressure cap,  
and filler neck. Pressure test the  
cooling system and pressure cap.  
your dealer/retailer perform this  
service. See Brakes on page 5-25  
Lubricants on page 6-11.  
At Each Fuel Fill  
It is important to perform these  
underhood checks at each fuel fill.  
Engine Oil Level Check  
Owner Checks and  
Services  
(j) A fluid loss in any vehicle system  
could indicate a problem. Have  
the system inspected and repaired  
and the fluid level checked. Add  
fluid if needed.  
Notice: It is important to check  
the engine oil regularly and  
keep it at the proper level. Failure  
to keep the engine oil at the  
proper level can cause damage to  
the engine not covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
These owner checks and services  
should be performed at the intervals  
specified to help ensure vehicle  
safety, dependability, and emission  
control performance. Your dealer/  
retailer can assist with these checks  
and services.  
(k) Or every 12 months, whichever  
occurs first. If driving regularly  
under dusty conditions, the filter may  
require replacement more often.  
Check the engine oil level and add  
the proper oil if necessary. See  
Engine Oil on page 5-11.  
Be sure any necessary repairs are  
completed at once. Whenever  
any fluids or lubricants are added to  
the vehicle, make sure they are  
the proper ones, as shown in  
(l) If driving regularly under dusty  
conditions, inspect the filter at each  
engine oil change.  
Engine Coolant Level Check  
Check the engine coolant level  
and add DEX-COOL® coolant  
mixture if necessary. See Engine  
Coolant on page 5-20.  
(m) Visually inspect belt for fraying,  
excessive cracks, or obvious  
damage. Replace belt if necessary.  
Lubricants on page 6-11.  
(n) Vehicles using DOT-4 brake  
fluid only: Drain, flush, and  
refill brake hydraulic system at a  
regular maintenance service (I or II)  
every two years. This service can  
be complex; you should have  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance Schedule  
6-9  
Windshield Washer Fluid  
Level Check  
Automatic Transmission Shift  
Lock Control System Check  
At Least Once a Year  
Starter Switch Check  
Check the windshield washer fluid  
level in the windshield washer  
fluid reservoir and add the proper  
fluid if necessary.  
{ CAUTION  
{ CAUTION  
When you are doing this  
When you are doing this  
inspection, the vehicle could move  
suddenly. If the vehicle moves,  
you or others could be injured.  
inspection, the vehicle could move  
suddenly. If the vehicle moves,  
you or others could be injured.  
At Least Once a Month  
Tire Inspection and Inflation  
Check  
1. Before starting this check, be  
sure there is enough room  
around the vehicle. It should be  
parked on a level surface.  
1. Before starting this check, be  
sure there is enough room  
around the vehicle.  
Inspect the vehicle’s tires for wear  
and make sure they are inflated  
to the correct pressures. See  
page 5-43.  
2. Firmly apply both the parking  
brake and the regular brake.  
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.  
See Parking Brake on page 2-22.  
See Parking Brake on page 2-22.  
Be ready to apply the regular  
brake immediately if the vehicle  
begins to move.  
Do not use the accelerator  
pedal, and be ready to turn off  
the engine immediately if it starts.  
3. With the engine off, turn the  
ignition to ON/RUN, but do  
3. Try to start the engine in  
each gear. The vehicle should  
start only in P (Park) or  
not start the engine. Without  
applying the regular brake, try to  
move the shift lever out of  
N (Neutral). If the vehicle starts  
in any other position, contact  
your dealer/retailer for service.  
P (Park) with normal effort. If the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-10  
Maintenance Schedule  
shift lever moves out of P (Park),  
contact your dealer/retailer for  
service.  
Parking Brake and Automatic  
Transmission P (Park)  
Mechanism Check  
To check the P (Park)  
mechanism’s holding ability: With  
the engine running, shift to  
P (Park). Then release the  
parking brake followed by the  
regular brake.  
Ignition Transmission Lock  
Check  
{ CAUTION  
While parked, and with the parking  
brake set, try to turn the ignition  
to LOCK/OFF in each shift  
lever position.  
When you are doing this check,  
the vehicle could begin to move.  
You or others could be injured  
and property could be damaged.  
Make sure there is room in front  
of the vehicle in case it begins to  
roll. Be ready to apply the regular  
brake at once should the vehicle  
begin to move.  
Contact your dealer/retailer if  
service is required.  
Underbody Flushing Service  
The ignition should turn to  
LOCK/OFF only when the  
shift lever is in P (Park).  
At least every spring, use plain  
water to flush any corrosive  
materials from the underbody. Take  
care to clean thoroughly any  
areas where mud and other debris  
can collect.  
The ignition key should come out  
only in LOCK/OFF.  
Contact your dealer/retailer if  
service is required.  
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the  
vehicle facing downhill. Keeping  
your foot on the regular brake, set  
the parking brake.  
Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit  
Check the sealant expiration date  
printed on the instruction label of the  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
at least once a year. See your  
dealer/retailer for a replacement  
canister.  
To check the parking brake’s  
holding ability: With the engine  
running and the transmission in  
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot  
pressure from the regular brake  
pedal. Do this until the vehicle is  
held by the parking brake only.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Schedule  
6-11  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  
Fluids and lubricants identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your  
dealer/retailer.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Engine oil which meets GM Standard GM6094M and displays the  
American Petroleum Institute Certified for Gasoline Engines starburst  
Engine Oil  
symbol. To determine the proper viscosity for your vehicle’s engine, see  
Engine Oil on page 5-11.  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and use only DEX-COOL®  
Engine Coolant  
Coolant. See Engine Coolant on page 5-20.  
Vehicles with DOT-3 brake fluid only: Delco® Supreme 11 Brake Fluid or  
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid.  
Hydraulic Brake System  
Vehicles with DOT-4 brake fluid only: DOT-4 Brake Fluid (GM Part  
No. U.S. 88862828, in Canada 88862829).  
Optikleen® Washer Solvent.  
Chassis Lubricant (GM Part No. 12377985, in Canada 88901242) or  
lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
Windshield Washer  
Parking Brake Cable Guides  
Automatic Transmission  
Key Lock Cylinders  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. U.S. 12346241,  
in Canada 10953474).  
Hood Latch Assembly, Secondary  
Latch, Pivots, Spring Anchor, and  
Release Pawl  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol (Saturn Part No. 21038869 or GM Part No.  
U.S. 12346293, in Canada 992723) or lubricant meeting requirements of  
NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.  
Hood, Liftgate Door, and Rear  
Folding Seat Hinges  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-12  
Maintenance Schedule  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol (Saturn Part No. 21038869 or GM Part  
No. U.S. 12346293, in Canada 992723) or lubricant meeting requirements  
of NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.  
Sunroof Track  
Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM Part No. U.S. 3634770, in Canada 10953518)  
or Dielectric Silicone Grease (GM Part No. U.S. 12345579,  
in Canada 992887).  
Weatherstrip Conditioning  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your retailer.  
Part  
GM Part Number  
96815102  
ACDelco Part Number  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
Engine Oil Filter  
PF457G  
12605566  
19130294  
12625058  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter Element  
Spark Plugs  
41-103  
Wiper Blades  
Driver Side – 24 in (60.0 cm)  
Passenger Side – 16 in (40.0 cm)  
Rear – 12.0 in (30.0 cm)  
25925618  
25925620  
96624648  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance Schedule  
6-13  
Engine Drive Belt  
Routing  
The engine drive belt on this hybrid  
vehicle is under a higher tension  
than the engine drive belt on  
a non-hybrid vehicle and requires a  
special tool to service. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6-14  
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Record  
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the  
type of services performed in the boxes provided. See Maintenance Requirements on page 6-1. Any additional  
information from Owner Checks and Services on page 6-8 can be added on the following record pages. You should  
retain all maintenance receipts.  
Maintenance Record  
Odometer  
Reading  
Maintenance I or  
Maintenance II  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance Schedule  
6-15  
Maintenance Record (cont’d)  
Odometer  
Reading  
Maintenance I or  
Maintenance II  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-16  
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Record (cont’d)  
Odometer  
Reading  
Maintenance I or  
Maintenance II  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance Information  
7-1  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
and Information  
Customer  
Assistance  
Information  
Customer Satisfaction  
Procedure  
Your satisfaction and goodwill are  
important to your retailer and to  
Saturn. Together we are committed  
to providing our customers with  
unparalleled service, before, during,  
and after the purchase of a  
Saturn vehicle, for total customer  
satisfaction. We call this the Saturn  
Difference. Normally, any concerns  
with the sales transaction or the  
operation of the vehicle are resolved  
by the retailer’s sales or service  
departments. If, for any reason, your  
ownership experience falls below  
your expectations, we suggest  
you take the following action:  
Customer Assistance  
and Information  
Vehicle Data Recording  
and Privacy  
STEP ONE: Contact the Retail  
Customer Assistance Liaison. Any  
member of the retail management  
team has the authority and the  
desire to resolve your concerns.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-2  
Customer Assistance Information  
Normally, concerns can be quickly  
resolved at this level.  
driver side corner of the  
instrument panel, or on your  
roadside assistance key card.  
assistance of a neutral party  
through our voluntary participation in  
a mediation/arbitration program  
called Better Business Bureau  
(BBB) Auto Line.  
STEP TWO: Should you need  
additional assistance, in the U.S.,  
contact the Saturn Customer  
The name of your selling and  
servicing retail facility.  
Assistance Center by calling  
The BBB Auto Line Program is an  
out-of-court program administered  
by the Council of Better Business  
Bureaus to settle automotive  
disputes regarding vehicle repairs or  
the interpretation of the New  
Vehicle Limited Warranty. This  
program is available at no cost to  
you, our customer.  
Vehicle delivery date and present  
mileage.  
1-800-553-6000. In Canada, call the  
Saturn Customer Communication  
Centre at 1-800-263-1999. A Saturn  
Customer Assistance Center team  
member will handle your call and  
assist in providing product and  
warranty information, the nearest  
retailer location, roadside assistance,  
brochures, literature and discuss any  
concerns you may have.  
Your daytime and evening phone  
numbers.  
When contacting Saturn, please  
remember that your concern  
will likely be resolved at a retailer’s  
facility. That is why we suggest  
you follow Step One first.  
Although you may be required to  
resort to this informal dispute  
STEP THREE (U.S. Owners): Both  
Saturn and its retailers are  
We encourage you to call the toll-free  
number in order to give your inquiry  
prompt attention. Please have the  
following information available to  
give the Customer Assistance  
Representative:  
resolution program prior to filing a  
court action, use of the program  
is free of charge and your case is  
generally heard within 40 days.  
If you do not agree with the decision  
given in your case, you can reject  
it and proceed with any other venue  
for relief available to you.  
committed to making sure you are  
completely satisfied with your Saturn  
vehicle. However, if you continue  
to remain unsatisfied after following  
the procedure outlined in Steps  
One and Two, Saturn and its  
Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN). This 17-digit number can  
be found on the vehicle  
retailers offer the additional  
registration or title, on the upper  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance Information  
7-3  
Contact the BBB Auto Line Program  
by using the toll-free telephone  
number or by writing them at  
the following address:  
STEP THREE (Canadian Owners):  
For further information concerning  
eligibility in the Canadian Motor  
Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP),  
call toll-free 1-800-207-0685.  
Alternatively, you may call the  
Saturn Customer Communication  
Centre, 1-800-263-1999, or you may  
write to:  
General Motors Participation in  
the Mediation/Arbitration Program  
In the event that you do not feel  
your concerns have been addressed  
after following the procedure  
outlined in Steps 1 and 2, General  
Motors of Canada Limited has  
committed to binding arbitration of  
owner disputes involving  
factory-related vehicle service  
claims. The program provides for  
the review of the facts involved  
by an impartial third party arbiter,  
and may include an informal hearing  
before the arbiter. The program is  
designed so that the entire  
dispute settlement process, from the  
time you file your complaint to the  
final decision, should be completed  
in approximately 70 days. We  
believe our impartial program offers  
advantages over courts in most  
jurisdictions because it is informal,  
quick, and free of charge.  
BBB Auto Line Program  
Council of Better Business  
Bureaus, Inc.  
4200 Wilson Boulevard  
Suite 800  
Arlington, VA 22203-1838  
Mediation/Arbitration Program  
c/o Customer Communication  
Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
dr.bbb.org/goauto  
This program is available in all  
50 states and the District of  
Columbia. Eligibility is limited by  
vehicle age, mileage and other  
factors. Saturn Corporation reserves  
the right to change eligibility  
limitations and/or discontinue its  
participation in this program.  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
Your inquiry should be accompanied  
by the Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-4  
Customer Assistance Information  
Help Center —  
www.saturn.com/helpcenter  
a service appointment by adding  
the vehicles you own to your  
driveway profile.  
Online Owner Center  
Online Owner Center (U.S.) —  
www.gmownercenter.com/  
saturn  
FAQ  
My Preferences: Manage your  
profile and use tools and forms  
with greater ease.  
Contact Us  
Information and services customized  
for your specific vehicle — all in  
one convenient place.  
My GM Canada (Canada) —  
www.gm.ca  
To sign up, visit the My GM Canada  
section within www.gm.ca.  
My GM Canada is a  
Digital owner manual, warranty  
information, and more  
password-protected section of  
www.gm.ca where you can save  
information on GM vehicles, get  
personalized offers, and use handy  
tools and forms with greater ease.  
Customer Assistance for  
Text Telephone (TTY)  
Users  
To assist owners who have hearing  
difficulties, Saturn has installed  
special TDD (Telecommunication  
Devices for the Deaf) equipment in  
its Saturn Customer Assistance  
Center.  
Online service and maintenance  
records  
Find Saturn retailers for service  
nationwide  
Here are a few of the valuable tools  
and services you will have access to:  
Exclusive privileges and offers  
My Showroom: Find and save  
information on vehicles and  
current offers in your area.  
Recall notices for your specific  
vehicle  
OnStar® and GM Cardmember  
Services Earnings summaries  
My Dealers/Retailers: Save  
details such as address and  
phone number for each of your  
preferred GM dealers/retailers.  
Any hearing or speech-impaired  
customer who has access to a TDD  
or to a conventional Text Telephone  
(TTY) can communicate with  
Saturn by dialing 1-800-TDD-6000.  
TTY users in Canada may dial  
1-800-263-3830.  
Other Helpful Links:  
Saturn www.saturn.com  
My Driveway: Access quick links  
to parts and service estimates,  
check trade-in values, or schedule  
Saturn Merchandise —  
www.saturncollection.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance Information  
7-5  
In Canada, customers may call the  
Saturn Customer Communication  
Centre at 1-800-263-1999. TTY  
users in Canada may call  
Customer Assistance  
Offices  
Saturn encourages customers to  
call the toll-free number for  
assistance. If a customer wishes to  
write to Saturn, the letter should  
be addressed to:  
GM Mobility  
Reimbursement Program  
1-800-263-3830.  
Roadside Assistance  
Program  
For U.S. purchased vehicles, call  
1-800-553-6000; (Text Telephone  
(TTY): 1-800-889-2438).  
This program, available to qualified  
applicants, can reimburse you up to  
$1,000 toward eligible aftermarket  
driver or passenger adaptive  
equipment you may require for your  
vehicle such as hand controls,  
wheelchair/scooter lifts, etc.  
Saturn Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33173  
Detroit, MI 48232-5173  
1-800-553-6000  
1-800-833-6000 (For Text  
Telephone devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance:  
1-800-553-6000  
For Canadian purchased vehicles,  
call 1-800-268-6800.  
The offer is available for a limited  
period of time from the date of  
vehicle purchase/lease.  
Service is available 24 hours a day,  
365 days a year.  
In Canada, write to:  
Saturn Customer Communication  
Centre  
General Motors of Canada Ltd.  
CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
GMcanada.com  
1-800-263-1999  
1-800-263-3830 (For Text  
Telephone devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance:  
1-800-268-6800  
Calling for Assistance  
For more details, or to determine  
your vehicle’s eligibility, visit  
your Saturn retailer or call the  
Saturn Customer Assistance Center  
at 1-800-553-6000. Text telephone  
(TTY) users, call 1-800-833-6000.  
When calling Roadside Assistance,  
have the following information  
ready:  
Your name, home address, and  
home telephone number  
Telephone number of your  
location  
Location of the vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-6  
Customer Assistance Information  
owner or driver if they decide the  
Model, year, color, and license  
plate number of the vehicle  
Flat Tire Change: Service is  
provided to change a flat tire  
with the spare tire. The spare tire,  
if equipped, must be in good  
condition and properly inflated. It  
is the owner’s responsibility  
for the repair or replacement of  
the tire if it is not covered by  
the warranty.  
claims are made too often, or  
the same type of claim is made  
many times.  
Odometer reading, Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN), and  
delivery date of the vehicle  
Services Provided  
Description of the problem  
Emergency Fuel Delivery:  
Delivery of enough fuel for  
the vehicle to get to the nearest  
service station.  
Coverage  
Services are provided up to 5 years/  
100,000 miles (160 000 km),  
whichever comes first.  
Battery Jump Start: Service is  
provided to jump start a dead  
battery.  
Lock-Out Service: Service is  
provided to unlock the vehicle  
if you are locked out. A remote  
unlock may be available if  
you have OnStar®. For security  
reasons, the driver must  
In the U.S., anyone driving the  
vehicle is covered. In Canada, a  
person driving the vehicle without  
permission from the owner is  
not covered.  
Trip Interruption Benefits and  
Assistance: If your trip is  
interrupted due to a warranty  
failure, incidental expenses may  
be reimbursed during the 5 years/  
100,000 miles (160 000 km)  
Powertrain warranty period. Items  
considered are hotel, meals, and  
rental car.  
present identification before this  
service is given.  
Roadside Assistance is not a part of  
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.  
Saturn and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to  
make any changes or discontinue  
the Roadside Assistance program at  
any time without notification.  
Emergency Tow From a Public  
Road or Highway: Tow to the  
nearest Saturn retailer for  
warranty service, or if the vehicle  
was in a crash and cannot be  
driven. Assistance is also  
given when the vehicle is stuck  
in sand, mud, or snow.  
Services Not Included in  
Roadside Assistance  
Impound towing caused by  
violation of any laws.  
Saturn and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to  
limit services or payment to an  
Legal fines.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance Information  
7-7  
Mounting, dismounting or  
changing of snow tires, chains,  
or other traction devices.  
Trip Interruption Benefits and  
Scheduling Service  
Appointments  
Assistance: Must be over  
250 kilometres from where  
your trip was started to  
When your vehicle requires warranty  
service, contact your dealer/retailer  
and request an appointment. By  
scheduling a service appointment  
and advising your service consultant  
of your transportation needs, your  
dealer/retailer can help minimize  
your inconvenience.  
Towing or services for vehicles  
driven on a non-public road or  
highway.  
qualify. General Motors of  
Canada Limited requires  
pre-authorization, original  
detailed receipts, and a copy  
of the repair orders. Once  
authorization has been received,  
the Roadside Assistance  
advisor will help you make  
arrangements and explain how  
to receive payment.  
Services Specific to Canadian  
Purchased Vehicles  
Fuel delivery: Reimbursement is  
approximately $5 Canadian.  
Diesel fuel delivery may  
be restricted. Propane and other  
fuels are not provided through  
this service.  
If your vehicle cannot be scheduled  
into the service department  
immediately, keep driving it until it  
can be scheduled for service,  
unless, of course, the problem is  
safety-related. If it is, please  
Alternative Service: If  
assistance cannot be provided  
right away, the Roadside  
Lock-Out Service: Vehicle  
registration is required.  
Assistance advisor may give  
you permission to get local  
emergency road service. You will  
receive payment, up to $100,  
after sending the original receipt  
to Roadside Assistance.  
Mechanical failures may be  
covered, however any cost for  
parts and labor for repairs  
not covered by the warranty are  
the owner responsibility.  
call your dealership/retailer, let them  
know this, and ask for instructions.  
Trip Routing Service: Detailed  
maps of North America are  
provided when requested either  
with the most direct route or  
the most scenic route. There is a  
limit of six requests per year.  
Additional travel information  
is also available. Allow three  
weeks for delivery.  
If the dealer/retailer requests  
you to bring the vehicle for service,  
you are urged to do so as early  
in the work day as possible to allow  
for the same day repair.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-8  
Customer Assistance Information  
retailer’s shuttle service, the  
expense must be supported by  
original receipts and can only be up  
to the maximum amount allowed  
by Saturn for shuttle service.  
In addition, for U.S. customers,  
should you arrange transportation  
through a friend or relative,  
Transportation Options  
Courtesy Transportation  
To enhance your ownership  
Warranty service can generally be  
completed while you wait. However,  
if you are unable to wait, Saturn  
helps to minimize your  
inconvenience by providing several  
transportation options. Depending  
on the circumstances, your  
retailer can offer you one of the  
following:  
experience, we and our participating  
retailers are proud to offer Courtesy  
Transportation, a customer  
support program for vehicles with  
the Bumper to Bumper (Base  
Warranty Coverage period in  
Canada), extended powertrain, and  
hybrid specific warranties in both  
the U.S. and Canada.  
limited reimbursement for  
reasonable fuel expenses may be  
available. Claim amounts should  
reflect actual costs and be  
supported by original receipts. See  
your retailer for information  
regarding the allowance amounts for  
reimbursement of fuel or other  
transportation costs.  
Shuttle Service  
Several courtesy transportation  
options are available to assist  
in reducing your inconvenience  
when warranty repairs are required.  
Shuttle service is the preferred  
means of offering Courtesy  
Transportation. Retailers may  
provide you with shuttle service to  
get you to your destination with  
minimal interruption of your daily  
schedule. This includes one-way or  
round trip shuttle service within  
reasonable time and distance  
parameters of the retailer’s area.  
Courtesy Transportation is not a  
part of the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty. A separate booklet  
entitled “Warranty and Owner  
Assistance Information” furnished  
with each new vehicle provides  
detailed warranty coverage  
information.  
Courtesy Rental Vehicle  
Your retailer may arrange to provide  
you with a courtesy rental vehicle or  
reimburse you for a rental vehicle  
that you obtain if your vehicle is kept  
for an overnight warranty repair.  
Rental reimbursement will be limited  
and must be supported by original  
receipts. This requires that you sign  
and complete a rental agreement  
Public Transportation or Fuel  
Reimbursement  
If your vehicle requires overnight  
warranty repairs, and public  
transportation is used instead of the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance Information  
7-9  
and meet state/ provincial, local, and  
rental vehicle provider requirements.  
Requirements vary and may include  
minimum age requirements,  
insurance coverage, credit card,  
etc. You are responsible for fuel  
usage charges and may also be  
responsible for taxes, levies, usage  
fees, excessive mileage, or rental  
usage beyond the completion of the  
repair.  
at any time and to resolve all  
of Genuine GM parts can help  
maintain your GM New Vehicle  
Warranty.  
questions of claim eligibility pursuant  
to the terms and conditions  
described herein at its sole  
discretion.  
Recycled original equipment parts  
may also be used for repair.  
These parts are typically removed  
from vehicles that were total  
losses in prior crashes. In most  
cases, the parts being recycled are  
from undamaged sections of the  
vehicle. A recycled original  
equipment GM part, may be an  
acceptable choice to maintain your  
vehicle’s originally designed  
appearance and safety performance,  
however, the history of these  
parts is not known. Such parts are  
not covered by your GM New  
Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any  
related failures are not covered  
by that warranty.  
Collision Damage Repair  
If your vehicle is involved in a  
collision and it is damaged, have  
the damage repaired by a qualified  
technician using the proper  
equipment and quality replacement  
parts. Poorly performed collision  
repairs diminish your vehicle’s  
resale value, and safety  
It may not be possible to provide a  
like-vehicle as a courtesy rental.  
Additional Program  
Information  
performance can be compromised  
in subsequent collisions.  
All program options, such as shuttle  
service, may not be available at  
every retailer. Please contact your  
retailer for specific information about  
availability. All Courtesy  
Transportation arrangements will be  
administered by appropriate  
retailer personnel.  
Collision Parts  
Genuine GM Collision parts are new  
parts made with the same materials  
and construction methods as the  
parts with which your vehicle  
was originally built. Genuine GM  
Collision parts are your best choice  
to ensure that your vehicle’s  
Aftermarket collision parts are also  
available. These are made by  
companies other than GM and may  
not have been tested for your  
vehicle. As a result, these parts may  
fit poorly, exhibit premature  
Saturn reserves the right to  
unilaterally modify, change or  
discontinue Courtesy Transportation  
designed appearance, durability,  
and safety are preserved. The use  
durability/corrosion problems, and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-10  
Customer Assistance Information  
may not perform properly in  
subsequent collisions. Aftermarket  
parts are not covered by your  
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty,  
and any vehicle failure related to  
such parts are not covered by  
that warranty.  
Many insurance policies provide  
reduced protection to your GM  
vehicle by limiting compensation for  
damage repairs by using  
aftermarket collision parts. Some  
insurance companies will not specify  
aftermarket collision parts. When  
purchasing insurance, we  
recommend that you assure your  
vehicle will be repaired with  
GM original equipment collision  
parts. If such insurance coverage is  
not available from your current  
insurance carrier, consider switching  
to another insurance carrier.  
If a Crash Occurs  
Here is what to do if you are  
involved in a crash.  
Check to make sure that you are  
all right. If you are uninjured,  
make sure that no one else in  
your vehicle, or the other vehicle,  
is injured.  
Repair Facility  
We recommend that you choose a  
collision repair facility that meets  
your needs before you ever  
If there has been an injury, call  
emergency services for help.  
Do not leave the scene of a crash  
until all matters have been  
need collision repairs. Your  
dealer/retailer may have a collision  
repair center with GM-trained  
technicians and state of the art  
equipment, or be able to  
recommend a collision repair center  
that has GM-trained technicians  
and comparable equipment.  
taken care of. Move your vehicle  
only if its position puts you in  
danger or you are instructed to  
move it by a police officer.  
If your vehicle is leased, the leasing  
company may require you to  
have insurance that assures repairs  
with Genuine GM Original  
Equipment Manufacturer (OEM)  
parts or Genuine Manufacturer  
replacement parts. Read your lease  
carefully, as you may be charged  
at the end of your lease for  
Give only the necessary and  
requested information to  
police and other parties involved  
in the crash. Do not discuss  
your personal condition, mental  
frame of mind, or anything  
unrelated to the crash. This will  
help guard against post-crash  
legal action.  
Insuring Your Vehicle  
Protect your investment in your GM  
vehicle with comprehensive and  
collision insurance coverage. There  
are significant differences in the  
quality of coverage afforded  
poor quality repairs.  
by various insurance policy terms.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance Information  
7-11  
number, and a general  
description of the damage to the  
other vehicle.  
If you need roadside assistance,  
call GM Roadside Assistance.  
Program on page 7-5 for more  
information.  
Once you have an estimate, read  
it carefully and make sure you  
understand what work will  
be performed on your vehicle. If  
you have a question, ask for  
an explanation. Reputable shops  
welcome this opportunity.  
If possible, call your insurance  
company from the scene of  
the crash. They will walk  
you through the information they  
will need. If they ask for a  
police report, phone or go to the  
police department headquarters  
the next day and you can get  
a copy of the report for a nominal  
fee. In some states/provinces  
with “no fault” insurance laws, a  
report may not be necessary.  
This is especially true if there are  
no injuries and both vehicles  
are driveable.  
If your vehicle cannot be driven,  
know where the towing service  
will be taking it. Get a card  
from the tow truck operator or  
write down the driver’s name, the  
service’s name, and the phone  
number.  
Managing the Vehicle Damage  
Repair Process  
In the event that your vehicle  
requires damage repairs, GM  
recommends that you take an active  
role in its repair. If you have a  
pre-determined repair facility  
of choice, take your vehicle there, or  
have it towed there. Specify to the  
facility that any required  
replacement collision parts be  
original equipment parts, either new  
Genuine GM parts or recycled  
original GM parts. Remember,  
recycled parts will not be covered  
by your GM vehicle warranty.  
Remove any valuables from your  
vehicle before it is towed away.  
Make sure this includes your  
insurance information and  
registration if you keep these  
items in your vehicle.  
Choose a reputable collision  
repair facility for your vehicle.  
Whether you select a dealer/  
retailer or a private collision  
repair facility to fix the damage,  
make sure you are comfortable  
with them. Remember, you  
will have to feel comfortable with  
their work for a long time.  
Gather the important information  
you will need from the other  
driver. Things like name,  
address, phone number, driver’s  
license number, vehicle license  
plate, vehicle make, model  
and model year, Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN),  
insurance company and policy  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-12  
Customer Assistance Information  
Insurance pays the bill for the  
repair, but you must live with the  
repair. Depending on your  
To contact NHTSA, call the  
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1-888-327-4236 (TTY:  
Reporting Safety  
Defects  
policy limits, your insurance  
company may initially value the  
repair using aftermarket parts.  
Discuss this with your repair  
professional, and insist on Genuine  
GM parts. Remember if your  
vehicle is leased you may be  
obligated to have the vehicle  
repaired with Genuine GM parts,  
even if your insurance coverage  
does not pay the full cost.  
1-800-424-9153); go to  
Reporting Safety Defects  
to the United States  
Government  
If you believe that your vehicle  
has a defect which could  
cause a crash or could cause  
injury or death, you should  
immediately inform the National  
Highway Traffic Safety  
Safercar.gov; or write to:  
Administrator, NHTSA  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.  
Washington D.C., 20590  
You can also obtain other  
information about motor vehicle  
safety from Safercar.gov.  
Reporting Safety Defects  
to the Canadian  
Government  
If you live in Canada, and you  
believe that your vehicle has  
a safety defect, notify Transport  
Canada immediately, in addition to  
notifying General Motors of  
Canada Limited. Call them at  
1-800-333-0510 or write to:  
Administration (NHTSA), in  
addition to notifying Saturn  
Corporation.  
If another party’s insurance  
company is paying for the repairs,  
you are not obligated to accept  
a repair valuation based on  
that insurance company’s collision  
policy repair limits, as you have  
no contractual limits with that  
company. In such cases, you can  
have control of the repair and  
parts choices as long as cost stays  
within reasonable limits.  
If NHTSA receives similar  
complaints, it could open an  
investigation, and if it finds that  
a safety defect exists in a  
group of vehicles, it could order  
a recall and remedy campaign.  
However, NHTSA cannot  
become involved in individual  
problems between you,  
Transport Canada  
Road Safety Branch  
2780 Sheffield Road  
Ottawa, Ontario K1B 3V9  
your retailer or Saturn  
Corporation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance Information  
Owner Publications  
7-13  
Reporting Safety Defects Service Publications  
to Saturn  
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or  
Transport Canada) in a situation like  
this, please notify Saturn.  
Ordering Information  
Information on how to obtain  
product bulletins and as described  
below is applicable only in the  
fifty U.S. states and the District of  
Columbia, and only for cars and light  
trucks with a Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) less than  
10,000 pounds (4 536 kg). Copies of  
individual bulletins are also at  
your participating Saturn retailer.  
You can ask to see them.  
Service Manuals  
A variety of publications are  
available to you. Saturn service  
manuals are written for trained  
technicians, and in some cases,  
specialized tools and equipment are  
necessary to complete certain  
repairs. However, the manuals are  
available to owners who either  
have the training, or wish to gain a  
greater understanding of the  
Call 1-800-553-6000, or write:  
Saturn Corporation  
100 Saturn Parkway  
Mail Drop 371-999-S24  
Spring Hill, TN 37174-1500  
In Canada, call 1-800-263-1999,  
or write:  
In Canada, information relating to  
product service bulletins can  
be obtained by contacting your  
Saturn retailer.  
Saturn Customer Communication  
Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
technical aspect of their Saturn.  
For additional publications  
information or to order publications  
in the United States, call toll  
free 1-800-2-SATURN or visit  
Saturn-publications.com to order  
on-line.  
Service Bulletins  
Saturn regularly sends its retailers  
useful service bulletins about Saturn  
products. Saturn monitors product  
performance in the field. We  
then prepare bulletins for servicing  
our products better. You can  
get these bulletins, too.  
In Canada, Saturn service manuals  
are available by calling toll free  
1-800-551-4123.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-14  
Customer Assistance Information  
Bulletins cover various subjects.  
Some pertain to the proper use and  
care of your vehicle. Some  
describe costly repairs. Others  
describe inexpensive repairs which,  
if done on time with the latest  
parts, may avoid future costly  
repairs.  
Event Data Recorders  
This vehicle has an Event  
Vehicle Data  
Recording and  
Privacy  
Your Saturn vehicle has a number  
of sophisticated computers that  
record information about the  
vehicle’s performance and how it is  
driven. For example, your vehicle  
uses computer modules to monitor  
and control engine and transmission  
performance, to monitor the  
conditions for airbag deployment  
and deploy airbags in a crash and,  
if so equipped, to provide antilock  
braking to help the driver control the  
vehicle. These modules may  
store data to help your  
dealer/retailer technician service  
your vehicle. Some modules  
may also store data about how you  
operate the vehicle, such as rate  
of fuel consumption or average  
speed. These modules may  
Data Recorder (EDR). The main  
purpose of an EDR is to record, in  
certain crash or near crash-like  
situations, such as an airbag  
deployment or hitting a road  
obstacle, data that will assist in  
understanding how a vehicle’s  
systems performed. The EDR is  
designed to record data related to  
vehicle dynamics and safety  
systems for a short period of time,  
typically 30 seconds or less.  
The EDR in this vehicle is designed  
to record such data as:  
Some bulletins tell a technician how  
to repair a new or unexpected  
condition. Others describe a quicker  
way to fix your vehicle. They can  
help a technician service your  
vehicle better.  
Most bulletins apply to conditions  
affecting a small number of vehicles.  
Your Saturn retailer or a qualified  
technician may have to determine if  
a specific bulletin applies to your  
vehicle. To order Saturn bulletins,  
call Saturn Publications at  
1-800-2-SATURN or visit  
saturn-publications.com to  
order online.  
How various systems in your  
vehicle were operating  
Whether or not the driver and  
passenger safety belts were  
buckled/fastened  
How far, if at all, the driver was  
pressing the accelerator and/or  
brake pedal  
also retain the owner’s personal  
preferences, such as radio pre-sets,  
seat positions, and temperature  
settings.  
How fast the vehicle was  
traveling  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance Information  
7-15  
This data can help provide a better  
understanding of the circumstances  
in which crashes and injuries  
occur.  
Important: EDR data is recorded  
by your vehicle only if a non-trivial  
crash situation occurs; no data  
is recorded by the EDR under  
normal driving conditions and no  
personal data (e.g., name, gender,  
age, and crash location) is  
recorded. However, other parties,  
such as law enforcement, could  
combine the EDR data with the type  
of personally identifying data  
routinely acquired during a crash  
investigation.  
Saturn will not access this data or  
Navigation System  
If your vehicle has a navigation  
system, use of the system  
may result in the storage of  
destinations, addresses, telephone  
numbers, and other trip information.  
Refer to the navigation system  
operating manual for information on  
stored data and for deletion  
instructions.  
share it with others except: with  
the consent of the vehicle owner or,  
if the vehicle is leased, with the  
consent of the lessee; in response  
to an official request of police or  
similar government office; as part of  
Saturn’s defense of litigation  
through the discovery process; or,  
as required by law. Data that Saturn  
collects or receives may also be  
used for Saturn research needs or  
may be made available to others  
for research purposes, where  
a need is shown and the data is not  
tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle  
owner.  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID)  
RFID technology is used in some  
vehicles for functions such as  
tire pressure monitoring and ignition  
system security, as well as in  
connection with conveniences such  
as key fobs for remote door  
locking/unlocking and starting, and  
in-vehicle transmitters for garage  
door openers. RFID technology in  
Saturn vehicles does not use  
To read data recorded by an EDR,  
special equipment is required,  
and access to the vehicle or the  
EDR is needed. In addition to  
the vehicle manufacturer, other  
parties, such as law enforcement,  
that have the special equipment, can  
read the information if they have  
access to the vehicle or the EDR.  
OnStar®  
If your vehicle has OnStar and you  
subscribe to the OnStar services,  
please refer to the OnStar  
Terms and Conditions for  
information on data collection and  
use. See also OnStar® System  
on page 2-29 in this manual  
for more information.  
or record personal information or  
link with any other Saturn system  
containing personal information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7-16  
Customer Assistance Information  
NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-1  
Airbag System (cont.)  
Appearance Care (cont.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
i-2  
INDEX  
Bluetooth® .......................... 3-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-3  
Child Restraints (cont.)  
Customer Assistance Information  
(cont.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-4  
INDEX  
Driving (cont.)  
PASS-Key® III+ ................ 2-12  
PASS-Key® III+ ................ 2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-5  
F
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-6  
INDEX  
Light (cont.)  
I
StabiliTrak® /Traction  
Ignition Positions .................. 2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-7  
OnStar® System, see  
OnStar® Manual ............... 2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-8  
INDEX  
P
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Bluetooth® ....................... 3-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-9  
Routing, Engine Drive Belt .... 6-13  
Seats (cont.)  
StabiliTrak® System ............... 4-7  
StabiliTrak®/TCS Warning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-10  
INDEX  
Storage Areas (cont.)  
Tires (cont.)  
StabiliTrak® System ............ 4-7  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-11  
U
Uniform Tire Quality Grading .. 5-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Radio Shack Thermometer 63 1034 User Guide
Regency Stove FG37 LPG User Guide
ReliOn Blood Pressure Monitor UA 787REL User Guide
Remington Styling Iron CB 75i User Guide
Renesas Network Card PCA4738F 100A User Guide
Ryobi Lawn Mower 136 User Guide
Ryobi Trimmer RY30542 User Guide
Samsung All in One Printer SLM3370FD User Guide
Samsung Digital Camera Digimax 200 User Guide
Samsung Projection Television HL R5056W User Guide